blob: 4b6e63d8a3fa5be394c0b7fff6d9f66b06ac5a28 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau1db55792020-11-05 17:20:35 +01005 version 2.4
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau86512dd2021-04-09 17:10:39 +02007 2021/04/09
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100442.4. Conditional blocks
452.5. Time format
462.6. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020047
483. Global parameters
493.1. Process management and security
503.2. Performance tuning
513.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100523.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200533.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200543.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200553.7. Programs
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +0100563.8. HTTP-errors
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +0200573.9. Rings
William Lallemand0217b7b2020-11-18 10:41:24 +0100583.10. Log forwarding
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020059
604. Proxies
614.1. Proxy keywords matrix
624.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
63
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100645. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200655.1. Bind options
665.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200675.3. Server DNS resolution
685.3.1. Global overview
695.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020070
Julien Pivotto6ccee412019-11-27 15:49:54 +0100716. Cache
726.1. Limitation
736.2. Setup
746.2.1. Cache section
756.2.2. Proxy section
76
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200777. Using ACLs and fetching samples
787.1. ACL basics
797.1.1. Matching booleans
807.1.2. Matching integers
817.1.3. Matching strings
827.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
837.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
847.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
857.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
867.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200877.3.1. Converters
887.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
897.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
907.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
917.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
927.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200937.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200947.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020095
968. Logging
978.1. Log levels
988.2. Log formats
998.2.1. Default log format
1008.2.2. TCP log format
1018.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01001028.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +01001038.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001048.3. Advanced logging options
1058.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1068.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1078.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1088.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1098.4. Timing events
1108.5. Session state at disconnection
1118.6. Non-printable characters
1128.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1138.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1148.9. Examples of logs
115
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001169. Supported filters
1179.1. Trace
1189.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001199.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001209.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02001219.5. fcgi-app
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +01001229.6. OpenTracing
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200123
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012410. FastCGI applications
12510.1. Setup
12610.1.1. Fcgi-app section
12710.1.2. Proxy section
12810.1.3. Example
12910.2. Default parameters
13010.3. Limitations
131
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020013211. Address formats
13311.1. Address family prefixes
13411.2. Socket type prefixes
13511.3. Protocol prefixes
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200136
1371. Quick reminder about HTTP
138----------------------------
139
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100140When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200141fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
142on almost anything found in the contents.
143
144However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
145formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
146correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
147
148
1491.1. The HTTP transaction model
150-------------------------------
151
152The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100153to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100154from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
155connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200156will involve a new connection :
157
158 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
159
160In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
161establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
162by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
163length.
164
165Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
166to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
167however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
168response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
169header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
170
171 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
172
173Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
174power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
175but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200176a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200177
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100178Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200179keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
180second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
181page :
182
183 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
184
185This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
186latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
187correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
188the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100189server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200190
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100191The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
192time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
193are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
194parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
195carry the stream identifier.
196
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100197By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
198connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
199leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100200start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
201processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
202waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200203
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200204HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100205 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
206 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100207 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100208 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200209 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100210
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100211
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200212
2131.2. HTTP request
214-----------------
215
216First, let's consider this HTTP request :
217
218 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100219 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200220 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
221 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
222 3 User-agent: my small browser
223 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
224 5 Accept: image/png
225
226
2271.2.1. The Request line
228-----------------------
229
230Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
231
232 - a METHOD : GET
233 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
234 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
235
236All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
237which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
238followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
239is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
240desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
241the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
242
243The URI itself can have several forms :
244
245 - A "relative URI" :
246
247 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
248
249 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
250 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
251
252 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
253
254 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
255
256 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
257 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
258 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
259 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
260 must accept this form too.
261
262 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
263 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
264 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100265
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200266 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
267 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
268 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
269 other protocols too.
270
271In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
272mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
273on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
274It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
275specific to the language, framework or application in use.
276
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100277HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100278assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100279
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200280
2811.2.2. The request headers
282--------------------------
283
284The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
285beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
286an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
287Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
288values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
289encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
290the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
291define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
292
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100293Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200294their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100295"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
Willy Tarreau253c2512020-07-07 15:55:23 +0200296as can be seen when running in debug mode. Internally, all header names are
297normalized to lower case so that HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 use the exact same
298representation, and they are sent as-is on the other side. This explains why an
299HTTP/1.x request typed with camel case is delivered in lower case.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200300
301The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
302that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
303is one valid form of empty line.
304
305Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
306headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
307about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
308application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
309
310Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000311 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200312 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
313 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
314 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
315
316
3171.3. HTTP response
318------------------
319
320An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
321messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
322
323 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100324 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200325 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
326 2 Content-length: 350
327 3 Content-Type: text/html
328
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200329As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
330codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
331response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100332continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
333the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
334following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
335sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
336(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
337correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
338such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
339state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
340over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
341if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
342information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200343
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200344
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003451.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200346------------------------
347
348Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
349
350 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
351 - a status code : 200
352 - a reason : OK
353
354The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100355 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
356 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
357 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
358 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
359 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200360
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000361Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100362"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200363found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
364messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
365or "Authentication Required".
366
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100367HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200368
369 Code When / reason
370 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
371 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
372 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
373 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100374 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
375 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200376 400 for an invalid or too large request
377 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
378 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200379 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +0100380 404 when the requested resource could not be found
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
Florian Tham272e29b2020-01-08 10:19:05 +0100382 410 when the requested resource is no longer available and will not
383 be available again
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200384 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
385 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +0100386 501 when haproxy is unable to satisfy a client request because of an
387 unsupported feature
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200388 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200389 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200390 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
391 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
392 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
393
394The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3954.2).
396
397
3981.3.2. The response headers
399---------------------------
400
401Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
402the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
403details.
404
405
4062. Configuring HAProxy
407----------------------
408
4092.1. Configuration file format
410------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200411
412HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
413
414 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100415 - the configuration file(s), whose format is described here
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -0700416 - the running process's environment, in case some environment variables are
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100417 explicitly referenced
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200418
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100419The configuration file follows a fairly simple hierarchical format which obey
420a few basic rules:
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100421
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100422 1. a configuration file is an ordered sequence of statements
423
424 2. a statement is a single non-empty line before any unprotected "#" (hash)
425
426 3. a line is a series of tokens or "words" delimited by unprotected spaces or
427 tab characters
428
429 4. the first word or sequence of words of a line is one of the keywords or
430 keyword sequences listed in this document
431
432 5. all other words are all arguments of the first one, some being well-known
433 keywords listed in this document, others being values, references to other
434 parts of the configuration, or expressions
435
436 6. certain keywords delimit a section inside which only a subset of keywords
437 are supported
438
439 7. a section ends at the end of a file or on a special keyword starting a new
440 section
441
442This is all that is needed to know to write a simple but reliable configuration
443generator, but this is not enough to reliably parse any configuration nor to
444figure how to deal with certain corner cases.
445
446First, there are a few consequences of the rules above. Rule 6 and 7 imply that
447the keywords used to define a new section are valid everywhere and cannot have
448a different meaning in a specific section. These keywords are always a single
449word (as opposed to a sequence of words), and traditionally the section that
450follows them is designated using the same name. For example when speaking about
451the "global section", it designates the section of configuration that follows
452the "global" keyword. This usage is used a lot in error messages to help locate
453the parts that need to be addressed.
454
455A number of sections create an internal object or configuration space, which
456requires to be distinguished from other ones. In this case they will take an
457extra word which will set the name of this particular section. For some of them
458the section name is mandatory. For example "frontend foo" will create a new
459section of type "frontend" named "foo". Usually a name is specific to its
460section and two sections of different types may use the same name, but this is
461not recommended as it tends to complexify configuration management.
462
463A direct consequence of rule 7 is that when multiple files are read at once,
464each of them must start with a new section, and the end of each file will end
465a section. A file cannot contain sub-sections nor end an existing section and
466start a new one.
467
468Rule 1 mentioned that ordering matters. Indeed, some keywords create directives
469that can be repeated multiple times to create ordered sequences of rules to be
470applied in a certain order. For example "tcp-request" can be used to alternate
471"accept" and "reject" rules on varying criteria. As such, a configuration file
472processor must always preserve a section's ordering when editing a file. The
473ordering of sections usually does not matter except for the global section
474which must be placed before other sections, but it may be repeated if needed.
475In addition, some automatic identifiers may automatically be assigned to some
476of the created objects (e.g. proxies), and by reordering sections, their
477identifiers will change. These ones appear in the statistics for example. As
478such, the configuration below will assign "foo" ID number 1 and "bar" ID number
4792, which will be swapped if the two sections are reversed:
480
481 listen foo
482 bind :80
483
484 listen bar
485 bind :81
486
487Another important point is that according to rules 2 and 3 above, empty lines,
488spaces, tabs, and comments following and unprotected "#" character are not part
489of the configuration as they are just used as delimiters. This implies that the
490following configurations are strictly equivalent:
491
492 global#this is the global section
493 daemon#daemonize
494 frontend foo
495 mode http # or tcp
496
497and:
498
499 global
500 daemon
501
502 # this is the public web frontend
503 frontend foo
504 mode http
505
506The common practice is to align to the left only the keyword that initiates a
507new section, and indent (i.e. prepend a tab character or a few spaces) all
508other keywords so that it's instantly visible that they belong to the same
509section (as done in the second example above). Placing comments before a new
510section helps the reader decide if it's the desired one. Leaving a blank line
511at the end of a section also visually helps spotting the end when editing it.
512
513Tabs are very convenient for indent but they do not copy-paste well. If spaces
514are used instead, it is recommended to avoid placing too many (2 to 4) so that
515editing in field doesn't become a burden with limited editors that do not
516support automatic indent.
517
518In the early days it used to be common to see arguments split at fixed tab
519positions because most keywords would not take more than two arguments. With
520modern versions featuring complex expressions this practice does not stand
521anymore, and is not recommended.
522
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200523
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02005242.2. Quoting and escaping
525-------------------------
526
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100527In modern configurations, some arguments require the use of some characters
528that were previously considered as pure delimiters. In order to make this
529possible, HAProxy supports character escaping by prepending a backslash ('\')
530in front of the character to be escaped, weak quoting within double quotes
531('"') and strong quoting within single quotes ("'").
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200532
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100533This is pretty similar to what is done in a number of programming languages and
534very close to what is commonly encountered in Bourne shell. The principle is
535the following: while the configuration parser cuts the lines into words, it
536also takes care of quotes and backslashes to decide whether a character is a
537delimiter or is the raw representation of this character within the current
538word. The escape character is then removed, the quotes are removed, and the
539remaining word is used as-is as a keyword or argument for example.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200540
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100541If a backslash is needed in a word, it must either be escaped using itself
542(i.e. double backslash) or be strongly quoted.
543
544Escaping outside quotes is achieved by preceding a special character by a
545backslash ('\'):
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200546
547 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
548 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
549 \\ to use a backslash
550 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
551 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
552
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100553In addition, a few non-printable characters may be emitted using their usual
554C-language representation:
555
556 \n to insert a line feed (LF, character \x0a or ASCII 10 decimal)
557 \r to insert a carriage return (CR, character \x0d or ASCII 13 decimal)
558 \t to insert a tab (character \x09 or ASCII 9 decimal)
559 \xNN to insert character having ASCII code hex NN (e.g \x0a for LF).
560
561Weak quoting is achieved by surrounding double quotes ("") around the character
562or sequence of characters to protect. Weak quoting prevents the interpretation
563of:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200564
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100565 space or tab as a word separator
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200566 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
567 # hash as a comment start
568
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100569Weak quoting permits the interpretation of environment variables (which are not
570evaluated outside of quotes) by preceding them with a dollar sign ('$'). If a
571dollar character is needed inside double quotes, it must be escaped using a
572backslash.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200573
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100574Strong quoting is achieved by surrounding single quotes ('') around the
575character or sequence of characters to protect. Inside single quotes, nothing
576is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regular expressions.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200577
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100578As a result, here is the matrix indicating how special characters can be
579entered in different contexts (unprintable characters are replaced with their
580name within angle brackets). Note that some characters that may only be
581represented escaped have no possible representation inside single quotes,
582hence the '-' there:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200583
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100584 Character | Unquoted | Weakly quoted | Strongly quoted
585 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
586 <TAB> | \<TAB>, \x09 | "<TAB>", "\<TAB>", "\x09" | '<TAB>'
587 <LF> | \n, \x0a | "\n", "\x0a" | -
588 <CR> | \r, \x0d | "\r", "\x0d" | -
589 <SPC> | \<SPC>, \x20 | "<SPC>", "\<SPC>", "\x20" | '<SPC>'
590 " | \", \x22 | "\"", "\x22" | '"'
591 # | \#, \x23 | "#", "\#", "\x23" | '#'
592 $ | $, \$, \x24 | "\$", "\x24" | '$'
593 ' | \', \x27 | "'", "\'", "\x27" | -
594 \ | \\, \x5c | "\\", "\x5c" | '\'
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200595
596 Example:
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100597 # those are all strictly equivalent:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200598 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
599 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
600 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
601 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
602 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
603
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100604There is one particular case where a second level of quoting or escaping may be
605necessary. Some keywords take arguments within parenthesis, sometimes delimited
606by commas. These arguments are commonly integers or predefined words, but when
607they are arbitrary strings, it may be required to perform a separate level of
608escaping to disambiguate the characters that belong to the argument from the
609characters that are used to delimit the arguments themselves. A pretty common
610case is the "regsub" converter. It takes a regular expression in argument, and
611if a closing parenthesis is needed inside, this one will require to have its
612own quotes.
613
614The keyword argument parser is exactly the same as the top-level one regarding
615quotes, except that is will not make special cases of backslashes. But what is
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500616not always obvious is that the delimiters used inside must first be escaped or
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100617quoted so that they are not resolved at the top level.
618
619Let's take this example making use of the "regsub" converter which takes 3
620arguments, one regular expression, one replacement string and one set of flags:
621
622 # replace all occurrences of "foo" with "blah" in the path:
623 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(foo,blah,g)]
624
625Here no special quoting was necessary. But if now we want to replace either
626"foo" or "bar" with "blah", we'll need the regular expression "(foo|bar)". We
627cannot write:
628
629 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
630
631because we would like the string to cut like this:
632
633 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
634 |---------|----|-|
635 arg1 _/ / /
636 arg2 __________/ /
637 arg3 ______________/
638
639but actually what is passed is a string between the opening and closing
640parenthesis then garbage:
641
642 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
643 |--------|--------|
644 arg1=(foo|bar _/ /
645 trailing garbage _________/
646
647The obvious solution here seems to be that the closing parenthesis needs to be
648quoted, but alone this will not work, because as mentioned above, quotes are
649processed by the top-level parser which will resolve them before processing
650this word:
651
652 http-request set-path %[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
653 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
654 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
655
656So we didn't change anything for the argument parser at the second level which
657still sees a truncated regular expression as the only argument, and garbage at
658the end of the string. By escaping the quotes they will be passed unmodified to
659the second level:
660
661 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(\"(foo|bar)\",blah,g)]
662 ------------ -------- ------------------------------------
663 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
664 |---------||----|-|
665 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
666 arg2=blah ___________/ /
667 arg3=g _______________/
668
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500669Another approach consists in using single quotes outside the whole string and
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100670double quotes inside (so that the double quotes are not stripped again):
671
672 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]'
673 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
674 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
675 |---------||----|-|
676 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
677 arg2 ___________/ /
678 arg3 _______________/
679
680When using regular expressions, it can happen that the dollar ('$') character
681appears in the expression or that a backslash ('\') is used in the replacement
682string. In this case these ones will also be processed inside the double quotes
683thus single quotes are preferred (or double escaping). Example:
684
685 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]'
686 ------------ -------- -----------------------------------------
687 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]
688 |-------------| |-----||-|
689 arg1=(here)(/|$) _/ / /
690 arg2=my/\1 ________________/ /
691 arg3 ______________________/
692
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500693Remember that backslahes are not escape characters within single quotes and
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100694that the whole word3 above is already protected against them using the single
695quotes. Conversely, if double quotes had been used around the whole expression,
696single the dollar character and the backslashes would have been resolved at top
697level, breaking the argument contents at the second level.
698
699When in doubt, simply do not use quotes anywhere, and start to place single or
700double quotes around arguments that require a comma or a closing parenthesis,
701and think about escaping these quotes using a backslash of the string contains
702a dollar or a backslash. Again, this is pretty similar to what is used under
703a Bourne shell when double-escaping a command passed to "eval". For API writers
704the best is probably to place escaped quotes around each and every argument,
705regardless of their contents. Users will probably find that using single quotes
706around the whole expression and double quotes around each argument provides
707more readable configurations.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200708
709
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007102.3. Environment variables
711--------------------------
712
713HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
714interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
715configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
716optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
717shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
Amaury Denoyellefa41cb62020-10-01 14:32:35 +0200718underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit. If the variable contains a
719list of several values separated by spaces, it can be expanded as individual
720arguments by enclosing the variable with braces and appending the suffix '[*]'
721before the closing brace.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200722
723 Example:
724
725 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
726
727 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
728
729 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
730
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200731Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
732file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200733
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200734* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
735 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
736
737* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
738 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
739 directory.
740
741* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
742
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500743* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200744 processes, separated by semicolons.
745
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500746* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200747 CLI, separated by semicolons.
748
749See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200750
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100751
7522.4. Conditional blocks
753-----------------------
754
755It may sometimes be convenient to be able to conditionally enable or disable
756some arbitrary parts of the configuration, for example to enable/disable SSL or
757ciphers, enable or disable some pre-production listeners without modifying the
758configuration, or adjust the configuration's syntax to support two distinct
759versions of HAProxy during a migration.. HAProxy brings a set of nestable
760preprocessor-like directives which allow to integrate or ignore some blocks of
761text. These directives must be placed on their own line and they act on the
762lines that follow them. Two of them support an expression, the other ones only
763switch to an alternate block or end a current level. The 4 following directives
764are defined to form conditional blocks:
765
766 - .if <condition>
767 - .elif <condition>
768 - .else
769 - .endif
770
771The ".if" directive nests a new level, ".elif" stays at the same level, ".else"
772as well, and ".endif" closes a level. Each ".if" must be terminated by a
773matching ".endif". The ".elif" may only be placed after ".if" or ".elif", and
774there is no limit to the number of ".elif" that may be chained. There may be
775only one ".else" per ".if" and it must always be after the ".if" or the last
776".elif" of a block.
777
778Comments may be placed on the same line if needed after a '#', they will be
779ignored. The directives are tokenized like other configuration directives, and
780as such it is possible to use environment variables in conditions.
781
782The conditions are currently limited to:
783
784 - an empty string, always returns "false"
785 - the integer zero ('0'), always returns "false"
786 - a non-nul integer (e.g. '1'), always returns "true".
787
788Other patterns are not supported yet but the purpose is to bring a few
789functions to test for certain build options and supported features.
790
791Three other directives are provided to report some status:
792
793 - .notice "message" : emit this message at level NOTICE
794 - .warning "message" : emit this message at level WARNING
795 - .alert "message" : emit this message at level ALERT
796
797Messages emitted at level WARNING may cause the process to fail to start if the
798"strict-mode" is enabled. Messages emitted at level ALERT will always cause a
799fatal error. These can be used to detect some inappropriate conditions and
800provide advice to the user.
801
802Example:
803
804 .if "${A}"
805 .if "${B}"
806 .notice "A=1, B=1"
807 .elif "${C}"
808 .notice "A=1, B=0, C=1"
809 .elif "${D}"
810 .warning "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=1"
811 .else
812 .alert "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=0"
813 .endif
814 .else
815 .notice "A=0"
816 .endif
817
818
8192.5. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200820----------------
821
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100822Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100823values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
824otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
825numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
826for every keyword. Supported units are :
827
828 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
829 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
830 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
831 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
832 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
833 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
834
835
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +01008362.6. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200837-------------
838
839 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
840 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
841 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
842 global
843 daemon
844 maxconn 256
845
846 defaults
847 mode http
848 timeout connect 5000ms
849 timeout client 50000ms
850 timeout server 50000ms
851
852 frontend http-in
853 bind *:80
854 default_backend servers
855
856 backend servers
857 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
858
859
860 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
861 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
862 global
863 daemon
864 maxconn 256
865
866 defaults
867 mode http
868 timeout connect 5000ms
869 timeout client 50000ms
870 timeout server 50000ms
871
872 listen http-in
873 bind *:80
874 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
875
876
877Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
878
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100879 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200880
881
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008823. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200883--------------------
884
885Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
886are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
887of them have command-line equivalents.
888
889The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
890
891 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200892 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200893 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200894 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200895 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200896 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200897 - description
898 - deviceatlas-json-file
899 - deviceatlas-log-level
900 - deviceatlas-separator
901 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900902 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200903 - gid
904 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100905 - hard-stop-after
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200906 - h1-case-adjust
907 - h1-case-adjust-file
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100908 - insecure-fork-wanted
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100909 - insecure-setuid-wanted
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +0100910 - issuers-chain-path
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +0200911 - localpeer
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200912 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200913 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100914 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200915 - lua-load
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +0100916 - lua-load-per-thread
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +0100917 - lua-prepend-path
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +0200918 - mworker-max-reloads
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200919 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200920 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200921 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200922 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +0200923 - pp2-never-send-local
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100924 - presetenv
925 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200926 - uid
927 - ulimit-n
928 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +0200929 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +0100930 - set-var
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100931 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200932 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200933 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200934 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +0200935 - ssl-default-bind-curves
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200936 - ssl-default-bind-options
937 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +0200938 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200939 - ssl-default-server-options
940 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100941 - ssl-server-verify
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +0200942 - ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100943 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100944 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100945 - 51degrees-data-file
946 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200947 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200948 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200949 - wurfl-data-file
950 - wurfl-information-list
951 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +0200952 - wurfl-cache-size
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +0100953 - strict-limits
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100954
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200955 * Performance tuning
William Dauchy0a8824f2019-10-27 20:08:09 +0100956 - busy-polling
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200957 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200958 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200959 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100960 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100961 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100962 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200963 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200964 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200965 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200966 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200967 - noepoll
968 - nokqueue
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +0000969 - noevports
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200970 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100971 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300972 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000973 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +0100974 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200975 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200976 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200977 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000978 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000979 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200980 - tune.buffers.limit
981 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200982 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200983 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100984 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +0200985 - tune.fd.edge-triggered
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +0200986 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +0200987 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +0200988 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100989 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +0200990 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200991 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +0200992 - tune.idle-pool.shared
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100993 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100994 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100995 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100996 - tune.lua.session-timeout
997 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200998 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100999 - tune.maxaccept
1000 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001001 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001002 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001003 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaua8e2d972020-07-01 18:27:16 +02001004 - tune.pool-high-fd-ratio
1005 - tune.pool-low-fd-ratio
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001006 - tune.rcvbuf.client
1007 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001008 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001009 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02001010 - tune.sched.low-latency
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001011 - tune.sndbuf.client
1012 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001013 - tune.ssl.cachesize
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02001014 - tune.ssl.keylog
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001015 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001016 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001017 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001018 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001019 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01001020 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001021 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001022 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001023 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
1024 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
1025 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001026 - tune.zlib.memlevel
1027 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001028
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001029 * Debugging
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001030 - quiet
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02001031 - zero-warning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001032
1033
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010343.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001035------------------------------------
1036
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001037ca-base <dir>
1038 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +01001039 relative path is used with "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" or "crl-file"
1040 directives. Absolute locations specified in "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" and
1041 "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001042
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001043chroot <jail dir>
1044 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
1045 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
1046 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
1047 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
1048 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001049 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001050
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001051cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
1052 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
1053 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
1054 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
1055 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
1056 set. These sets have the format
1057
1058 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
1059
1060 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001061 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001062 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
1063 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +01001064 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
1065 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001066 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +01001067 range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001068 or ranges may be specified, and the processes or threads will be allowed to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001069 bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001070 specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace the previous ones when they
1071 overlap. A thread will be bound on the intersection of its mapping and the
1072 one of the process on which it is attached. If the intersection is null, no
1073 specific binding will be set for the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +01001074
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001075 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
1076 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
1077 on the machine's word size.
1078
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001079 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001080 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
1081 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
1082 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
1083 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
1084 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
1085 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001086
1087 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001088 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
1089
1090 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
1091 # first 4 CPUs
1092
1093 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
1094 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
1095 # word size.
1096
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001097 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001098 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001099 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
1100 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
1101 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
1102
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001103 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
1104 # and so on.
1105 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
1106 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
1107 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
1108
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001109 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001110 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
1111 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
1112 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
1113
1114 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
1115 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
1116 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
1117
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001118 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
1119 # and a thread range.
1120 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
1121 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
1122 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
1123
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001124crt-base <dir>
1125 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
William Dauchy238ea3b2020-01-11 13:09:12 +01001126 path is used with "crtfile" or "crt" directives. Absolute locations specified
1127 prevail and ignore "crt-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001128
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001129daemon
1130 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
1131 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +01001132 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
1133 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001134
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001135deviceatlas-json-file <path>
1136 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001137 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001138
1139deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001140 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001141 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
1142
1143deviceatlas-separator <char>
1144 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
1145 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
1146
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +01001147deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001148 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
1149 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
1150 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +01001151
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001152external-check
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001153 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks. This is
1154 disabled by default as a security precaution, and even when enabled, checks
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001155 may still fail unless "insecure-fork-wanted" is enabled as well. If the
1156 program launched makes use of a setuid executable (it should really not),
1157 you may also need to set "insecure-setuid-wanted" in the global section.
1158 See "option external-check", and "insecure-fork-wanted", and
1159 "insecure-setuid-wanted".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001160
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001161gid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07001162 Changes the process's group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001163 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1164 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +01001165 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
1166 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001167 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001168
Willy Tarreau11770ce2019-12-03 08:29:22 +01001169group <group name>
1170 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
1171 See also "gid" and "user".
1172
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +01001173hard-stop-after <time>
1174 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
1175
1176 Arguments :
1177 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
1178 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
1179 SIGUSR1 signal.
1180
1181 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
1182 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
1183 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
1184
1185 Example:
1186 global
1187 hard-stop-after 30s
1188
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001189h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
1190 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
1191 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
1192 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
1193 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05001194 adjusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001195 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
1196 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
1197 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
1198 specified in a proxy.
1199
1200 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
1201 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
1202 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
1203 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
1204 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
1205 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
1206 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
1207
1208 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
1209 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
1210 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
1211 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
1212 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
1213
1214 Example:
1215 global
1216 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
1217
1218 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1219 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1220
1221h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
1222 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
1223 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
1224 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
1225 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
1226 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
1227 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
1228 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
1229 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
1230
1231 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
1232 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
1233 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
1234
1235 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1236 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1237
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001238insecure-fork-wanted
1239 By default haproxy tries hard to prevent any thread and process creation
1240 after it starts. Doing so is particularly important when using Lua files of
1241 uncertain origin, and when experimenting with development versions which may
1242 still contain bugs whose exploitability is uncertain. And generally speaking
1243 it's good hygiene to make sure that no unexpected background activity can be
1244 triggered by traffic. But this prevents external checks from working, and may
1245 break some very specific Lua scripts which actively rely on the ability to
1246 fork. This option is there to disable this protection. Note that it is a bad
1247 idea to disable it, as a vulnerability in a library or within haproxy itself
1248 will be easier to exploit once disabled. In addition, forking from Lua or
1249 anywhere else is not reliable as the forked process may randomly embed a lock
1250 set by another thread and never manage to finish an operation. As such it is
1251 highly recommended that this option is never used and that any workload
1252 requiring such a fork be reconsidered and moved to a safer solution (such as
1253 agents instead of external checks). This option supports the "no" prefix to
1254 disable it.
1255
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001256insecure-setuid-wanted
1257 HAProxy doesn't need to call executables at run time (except when using
1258 external checks which are strongly recommended against), and is even expected
1259 to isolate itself into an empty chroot. As such, there basically is no valid
1260 reason to allow a setuid executable to be called without the user being fully
1261 aware of the risks. In a situation where haproxy would need to call external
1262 checks and/or disable chroot, exploiting a vulnerability in a library or in
1263 haproxy itself could lead to the execution of an external program. On Linux
1264 it is possible to lock the process so that any setuid bit present on such an
1265 executable is ignored. This significantly reduces the risk of privilege
1266 escalation in such a situation. This is what haproxy does by default. In case
1267 this causes a problem to an external check (for example one which would need
1268 the "ping" command), then it is possible to disable this protection by
1269 explicitly adding this directive in the global section. If enabled, it is
1270 possible to turn it back off by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
1271
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001272issuers-chain-path <dir>
1273 Assigns a directory to load certificate chain for issuer completion. All
1274 files must be in PEM format. For certificates loaded with "crt" or "crt-list",
1275 if certificate chain is not included in PEM (also commonly known as
1276 intermediate certificate), haproxy will complete chain if the issuer of the
1277 certificate corresponds to the first certificate of the chain loaded with
1278 "issuers-chain-path".
1279 A "crt" file with PrivateKey+Certificate+IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1
1280 could be replaced with PrivateKey+Certificate. HAProxy will complete the
1281 chain if a file with IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1 is present in
1282 "issuers-chain-path" directory. All other certificates with the same issuer
1283 will share the chain in memory.
1284
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02001285localpeer <name>
1286 Sets the local instance's peer name. It will be ignored if the "-L"
1287 command line argument is specified or if used after "peers" section
1288 definitions. In such cases, a warning message will be emitted during
1289 the configuration parsing.
1290
1291 This option will also set the HAPROXY_LOCALPEER environment variable.
1292 See also "-L" in the management guide and "peers" section below.
1293
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01001294log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001295 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +01001296 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001297 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001298 configured with "log global".
1299
1300 <address> can be one of:
1301
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01001302 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001303 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1304 port).
1305
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01001306 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
1307 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1308 port).
1309
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001310 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001311 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
1312 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001313 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001314
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001315 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
1316 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
1317 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
1318 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
1319 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
1320 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
1321 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
1322 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
1323 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
1324 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
1325 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow haproxy down
1326 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
1327 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
1328 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001329 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
1330 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001331
1332 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
1333 "fd@2", see above.
1334
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02001335 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
1336 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
1337 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
1338 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
1339 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
1340
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001341 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1342 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001343
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001344 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
1345 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
1346 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
1347 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
1348 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
1349 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
1350 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
1351 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
1352 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
1353 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001354 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
1355 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001356
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001357 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
1358 one of the following :
1359
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01001360 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
1361 field is stripped. This is the default.
1362 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
1363 rfc3164.
1364
1365 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001366 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
1367
1368 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
1369 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
1370
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001371 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
1372 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
1373 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1374 designed to be used with a local log server.
1375
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001376 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1377 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
1378 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
1379 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
1380 logger consumes.
1381
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001382 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1383 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
1384 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1385 used with a local log server.
1386
1387 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
1388 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1389 designed to be used with a local log server.
1390
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001391 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
1392 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1393 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
1394 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
1395
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001396 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
1397 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
1398 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
1399 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
1400 set with <sample_size> parameter.
1401
1402 <sample_size>
1403 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
1404 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
1405 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
1406 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
1407 (see also <ranges> parameter).
1408
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001409 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001410
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001411 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
1412 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
1413 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
1414
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001415 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
1416 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
1417 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1418 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001419
1420 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001421 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1422 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1423 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1424 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1425 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1426 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001427
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001428 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001429
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001430log-send-hostname [<string>]
1431 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1432 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1433 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1434 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1435 the logs.
1436
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001437log-tag <string>
1438 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1439 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1440 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001441 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001442
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001443lua-load <file>
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001444 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file in the shared context
1445 that is visible to all threads. Any variable set in such a context is visible
1446 from any thread. This is the easiest and recommended way to load Lua programs
1447 but it will not scale well if a lot of Lua calls are performed, as only one
1448 thread may be running on the global state at a time. A program loaded this
1449 way will always see 0 in the "core.thread" variable. This directive can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001450 used multiple times.
1451
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001452lua-load-per-thread <file>
1453 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file into each started thread.
1454 Any global variable has a thread-local visibility so that each thread could
1455 see a different value. As such it is strongly recommended not to use global
1456 variables in programs loaded this way. An independent copy is loaded and
1457 initialized for each thread, everything is done sequentially and in the
1458 thread's numeric order from 1 to nbthread. If some operations need to be
1459 performed only once, the program should check the "core.thread" variable to
1460 figure what thread is being initialized. Programs loaded this way will run
1461 concurrently on all threads and will be highly scalable. This is the
1462 recommended way to load simple functions that register sample-fetches,
1463 converters, actions or services once it is certain the program doesn't depend
1464 on global variables. For the sake of simplicity, the directive is available
1465 even if only one thread is used and even if threads are disabled (in which
1466 case it will be equivalent to lua-load). This directive can be used multiple
1467 times.
1468
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001469lua-prepend-path <string> [<type>]
1470 Prepends the given string followed by a semicolon to Lua's package.<type>
1471 variable.
1472 <type> must either be "path" or "cpath". If <type> is not given it defaults
1473 to "path".
1474
1475 Lua's paths are semicolon delimited lists of patterns that specify how the
1476 `require` function attempts to find the source file of a library. Question
1477 marks (?) within a pattern will be replaced by module name. The path is
1478 evaluated left to right. This implies that paths that are prepended later
1479 will be checked earlier.
1480
1481 As an example by specifying the following path:
1482
1483 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?/init.lua
1484 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?.lua
1485
1486 When `require "example"` is being called Lua will first attempt to load the
1487 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example.lua script, if that does not exist the
1488 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example/init.lua will be attempted and the default
1489 paths if that does not exist either.
1490
1491 See https://www.lua.org/pil/8.1.html for the details within the Lua
1492 documentation.
1493
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001494master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001495 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1496 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1497 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001498 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001499 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
1500 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001501 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1502 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1503 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1504 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1505 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001506
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001507 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001508
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001509mworker-max-reloads <number>
1510 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001511 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001512 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1513 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1514 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1515
Willy Tarreauf42d7942020-10-20 11:54:49 +02001516nbproc <number> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001517 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
1518 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
1519 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001520 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
1521 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreauf42d7942020-10-20 11:54:49 +02001522 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. This directive is deprecated
1523 and scheduled for removal in 2.5. Please use "nbthread" instead. See also
1524 "daemon" and "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001525
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001526nbthread <number>
1527 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +01001528 makes haproxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
1529 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
1530 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
1531 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
1532 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001533 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
1534 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
1535 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
1536 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
1537 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
1538 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
1539 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001540
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001541pidfile <pidfile>
MIZUTA Takeshic32f3942020-08-26 13:46:19 +09001542 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile> when daemon mode or writes PID
1543 of master process into file <pidfile> when master-worker mode. This option is
1544 equivalent to the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to
1545 the user starting the process. See also "daemon" and "master-worker".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001546
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02001547pp2-never-send-local
1548 A bug in the PROXY protocol v2 implementation was present in HAProxy up to
1549 version 2.1, causing it to emit a PROXY command instead of a LOCAL command
1550 for health checks. This is particularly minor but confuses some servers'
1551 logs. Sadly, the bug was discovered very late and revealed that some servers
1552 which possibly only tested their PROXY protocol implementation against
1553 HAProxy fail to properly handle the LOCAL command, and permanently remain in
1554 the "down" state when HAProxy checks them. When this happens, it is possible
1555 to enable this global option to revert to the older (bogus) behavior for the
1556 time it takes to contact the affected components' vendors and get them fixed.
1557 This option is disabled by default and acts on all servers having the
1558 "send-proxy-v2" statement.
1559
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001560presetenv <name> <value>
1561 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1562 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1563 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1564 and "unsetenv".
1565
1566resetenv [<name> ...]
1567 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1568 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1569 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1570 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1571 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1572 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1573 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1574 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1575
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001576stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001577 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
1578 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
1579 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
1580 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1581 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1582 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001583 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001584 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1585 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1586 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1587 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001588
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001589server-state-base <directory>
1590 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001591 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1592 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001593
1594server-state-file <file>
1595 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1596 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1597 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1598 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1599 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1600 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1601 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1602 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001603 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1604 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001605
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01001606set-var <var-name> <expr>
1607 Sets the process-wide variable '<var-name>' to the result of the evaluation
1608 of the sample expression <expr>. The variable '<var-name>' may only be a
1609 process-wide variable (using the 'proc.' prefix). It works exactly like the
1610 'set-var' action in TCP or HTTP rules except that the expression is evaluated
1611 at configuration parsing time and that the variable is instantly set. The
1612 sample fetch functions and converters permitted in the expression are only
1613 those using internal data, typically 'int(value)' or 'str(value)'. It's is
1614 possible to reference previously allocated variables as well. These variables
1615 will then be readable (and modifiable) from the regular rule sets.
1616
1617 Example:
1618 global
1619 set-var proc.current_state str(primary)
1620 set-var proc.prio int(100)
1621 set-var proc.threshold int(200),sub(proc.prio)
1622
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001623setenv <name> <value>
1624 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1625 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1626 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1627 and "unsetenv".
1628
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001629set-dumpable
1630 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
William Dauchyec730982019-10-27 20:08:10 +01001631 developer's request. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly
1632 disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It has no impact on
1633 performance nor stability but will try hard to re-enable core dumps that were
1634 possibly disabled by file size limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations
1635 (ulimit -c), or "dumpability" of a process after changing its UID/GID (such
1636 as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by
1637 the current directory's permissions (check what directory the file is started
1638 from), the chroot directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily
1639 disable the chroot directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location),
1640 or any other system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are
1641 notorious for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable
1642 not even installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often,
1643 simply writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the
1644 issue. When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to
1645 re-appear, it's often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by
1646 issuing, for example, "kill -11" to the haproxy process and verify that it
1647 leaves a core where expected when dying.
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001648
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001649ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1650 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1651 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001652 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001653 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001654 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1655 information and recommendations see e.g.
1656 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1657 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1658 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1659 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001660
1661ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1662 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1663 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1664 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1665 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1666 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001667 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1668 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1669 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001670 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001671
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001672ssl-default-bind-curves <curves>
1673 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1674 the default string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve
1675 suite") that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format
1676 of the string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
1677 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
1678
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001679ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1680 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1681 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1682 keyword to see available options.
1683
1684 Example:
1685 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001686 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001687
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001688ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1689 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1690 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001691 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001692 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001693 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1694 information and recommendations see e.g.
1695 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1696 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1697 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1698 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1699 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001700
1701ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1702 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1703 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1704 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1705 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1706 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001707 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1708 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1709 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1710 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001711
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001712ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1713 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1714 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1715 keyword to see available options.
1716
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001717ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1718 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1719 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1720 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001721 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001722 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001723 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1724 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1725 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1726 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001727 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1728 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1729 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1730
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001731ssl-load-extra-del-ext
1732 This setting allows to configure the way HAProxy does the lookup for the
1733 extra SSL files. By default HAProxy adds a new extension to the filename.
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02001734 (ex: with "foobar.crt" load "foobar.crt.key"). With this option enabled,
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001735 HAProxy removes the extension before adding the new one (ex: with
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02001736 "foobar.crt" load "foobar.key").
1737
1738 Your crt file must have a ".crt" extension for this option to work.
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001739
1740 This option is not compatible with bundle extensions (.ecdsa, .rsa. .dsa)
1741 and won't try to remove them.
1742
1743 This option is disabled by default. See also "ssl-load-extra-files".
1744
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001745ssl-load-extra-files <none|all|bundle|sctl|ocsp|issuer|key>*
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001746 This setting alters the way HAProxy will look for unspecified files during
Jerome Magnin587be9c2020-09-07 11:55:57 +02001747 the loading of the SSL certificates associated to "bind" lines. It does not
1748 apply to certificates used for client authentication on "server" lines.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001749
1750 By default, HAProxy discovers automatically a lot of files not specified in
1751 the configuration, and you may want to disable this behavior if you want to
1752 optimize the startup time.
1753
1754 "none": Only load the files specified in the configuration. Don't try to load
1755 a certificate bundle if the file does not exist. In the case of a directory,
1756 it won't try to bundle the certificates if they have the same basename.
1757
1758 "all": This is the default behavior, it will try to load everything,
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001759 bundles, sctl, ocsp, issuer, key.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001760
1761 "bundle": When a file specified in the configuration does not exist, HAProxy
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001762 will try to load a "cert bundle".
1763
1764 Starting from HAProxy 2.3, the bundles are not loaded in the same OpenSSL
1765 certificate store, instead it will loads each certificate in a separate
1766 store which is equivalent to declaring multiple "crt". OpenSSL 1.1.1 is
1767 required to achieve this. Which means that bundles are now used only for
1768 backward compatibility and are not mandatory anymore to do an hybrid RSA/ECC
1769 bind configuration..
1770
1771 To associate these PEM files into a "cert bundle" that is recognized by
1772 haproxy, they must be named in the following way: All PEM files that are to
1773 be bundled must have the same base name, with a suffix indicating the key
1774 type. Currently, three suffixes are supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For
1775 example, if www.example.com has two PEM files, an RSA file and an ECDSA
1776 file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa" and "example.pem.ecdsa". The
1777 first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the suffix matters. To load
1778 this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
1779
1780 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
1781
1782 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
1783 a cert bundle.
1784
1785 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle as if they were configured
1786 separately in several "crt".
1787
1788 The bundle loading does not have an impact anymore on the directory loading
1789 since files are loading separately.
1790
1791 On the CLI, bundles are seen as separate files, and the bundle extension is
1792 required to commit them.
1793
William Dauchy57dd6f12020-10-06 15:22:37 +02001794 OCSP files (.ocsp), issuer files (.issuer), Certificate Transparency (.sctl)
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001795 as well as private keys (.key) are supported with multi-cert bundling.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001796
1797 "sctl": Try to load "<basename>.sctl" for each crt keyword.
1798
1799 "ocsp": Try to load "<basename>.ocsp" for each crt keyword.
1800
1801 "issuer": Try to load "<basename>.issuer" if the issuer of the OCSP file is
1802 not provided in the PEM file.
1803
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001804 "key": If the private key was not provided by the PEM file, try to load a
1805 file "<basename>.key" containing a private key.
1806
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001807 The default behavior is "all".
1808
1809 Example:
1810 ssl-load-extra-files bundle sctl
1811 ssl-load-extra-files sctl ocsp issuer
1812 ssl-load-extra-files none
1813
1814 See also: "crt", section 5.1 about bind options.
1815
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001816ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1817 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1818 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1819 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1820
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001821ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04001822 Self issued CA, aka x509 root CA, is the anchor for chain validation: as a
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001823 server is useless to send it, client must have it. Standard configuration
1824 need to not include such CA in PEM file. This option allows you to keep such
1825 CA in PEM file without sending it to the client. Use case is to provide
1826 issuer for ocsp without the need for '.issuer' file and be able to share it
1827 with 'issuers-chain-path'. This concerns all certificates without intermediate
1828 certificates. It's useless for BoringSSL, .issuer is ignored because ocsp
William Lallemand9a1d8392020-08-10 17:28:23 +02001829 bits does not need it. Requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.2.
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001830
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001831stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1832 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
1833 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
1834 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02001835 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02001836 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02001837
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001838 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
1839 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
1840 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001841
1842stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
1843 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
1844 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01001845 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001846
1847stats maxconn <connections>
1848 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
1849 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
1850
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001851uid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07001852 Changes the process's user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001853 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1854 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
1855 one. See also "gid" and "user".
1856
1857ulimit-n <number>
1858 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
1859 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
1860 option.
1861
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001862unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
1863 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
1864
1865 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
1866 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
1867 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
1868 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
1869 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
1870 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
1871 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
1872 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
1873 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
1874 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
1875
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001876unsetenv [<name> ...]
1877 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
1878 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
1879 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
1880 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
1881 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
1882 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
1883 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
1884
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001885user <user name>
1886 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
1887 See also "uid" and "group".
1888
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02001889node <name>
1890 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
1891
1892 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
1893 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
1894 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
1895 traffic.
1896
1897description <text>
1898 Add a text that describes the instance.
1899
1900 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1901 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1902 "<" and ">" characters.
1903
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100190451degrees-data-file <file path>
1905 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001906 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001907
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001908 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001909 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1910
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000191151degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001912 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1913 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1914 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1915
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001916 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001917 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1918
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200191951degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001920 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1921 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1922
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001923 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1924 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1925
192651degrees-cache-size <number>
1927 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1928 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1929 By default, this cache is disabled.
1930
1931 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001932 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1933
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001934wurfl-data-file <file path>
1935 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1936 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1937
1938 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1939 with USE_WURFL=1.
1940
1941wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1942 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1943 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1944 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1945
1946 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1947
1948 Valid WURFL properties are:
1949 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1950
1951 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1952 device.
1953
1954 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1955 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1956
1957 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1958 particular web request.
1959
1960 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1961 used Libwurfl API version.
1962
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001963 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1964 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1965
1966 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1967 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1968
1969 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1970
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001971 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1972 with USE_WURFL=1.
1973
1974wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1975 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1976 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1977
1978 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1979 with USE_WURFL=1.
1980
1981wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1982 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1983 thus before the chroot.
1984
1985 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1986 with USE_WURFL=1.
1987
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001988wurfl-cache-size <size>
1989 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
1990 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001991 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02001992 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001993
1994 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1995 with USE_WURFL=1.
1996
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01001997strict-limits
William Dauchya5194602020-03-28 19:29:58 +01001998 Makes process fail at startup when a setrlimit fails. Haproxy tries to set the
1999 best setrlimit according to what has been calculated. If it fails, it will
2000 emit a warning. This option is here to guarantee an explicit failure of
2001 haproxy when those limits fail. It is enabled by default. It may still be
2002 forcibly disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01002003
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020043.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002005-----------------------
2006
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01002007busy-polling
2008 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
2009 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
2010 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
2011 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
2012 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
2013 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
2014 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
2015 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
2016 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
2017 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
2018 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
2019 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
2020 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
2021 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
2022 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
2023 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
2024 "poll" pollers.
2025
William Dauchy3894d972019-12-28 15:36:02 +01002026 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
2027 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
2028 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
2029
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02002030max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
2031 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
2032 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
2033 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
2034 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
2035 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
2036 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
2037 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
2038 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
2039
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002040maxconn <number>
2041 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
2042 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
2043 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02002044 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
2045 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
2046 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
2047 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01002048 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
2049 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
2050 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
2051 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
2052 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
2053 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002054
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02002055maxconnrate <number>
2056 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
2057 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2058 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2059 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2060 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2061 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2062 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2063 fairness.
2064
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01002065maxcomprate <number>
2066 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002067 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01002068 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
2069 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
2070 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002071 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01002072 default value.
2073
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01002074maxcompcpuusage <number>
2075 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
2076 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
2077 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
2078 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
2079 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
2080 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
2081 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
2082 process down and from introducing high latencies.
2083
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002084maxpipes <number>
2085 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
2086 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
2087 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
2088 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
2089 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
2090 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
2091
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02002092maxsessrate <number>
2093 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
2094 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2095 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2096 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2097 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2098 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2099 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2100 fairness.
2101
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002102maxsslconn <number>
2103 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
2104 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
2105 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
2106 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
2107 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
2108 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
2109 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01002110 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
2111 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
2112 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
2113 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
2114 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
2115 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
2116 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002117
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02002118maxsslrate <number>
2119 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
2120 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
2121 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
2122 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
2123 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
2124 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
2125 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
2126 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
2127 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
2128 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
2129
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01002130maxzlibmem <number>
2131 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
2132 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
2133 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01002134 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
2135 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
2136 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
2137
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002138noepoll
2139 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
2140 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01002141 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002142
2143nokqueue
2144 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
2145 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
2146 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
2147
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002148noevports
2149 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
2150 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
2151 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
2152 also "nopoll".
2153
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002154nopoll
2155 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
2156 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002157 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002158 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
2159 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002160
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002161nosplice
2162 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002163 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002164 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002165 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002166 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
2167 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
2168 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
2169 "option splice-response".
2170
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002171nogetaddrinfo
2172 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
2173 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
2174
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00002175noreuseport
2176 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
2177 command line argument "-dR".
2178
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002179profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
2180 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
2181 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
2182 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
2183 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002184 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002185 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
2186 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
2187 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
2188 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
2189
2190 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
2191 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
2192 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
2193 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
2194 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01002195 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
2196 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
2197 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
2198 CLI.
2199
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002200spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09002201 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
2202 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
2203 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
2204 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
2205 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
2206 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002207
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002208ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002209 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002210 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002211 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
2212 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
2213 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
2214 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
2215 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002216 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
2217 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002218 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
2219 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
2220 openssl configuration file uses:
2221 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
2222
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002223ssl-mode-async
2224 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02002225 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002226 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
2227 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
2228 haproxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002229 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002230 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002231
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002232tune.buffers.limit <number>
2233 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
2234 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
2235 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
2236 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
2237 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002238 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002239 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
2240 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
2241 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
2242 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
2243 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
2244 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
2245 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
2246 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
2247 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
2248
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01002249tune.buffers.reserve <number>
2250 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
2251 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
2252 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
2253 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
2254
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002255tune.bufsize <number>
2256 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
2257 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
2258 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
2259 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
2260 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
2261 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
2262 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01002263 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
2264 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
2265 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04002266 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01002267 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
2268 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
2269 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002270
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +01002271tune.chksize <number> (deprecated)
2272 This option is deprecated and ignored.
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02002273
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01002274tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
2275 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
2276 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
2277 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
2278 this value. The default value is 1.
2279
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01002280tune.fail-alloc
2281 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
2282 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
2283 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
2284 gracefully.
2285
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02002286tune.fd.edge-triggered { on | off } [ EXPERIMENTAL ]
2287 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the edge-triggered polling mode for FDs
2288 that support it. This is currently only support with epoll. It may noticeably
2289 reduce the number of epoll_ctl() calls and slightly improve performance in
2290 certain scenarios. This is still experimental, it may result in frozen
2291 connections if bugs are still present, and is disabled by default.
2292
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02002293tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
2294 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
2295 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
2296 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
2297 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
2298 change it.
2299
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002300tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
2301 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002302 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from haproxy. This setting
2303 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002304 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
2305 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
2306 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
2307 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
2308 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
2309
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02002310tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
2311 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
2312 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
2313 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
2314 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
2315 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
2316 client may create as many streams as allocatable by haproxy. It is highly
2317 recommended not to change this value.
2318
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002319tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
2320 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that haproxy announces it is willing to
2321 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
2322 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, haproxy will not announce support
2323 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
2324 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
2325 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
2326 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
2327
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002328tune.http.cookielen <number>
2329 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
2330 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
2331 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
2332 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
2333 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
2334 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
2335 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
2336 to change this value.
2337
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002338tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002339 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
2340 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002341 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002342 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002343 configuration directives too.
2344 The default value is 1024.
2345
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002346tune.http.maxhdr <number>
2347 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
2348 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
2349 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
2350 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
2351 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
2352 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02002353 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
2354 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
2355 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002356
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002357tune.idle-pool.shared { on | off }
2358 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') sharing of idle connection pools between
2359 threads for a same server. The default is to share them between threads in
2360 order to minimize the number of persistent connections to a server, and to
2361 optimize the connection reuse rate. But to help with debugging or when
2362 suspecting a bug in HAProxy around connection reuse, it can be convenient to
2363 forcefully disable this idle pool sharing between multiple threads, and force
Willy Tarreau0784db82021-02-19 11:45:22 +01002364 this option to "off". The default is on. It is strongly recommended against
2365 disabling this option without setting a conservative value on "pool-low-conn"
2366 for all servers relying on connection reuse to achieve a high performance
2367 level, otherwise connections might be closed very often as the thread count
2368 increases.
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002369
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002370tune.idletimer <timeout>
2371 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
2372 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
2373 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
2374 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
2375 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
2376 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002377 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002378 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002379 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
2380
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01002381tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
2382 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
2383 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
2384 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
2385 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
2386 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
2387 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
2388 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
2389 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
2390 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
2391
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002392tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
2393 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01002394 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002395 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
2396 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002397 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002398 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
2399 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
2400
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01002401tune.lua.maxmem
2402 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
2403 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
2404 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
2405 memory.
2406
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002407tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
2408 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002409 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2410 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002411 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002412
2413tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
2414 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
2415 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
2416 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
2417 check servers.
2418
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002419tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
2420 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
2421 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2422 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002423 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002424
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002425tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01002426 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
2427 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
Willy Tarreau66161322021-02-19 15:50:27 +01002428 used to give better performance at high connection rates, though this is not
2429 the case anymore with the multi-queue. This value applies individually to
2430 each listener, so that the number of processes a listener is bound to is
2431 taken into account. This value defaults to 4 which showed best results. If a
2432 significantly higher value was inherited from an ancient config, it might be
2433 worth removing it as it will both increase performance and lower response
2434 time. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice the number of processes
2435 the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1 completely disables the
2436 limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002437
2438tune.maxpollevents <number>
2439 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
2440 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
2441 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
2442 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
2443 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
2444
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002445tune.maxrewrite <number>
2446 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
2447 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
2448 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
2449 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
2450 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
2451 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
2452 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
2453 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
2454 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
2455 bufsize.
2456
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002457tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
2458 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
2459 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
2460 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
2461 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
2462 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
2463 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
2464 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
2465 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
2466 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau403bfbb2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02002467 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
2468 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002469 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
2470 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
2471 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
2472 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
2473 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
2474 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
2475 setting this parameter to 0.
2476
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02002477tune.pipesize <number>
2478 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
2479 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
2480 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
2481 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
2482 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
2483 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
2484
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002485tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
2486 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
2487 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
2488 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
2489 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
2490 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
2491 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002492 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002493
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02002494tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
2495 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
2496 haproxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors haproxy can
2497 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
2498 default is 20.
2499
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002500tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
2501tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
2502 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
2503 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2504 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002505 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002506 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002507 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2508 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2509
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002510tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002511 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002512 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
2513 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
2514 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
2515 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
2516
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002517tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002518 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Willy Tarreau060a7612021-03-10 11:06:26 +01002519 tasks. The default value depends on the number of threads but sits between 35
2520 and 280, which tend to show the highest request rates and lowest latencies.
2521 Increasing it may incur latency when dealing with I/Os, making it too small
2522 can incur extra overhead. Higher thread counts benefit from lower values.
2523 When experimenting with much larger values, it may be useful to also enable
2524 tune.sched.low-latency and possibly tune.fd.edge-triggered to limit the
2525 maximum latency to the lowest possible.
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02002526
2527tune.sched.low-latency { on | off }
2528 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the low-latency task scheduler. By default
2529 haproxy processes tasks from several classes one class at a time as this is
2530 the most efficient. But when running with large values of tune.runqueue-depth
2531 this can have a measurable effect on request or connection latency. When this
2532 low-latency setting is enabled, tasks of lower priority classes will always
2533 be executed before other ones if they exist. This will permit to lower the
2534 maximum latency experienced by new requests or connections in the middle of
2535 massive traffic, at the expense of a higher impact on this large traffic.
2536 For regular usage it is better to leave this off. The default value is off.
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002537
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002538tune.sndbuf.client <number>
2539tune.sndbuf.server <number>
2540 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
2541 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2542 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002543 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002544 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002545 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2546 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2547 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
2548 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
2549 notifying haproxy again.
2550
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002551tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002552 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
William Dauchy9a4bbfe2021-02-12 15:58:46 +01002553 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate. An
2554 encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks depending
2555 on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately 200 bytes of
2556 memory (based on `sizeof(struct sh_ssl_sess_hdr) + SHSESS_BLOCK_MIN_SIZE`
2557 calculation used for `shctx_init` function). The default value may be forced
2558 at build time, otherwise defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most
2559 idle entries are purged and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence
2560 of such a purge, hence the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring
2561 that all users keep their session as long as possible. All entries are
2562 pre-allocated upon startup and are shared between all processes if "nbproc"
2563 is greater than 1. Setting this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002564
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002565tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02002566 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002567 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
2568 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
2569 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
2570 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
2571 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
2572
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002573tune.ssl.keylog { on | off }
2574 This option activates the logging of the TLS keys. It should be used with
2575 care as it will consume more memory per SSL session and could decrease
2576 performances. This is disabled by default.
2577
2578 These sample fetches should be used to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE that is
2579 required to decipher traffic with wireshark.
2580
2581 https://developer.mozilla.org/en-US/docs/Mozilla/Projects/NSS/Key_Log_Format
2582
2583 The SSLKEYLOG is a series of lines which are formatted this way:
2584
2585 <Label> <space> <ClientRandom> <space> <Secret>
2586
2587 The ClientRandom is provided by the %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] sample
2588 fetch, the secret and the Label could be find in the array below. You need
2589 to generate a SSLKEYLOGFILE with all the labels in this array.
2590
2591 The following sample fetches are hexadecimal strings and does not need to be
2592 converted.
2593
2594 SSLKEYLOGFILE Label | Sample fetches for the Secrets
2595 --------------------------------|-----------------------------------------
2596 CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret]
2597 CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret]
2598 SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret]
2599 CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0]
2600 SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0]
William Lallemandd742b6c2020-07-07 10:14:56 +02002601 EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_exporter_secret]
2602 EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret]
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002603
2604 This is only available with OpenSSL 1.1.1, and useful with TLS1.3 session.
2605
2606 If you want to generate the content of a SSLKEYLOGFILE with TLS < 1.3, you
2607 only need this line:
2608
2609 "CLIENT_RANDOM %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] %[ssl_fc_session_key,hex]"
2610
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002611tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
2612 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002613 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002614 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
2615 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
2616 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
2617 being used for too long.
2618
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002619tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
2620 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
2621 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
2622 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
2623 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
2624 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
2625 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
2626 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
2627 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
2628 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
2629 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002630 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002631 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002632
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002633tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
2634 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
2635 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
2636 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
2637 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
Willy Tarreau3ba77d22020-05-08 09:31:18 +02002638 this maximum value. Default value if 2048. Only 1024 or higher values are
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002639 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
2640 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002641 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
2642 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002643
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02002644tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
2645 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
2646 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
2647 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
2648 1000 entries.
2649
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01002650tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
2651 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
2652 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
2653 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
2654
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002655tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002656tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002657tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
2658tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
2659tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002660 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
2661 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
2662 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
2663 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
2664 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
2665 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
2666 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
2667 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002668
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01002669 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
2670 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
2671 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
2672 all available space is consumed.
2673 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
2674 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
2675 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002676
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002677tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
2678 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002679 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002680 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002681 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002682 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
2683
2684tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
2685 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
2686 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002687 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
2688 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002689
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026903.3. Debugging
2691--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002692
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002693quiet
2694 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
2695 line argument "-q".
2696
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02002697zero-warning
2698 When this option is set, haproxy will refuse to start if any warning was
2699 emitted while processing the configuration. It is highly recommended to set
2700 this option on configurations that are not changed often, as it helps detect
2701 subtle mistakes and keep the configuration clean and forward-compatible. Note
2702 that "haproxy -c" will also report errors in such a case. This option is
2703 equivalent to command line argument "-dW".
2704
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002705
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010027063.4. Userlists
2707--------------
2708It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
2709http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
2710it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
2711
2712userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002713 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002714 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
2715
2716group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002717 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002718 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
2719 proceeded by "users" keyword.
2720
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002721user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
2722 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002723 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
2724 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002725 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
2726 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
2727 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
2728 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002729
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002730 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
2731 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
2732 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
2733 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
2734 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
2735 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
2736 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
2737 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in haproxy's
2738 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002739
2740 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002741 userlist L1
2742 group G1 users tiger,scott
2743 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002744
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002745 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
2746 user scott insecure-password elgato
2747 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002748
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002749 userlist L2
2750 group G1
2751 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002752
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002753 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
2754 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
2755 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002756
2757 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002758
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002759
27603.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002761----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002762It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
2763several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
2764instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
2765values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
2766automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
2767In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
2768using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
2769tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
2770reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
2771Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
2772that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
2773each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002774
2775peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002776 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002777 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
2778
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002779bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2780 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
2781 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
2782
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002783disabled
2784 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
2785 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
2786 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
2787
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002788default-bind [param*]
2789 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
2790
2791default-server [param*]
2792 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
2793
2794 Arguments:
2795 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2796 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
2797 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
2798 details.
2799
2800
2801 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
2802
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002803enable
2804 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
2805
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01002806log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailleb6f759b2019-11-05 09:57:45 +01002807 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
2808 "peers" sections support the same "log" keyword as for the proxies to
2809 log information about the "peers" listener. See "log" option for proxies for
2810 more details.
2811
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002812peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002813 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
2814 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02002815 using "-L" command line option or "localpeer" global configuration setting),
2816 haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer connection on <ip>:<port>.
2817 Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to in order to join the
2818 remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to identify and
2819 validate the remote peer on the server side.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002820
2821 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
2822 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
2823
2824 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02002825 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument or the "localpeer"
2826 global configuration setting to change the local peer name. This makes it
2827 easier to maintain coherent configuration files across all peers.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002828
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002829 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
2830 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002831
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002832 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
2833 "server" keyword explanation below).
2834
2835server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02002836 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002837 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
2838 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
2839 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
2840 of this "peers" section).
2841 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
2842
2843
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002844 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002845 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002846 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002847 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
2848 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
2849 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002850
2851 backend mybackend
2852 mode tcp
2853 balance roundrobin
2854 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
2855 stick on src
2856
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01002857 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2858 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002859
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002860 Example:
2861 peers mypeers
2862 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
2863 default-server ssl verify none
2864 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
2865 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002866
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002867
2868table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
2869 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
2870
2871 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
2872 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002873 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002874 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
2875 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
2876 "stick-table" keyword).
2877
2878 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
2879 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
2880 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
2881 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
2882 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
2883 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
2884 of the stick-table name as follows:
2885
2886 peers mypeers
2887 peer A ...
2888 peer B ...
2889 table t1 ...
2890
2891 frontend fe1
2892 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
2893
2894 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
2895 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
2896
2897 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
2898 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
2899 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
2900 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
2901 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
2902 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
2903 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
2904
2905 peers mypeers
2906 peer A ...
2907 peer B ...
2908 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
2909
2910 backend t1
2911 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
2912
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04002913 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01002914 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
2915 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
2916
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090029173.6. Mailers
2918------------
2919It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
2920If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
2921in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
2922
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02002923mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002924 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
2925 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
2926
2927mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
2928 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
2929
2930 Example:
2931 mailers mymailers
2932 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
2933 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
2934
2935 backend mybackend
2936 mode tcp
2937 balance roundrobin
2938
2939 email-alert mailers mymailers
2940 email-alert from test1@horms.org
2941 email-alert to test2@horms.org
2942
2943 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
2944 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
2945
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01002946timeout mail <time>
2947 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
2948 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
2949 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
2950 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
2951
2952 Example:
2953 mailers mymailers
2954 timeout mail 20s
2955 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09002956
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020029573.7. Programs
2958-------------
2959In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
2960master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
2961managed the same way as the workers.
2962
2963During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
2964sequence as a worker:
2965
2966 - the master is re-executed
2967 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
2968 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
2969 instance of the program
2970
2971During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
2972
2973program <name>
2974 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
2975 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
2976 the management guide).
2977
2978command <command> [arguments*]
2979 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
2980 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
2981 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
2982 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
2983
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08002984user <user name>
2985 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
2986 See also "group".
2987
2988group <group name>
2989 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
2990 See also "user".
2991
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02002992option start-on-reload
2993no option start-on-reload
2994 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
2995 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
2996 program section.
2997
2998
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +010029993.8. HTTP-errors
3000----------------
3001
3002It is possible to globally declare several groups of HTTP errors, to be
3003imported afterwards in any proxy section. Same group may be referenced at
3004several places and can be fully or partially imported.
3005
3006http-errors <name>
3007 Create a new http-errors group with the name <name>. It is an independent
3008 section that may be referenced by one or more proxies using its name.
3009
3010errorfile <code> <file>
3011 Associate a file contents to an HTTP error code
3012
3013 Arguments :
3014 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02003015 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01003016 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003017
3018 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
3019 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
3020 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
3021 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3022 before any chroot is performed.
3023
3024 Please referrers to "errorfile" keyword in section 4 for details.
3025
3026 Example:
3027 http-errors website-1
3028 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/400.http
3029 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/404.http
3030 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
3031
3032 http-errors website-2
3033 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/400.http
3034 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/404.http
3035 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
3036
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +020030373.9. Rings
3038----------
3039
3040It is possible to globally declare ring-buffers, to be used as target for log
3041servers or traces.
3042
3043ring <ringname>
3044 Creates a new ring-buffer with name <ringname>.
3045
3046description <text>
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04003047 The description is an optional description string of the ring. It will
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003048 appear on CLI. By default, <name> is reused to fill this field.
3049
3050format <format>
3051 Format used to store events into the ring buffer.
3052
3053 Arguments:
3054 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
3055 one of the following :
3056
3057 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
3058 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
3059 designed to be used with a local log server.
3060
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01003061 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
3062 field is stripped. This is the default.
3063 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
3064 rfc3164.
3065
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003066 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
3067 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
3068 used in containers or during development, where the severity
3069 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr). This
3070 is the default.
3071
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01003072 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003073 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
3074
3075 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
3076 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
3077
3078 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
3079 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
3080 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
3081 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
3082 logger consumes.
3083
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02003084 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between angle
3085 brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time,
3086 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used
3087 with a local log server.
3088
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003089 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
3090 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
3091 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
3092 used with a local log server.
3093
3094maxlen <length>
3095 The maximum length of an event message stored into the ring,
3096 including formatted header. If an event message is longer than
3097 <length>, it will be truncated to this length.
3098
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003099server <name> <address> [param*]
3100 Used to configure a syslog tcp server to forward messages from ring buffer.
3101 This supports for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph. Some of
3102 these parameters are irrelevant for "ring" sections. Important point: there
3103 is little reason to add more than one server to a ring, because all servers
3104 will receive the exact same copy of the ring contents, and as such the ring
3105 will progress at the speed of the slowest server. If one server does not
3106 respond, it will prevent old messages from being purged and may block new
3107 messages from being inserted into the ring. The proper way to send messages
3108 to multiple servers is to use one distinct ring per log server, not to
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003109 attach multiple servers to the same ring. Note that specific server directive
3110 "log-proto" is used to set the protocol used to send messages.
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003111
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003112size <size>
3113 This is the optional size in bytes for the ring-buffer. Default value is
3114 set to BUFSIZE.
3115
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003116timeout connect <timeout>
3117 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
3118
3119 Arguments :
3120 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
3121 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3122 as explained at the top of this document.
3123
3124timeout server <timeout>
3125 Set the maximum time for pending data staying into output buffer.
3126
3127 Arguments :
3128 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
3129 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3130 as explained at the top of this document.
3131
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003132 Example:
3133 global
3134 log ring@myring local7
3135
3136 ring myring
3137 description "My local buffer"
3138 format rfc3164
3139 maxlen 1200
3140 size 32764
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003141 timeout connect 5s
3142 timeout server 10s
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003143 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:6514 log-proto octet-count
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003144
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +020031453.10. Log forwarding
3146-------------------
3147
3148It is possible to declare one or multiple log forwarding section,
3149haproxy will forward all received log messages to a log servers list.
3150
3151log-forward <name>
3152 Creates a new log forwarder proxy identified as <name>.
3153
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003154backlog <conns>
3155 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3156 on connections accept.
3157
3158bind <addr> [param*]
3159 Used to configure a stream log listener to receive messages to forward.
Emeric Brunda46c1c2020-10-08 08:39:02 +02003160 This supports the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph including
3161 those about ssl but some statements such as "alpn" may be irrelevant for
3162 syslog protocol over TCP.
3163 Those listeners support both "Octet Counting" and "Non-Transparent-Framing"
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003164 modes as defined in rfc-6587.
3165
Willy Tarreau76aaa7f2020-09-16 15:07:22 +02003166dgram-bind <addr> [param*]
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003167 Used to configure a datagram log listener to receive messages to forward.
3168 Addresses must be in IPv4 or IPv6 form,followed by a port. This supports
3169 for some of the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph among which
3170 "interface", "namespace" or "transparent", the other ones being
Willy Tarreau26ff5da2020-09-16 15:22:19 +02003171 silently ignored as irrelevant for UDP/syslog case.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003172
3173log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01003174log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003175 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
3176 Used to configure target log servers. See more details on proxies
3177 documentation.
3178 If no format specified, haproxy tries to keep the incoming log format.
3179 Configured facility is ignored, except if incoming message does not
3180 present a facility but one is mandatory on the outgoing format.
3181 If there is no timestamp available in the input format, but the field
3182 exists in output format, haproxy will use the local date.
3183
3184 Example:
3185 global
3186 log stderr format iso local7
3187
3188 ring myring
3189 description "My local buffer"
3190 format rfc5424
3191 maxlen 1200
3192 size 32764
3193 timeout connect 5s
3194 timeout server 10s
3195 # syslog tcp server
3196 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:514 log-proto octet-count
3197
3198 log-forward sylog-loadb
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003199 dgram-bind 127.0.0.1:1514
3200 bind 127.0.0.1:1514
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003201 # all messages on stderr
3202 log global
3203 # all messages on local tcp syslog server
3204 log ring@myring local0
3205 # load balance messages on 4 udp syslog servers
3206 log 127.0.0.1:10001 sample 1:4 local0
3207 log 127.0.0.1:10002 sample 2:4 local0
3208 log 127.0.0.1:10003 sample 3:4 local0
3209 log 127.0.0.1:10004 sample 4:4 local0
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003210
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003211maxconn <conns>
3212 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a log forwarder.
3213 10 is the default.
3214
3215timeout client <timeout>
3216 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
3217
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020032184. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003219----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003220
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003221Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01003222 - defaults [<name>] [ from <defaults_name> ]
3223 - frontend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
3224 - backend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
3225 - listen <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003226
3227A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
3228connections.
3229
3230A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
3231to forward incoming connections.
3232
3233A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
3234parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
3235
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01003236A "defaults" section resets all settings to the documented ones and presets new
3237ones for use by subsequent sections. All of "frontend", "backend" and "listen"
3238sections always take their initial settings from a defaults section, by default
3239the latest one that appears before the newly created section. It is possible to
3240explicitly designate a specific "defaults" section to load the initial settings
3241from by indicating its name on the section line after the optional keyword
3242"from". While "defaults" section do not impose a name, this use is encouraged
3243for better readability. It is also the only way to designate a specific section
3244to use instead of the default previous one. Since "defaults" section names are
3245optional, by default a very permissive check is applied on their name and these
3246are even permitted to overlap. However if a "defaults" section is referenced by
3247any other section, its name must comply with the syntax imposed on all proxy
3248names, and this name must be unique among the defaults sections. Please note
3249that regardless of what is currently permitted, it is recommended to avoid
3250duplicate section names in general and to respect the same syntax as for proxy
3251names. This rule might be enforced in a future version.
3252
3253Note that it is even possible for a defaults section to take its initial
3254settings from another one, and as such, inherit settings across multiple levels
3255of defaults sections. This can be convenient to establish certain configuration
3256profiles to carry groups of default settings (e.g. TCP vs HTTP or short vs long
3257timeouts) but can quickly become confusing to follow.
3258
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003259All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
3260'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
3261case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
3262
3263Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
3264logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
3265proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
3266However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
3267name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
3268
3269Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
3270and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003271bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003272protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
3273modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
3274arbitrary criteria.
3275
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003276In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
3277a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto21ad3152019-12-10 13:11:17 +01003278the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003279
3280 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
3281 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
3282 between responses and new requests.
3283
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003284 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
3285 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
3286 client-facing connection remains open.
3287
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003288 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
3289 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003290
3291The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
3292frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
3293following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003294weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003295
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003296 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003297
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003298 | KAL | SCL | CLO
3299 ----+-----+-----+----
3300 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
3301 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003302 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
3303 ----+-----+-----+----
3304 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003305
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003306It is possible to chain a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. It is pointless if
3307only HTTP traffic is handled. But It may be used to handle several protocols
3308into the same frontend. It this case, the client's connection is first handled
3309as a raw tcp connection before being upgraded to HTTP. Before the upgrade, the
3310content processings are performend on raw data. Once upgraded, data are parsed
3311and stored using an internal representation called HTX and it is no longer
3312possible to rely on raw representation. There is no way to go back.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003313
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003314There are two kind of upgrades, in-place upgrades and destructive upgrades. The
3315first ones concern the TCP to HTTP/1 upgrades. In HTTP/1, the request
3316processings are serialized, thus the applicative stream can be preserved. The
3317second ones concern the TCP to HTTP/2 upgrades. Because it is a multiplexed
3318protocol, the applicative stream cannot be associated to any HTTP/2 stream and
3319is destroyed. New applicative streams are then created when HAProxy receives
3320new HTTP/2 streams at the lower level, in the H2 multiplexer. It is important
3321to understand this difference because that drastically change the way to
3322process data. When an HTTP/1 upgrade is performed, the content processings
3323already performed on raw data are neither lost nor reexecuted while for an
3324HTTP/2 upgrade, applicative streams are distinct and all frontend rules are
3325evaluated systematically on each one. And as said, the first stream, the TCP
3326one, is destroyed, but only after the frontend rules were evaluated.
3327
3328There is another importnat point to understand when HTTP processings are
3329performed from a TCP proxy. While HAProxy is able to parse HTTP/1 in-fly from
3330tcp-request content rules, it is not possible for HTTP/2. Only the HTTP/2
3331preface can be parsed. This is a huge limitation regarding the HTTP content
3332analysis in TCP. Concretely it is only possible to know if received data are
3333HTTP. For instance, it is not possible to choose a backend based on the Host
3334header value while it is trivial in HTTP/1. Hopefully, there is a solution to
3335mitigate this drawback.
3336
3337It exists two way to perform HTTP upgrades. The first one, the historical
3338method, is to select an HTTP backend. The upgrade happens when the backend is
3339set. Thus, for in-place upgrades, only the backend configuration is considered
3340in the HTTP data processing. For destructive upgrades, the applicative stream
3341is destroyed, thus its processing is stopped. With this method, possibilities
3342to choose a backend with an HTTP/2 connection are really limited, as mentioned
3343above, and a bit useless because the stream is destroyed. The second method is
3344to upgrade during the tcp-request content rules evaluation, thanks to the
3345"switch-mode http" action. In this case, the upgrade is performed in the
3346frontend context and it is possible to define HTTP directives in this
3347frontend. For in-place upgrades, it offers all the power of the HTTP analysis
3348as soon as possible. It is not that far from an HTTP frontend. For destructive
3349upgrades, it does not change anything except it is useless to choose a backend
3350on limited information. It is of course the recommended method. Thus, testing
3351the request protocol from the tcp-request content rules to perform an HTTP
3352upgrade is enough. All the remaining HTTP manipulation may be moved to the
3353frontend http-request ruleset. But keep in mind that tcp-request content rules
3354remains evaluated on each streams, that can't be changed.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003355
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020033564.1. Proxy keywords matrix
3357--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003358
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003359The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
3360limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
3361they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
3362limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003363marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003364option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02003365and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
3366with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
3367specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003368
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003369
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003370 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
3371------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
3372acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003373backlog X X X -
3374balance X - X X
3375bind - X X -
3376bind-process X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003377capture cookie - X X -
3378capture request header - X X -
3379capture response header - X X -
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003380clitcpka-cnt X X X -
3381clitcpka-idle X X X -
3382clitcpka-intvl X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003383compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003384cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003385declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003386default-server X - X X
3387default_backend X X X -
3388description - X X X
3389disabled X X X X
3390dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003391email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003392email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003393email-alert mailers X X X X
3394email-alert myhostname X X X X
3395email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003396enabled X X X X
3397errorfile X X X X
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003398errorfiles X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003399errorloc X X X X
3400errorloc302 X X X X
3401-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3402errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003403force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003404filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003405fullconn X - X X
3406grace X X X X
3407hash-type X - X X
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01003408http-after-response - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003409http-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003410http-check connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003411http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003412http-check expect X - X X
Peter Gervai8912ae62020-06-11 18:26:36 +02003413http-check send X - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02003414http-check send-state X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003415http-check set-var X - X X
3416http-check unset-var X - X X
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02003417http-error X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003418http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003419http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02003420http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02003421http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003422id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003423ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003424load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003425log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01003426log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02003427log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01003428log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02003429max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003430maxconn X X X -
3431mode X X X X
3432monitor fail - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003433monitor-uri X X X -
3434option abortonclose (*) X - X X
3435option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
3436option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
3437option allbackups (*) X - X X
3438option checkcache (*) X - X X
3439option clitcpka (*) X X X -
3440option contstats (*) X X X -
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02003441option disable-h2-upgrade (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003442option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
3443option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003444-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3445option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02003446option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
3447option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02003448option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02003449option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003450option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02003451option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02003452option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003453option http-server-close (*) X X X X
3454option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
3455option httpchk X - X X
3456option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01003457option httplog X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003458option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003459option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02003460option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003461option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003462option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
3463option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
3464option logasap (*) X X X -
3465option mysql-check X - X X
3466option nolinger (*) X X X X
3467option originalto X X X X
3468option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02003469option pgsql-check X - X X
3470option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003471option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02003472option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003473option smtpchk X - X X
3474option socket-stats (*) X X X -
3475option splice-auto (*) X X X X
3476option splice-request (*) X X X X
3477option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01003478option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003479option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
3480option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
3481-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01003482option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003483option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
3484option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
3485option tcpka X X X X
3486option tcplog X X X X
3487option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003488external-check command X - X X
3489external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003490persist rdp-cookie X - X X
3491rate-limit sessions X X X -
3492redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003493-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003494retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02003495retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003496server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003497server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02003498server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003499source X - X X
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003500srvtcpka-cnt X - X X
3501srvtcpka-idle X - X X
3502srvtcpka-intvl X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02003503stats admin - X X X
3504stats auth X X X X
3505stats enable X X X X
3506stats hide-version X X X X
3507stats http-request - X X X
3508stats realm X X X X
3509stats refresh X X X X
3510stats scope X X X X
3511stats show-desc X X X X
3512stats show-legends X X X X
3513stats show-node X X X X
3514stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003515-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3516stick match - - X X
3517stick on - - X X
3518stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02003519stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01003520stick-table - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003521tcp-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003522tcp-check connect X - X X
3523tcp-check expect X - X X
3524tcp-check send X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003525tcp-check send-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003526tcp-check send-binary X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003527tcp-check send-binary-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003528tcp-check set-var X - X X
3529tcp-check unset-var X - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02003530tcp-request connection - X X -
3531tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02003532tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02003533tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02003534tcp-response content - - X X
3535tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003536timeout check X - X X
3537timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003538timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003539timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003540timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
3541timeout http-request X X X X
3542timeout queue X - X X
3543timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003544timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003545timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02003546timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003547transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01003548unique-id-format X X X -
3549unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003550use_backend - X X -
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02003551use-fcgi-app - - X X
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02003552use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003553------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
3554 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003555
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003556
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020035574.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
3558---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003559
3560This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
3561
3562
3563acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
3564 Declare or complete an access list.
3565 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3566 no | yes | yes | yes
3567 Example:
3568 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
3569 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
3570 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
3571
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003572 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003573
3574
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003575backlog <conns>
3576 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3577 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3578 yes | yes | yes | no
3579 Arguments :
3580 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
3581 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003582 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003583
3584 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
3585 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
3586 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
3587 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
3588 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
3589 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
3590 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
3591 backlog parameter.
3592
3593 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
3594 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
3595 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
3596
3597 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
3598
3599
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003600balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003601balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003602 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
3603 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3604 yes | no | yes | yes
3605 Arguments :
3606 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
3607 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
3608 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
3609 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
3610
3611 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3612 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
3613 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
3614 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003615 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08003616 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003617 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
3618 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
3619 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
3620 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
3621 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
3622 it, so that you don't worry.
3623
3624 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3625 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
3626 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
3627 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
3628 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
3629 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
3630 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
3631 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003632
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003633 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
3634 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
3635 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
3636 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
3637 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
3638 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
3639 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
Willy Tarreau8c855f62020-10-22 17:41:45 +02003640 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance. It will
3641 also consider the number of queued connections in addition to
3642 the established ones in order to minimize queuing.
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003643
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003644 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003645 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003646 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
3647 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003648 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003649 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
3650 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
3651 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
3652 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
3653 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003654 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
3655 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
3656 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
3657 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
3658 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
3659 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003660
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003661 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
3662 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
3663 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
3664 address will always reach the same server as long as no
3665 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
3666 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
3667 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
3668 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003669 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003670 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003671 static by default, which means that changing a server's
3672 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
3673 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003674
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003675 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
3676 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
3677 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
3678 the running servers. The result designates which server will
3679 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
3680 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
3681 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
3682 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
3683 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
3684 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3685 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3686 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003687
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003688 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003689 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
3690 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
3691 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
3692 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
3693 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
3694 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
3695 URIs start with a leading "/".
3696
3697 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
3698 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
3699 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
3700 evaluation stops when either is reached.
3701
Willy Tarreau57a37412020-09-23 08:56:29 +02003702 A "path-only" parameter indicates that the hashing key starts
3703 at the first '/' of the path. This can be used to ignore the
3704 authority part of absolute URIs, and to make sure that HTTP/1
3705 and HTTP/2 URIs will provide the same hash.
3706
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003707 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003708 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
3709
3710 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003711 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
3712 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003713 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
3714 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
3715 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
3716 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003717 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003718 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
3719 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003720
3721 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
3722 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
3723 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
3724 server will receive the request.
3725
3726 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
3727 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
3728 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
3729 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
3730 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003731 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
3732 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
3733 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003734
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003735 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
3736 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
3737 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
3738 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
3739 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003740
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003741 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003742 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
3743 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
3744 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
3745
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003746 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3747 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3748 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3749
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003750 random
3751 random(<draws>)
3752 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003753 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
3754 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
3755 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
3756 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003757 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
3758 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
3759 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
3760 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
3761 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
3762 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
3763 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
3764 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
3765 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
3766 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
3767 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
3768 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
3769 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
3770 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
3771 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
3772 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
3773 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
3774 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
3775 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
3776 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003777
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003778 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02003779 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003780 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
3781 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
3782 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
3783 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
3784 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
3785 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003786 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003787 used instead.
3788
3789 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
3790 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
3791 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
3792 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
3793
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003794 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3795 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3796 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3797
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003798 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09003799
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003800 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003801 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
3802 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003803
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01003804 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
3805 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
3806 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003807
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003808 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003809 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02003810 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
3811 NTLM relies on.
3812
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003813 Examples :
3814 balance roundrobin
3815 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003816 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003817 balance hdr(User-Agent)
3818 balance hdr(host)
3819 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003820
3821 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
3822 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
3823
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003824 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003825 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
3826 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
3827 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02003828 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003829
3830 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
3831 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
3832 defaults to 16 kB.
3833
3834 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
3835 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
3836
3837 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
3838 Round Robin.
3839
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00003840 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003841 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
3842 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
3843 actually appeared in the first chunk).
3844
3845 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
3846
3847 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003848 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003849 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
3850 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
3851 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003852
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003853 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003854
3855
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003856bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
3857bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003858 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
3859 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3860 no | yes | yes | no
3861 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01003862 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
3863 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
3864 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
3865 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01003866 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003867 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
3868 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
3869 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
3870 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
3871 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
3872 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02003873 - 'udp@' -> address is resolved as IPv4 or IPv6 and
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003874 protocol UDP is used. Currently those listeners are
3875 supported only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02003876 - 'udp4@' -> address is always IPv4 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003877 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
3878 only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02003879 - 'udp6@' -> address is always IPv6 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003880 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
3881 only in log-forward sections.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003882 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02003883 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
3884 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
3885 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
3886 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
3887 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
3888 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
3889 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01003890 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
3891 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
3892 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02003893 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
3894 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
3895 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
3896 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003897 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
3898 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
3899 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01003900
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003901 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
3902 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003903 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
3904 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
3905 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003906 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
3907 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
3908 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
3909 the range.
3910
3911 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
3912 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
3913 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
3914 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
3915 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
3916 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
3917 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003918 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01003919 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003920
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003921 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003922 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003923 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
3924 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
3925 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
3926 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
3927 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
3928 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
3929
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003930 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
3931 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
3932 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
3933 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003934
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003935 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
3936 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
3937 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
3938 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
3939 in a frontend.
3940
3941 Example :
3942 listen http_proxy
3943 bind :80,:443
3944 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003945 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003946
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003947 listen http_https_proxy
3948 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02003949 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02003950
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01003951 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
3952 bind ipv6@:80
3953 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
3954 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
3955
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003956 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003957 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003958
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02003959 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
3960 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
3961 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
3962 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
3963 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
3964
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01003965 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02003966 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003967
3968
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003969bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003970 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
3971 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3972 yes | yes | yes | yes
3973 Arguments :
3974 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
3975 may be used to override a default value.
3976
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003977 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003978 option may be combined with other numbers.
3979
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003980 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003981 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
3982 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
3983 missing from all processes.
3984
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003985 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01003986 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01003987 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
3988 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
3989 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
3990 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
3991 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02003992 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01003993
3994 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
3995 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
3996 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
3997 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
3998 and 'even' instances.
3999
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01004000 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
4001 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
4002 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
4003 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004004
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02004005 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
4006 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
4007
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02004008 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
4009 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
4010 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
4011
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004012 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
4013 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
4014
4015 Example :
4016 listen app_ip1
4017 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02004018 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004019
4020 listen app_ip2
4021 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02004022 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004023
4024 listen management
4025 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02004026 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004027
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01004028 listen management
4029 bind 10.0.0.4:80
4030 bind-process 1-4
4031
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02004032 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004033
4034
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004035capture cookie <name> len <length>
4036 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
4037 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4038 no | yes | yes | no
4039 Arguments :
4040 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
4041 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
4042 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
4043 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004044 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004045
4046 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
4047 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
4048 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
4049 right if it exceeds <length>.
4050
4051 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
4052 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
4053 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
4054 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
4055
4056 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
4057 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
4058 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
4059
4060 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
4061 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
4062 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01004063 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
4064 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
4065 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004066
4067 Example:
4068 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
4069
4070 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004071 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004072
4073
4074capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004075 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004076 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4077 no | yes | yes | no
4078 Arguments :
4079 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004080 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004081 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
4082 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
4083 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
4084
4085 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
4086 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
4087 it exceeds <length>.
4088
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004089 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004090 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
4091 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004092 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
4093 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
4094 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
4095 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004096 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004097 environments to find where the request came from.
4098
4099 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
4100 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
4101 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
4102 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004103
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01004104 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
4105 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
4106 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
4107 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
4108 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004109
4110 Example:
4111 capture request header Host len 15
4112 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01004113 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004114
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004115 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004116 about logging.
4117
4118
4119capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004120 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004121 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4122 no | yes | yes | no
4123 Arguments :
4124 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004125 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004126 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
4127 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
4128 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
4129
4130 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
4131 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
4132 it exceeds <length>.
4133
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004134 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004135 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
4136 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
4137 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004138 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
4139 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
4140 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
4141 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004142
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01004143 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
4144 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
4145 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
4146 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
4147 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004148
4149 Example:
4150 capture response header Content-length len 9
4151 capture response header Location len 15
4152
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004153 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004154 about logging.
4155
4156
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004157clitcpka-cnt <count>
4158 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
4159 the connection on the client side.
4160 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4161 yes | yes | yes | no
4162 Arguments :
4163 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
4164
4165 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
4166 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004167 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4168 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004169
4170 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-idle", "clitcpka-intvl".
4171
4172
4173clitcpka-idle <timeout>
4174 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
4175 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
4176 client side.
4177 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4178 yes | yes | yes | no
4179 Arguments :
4180 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
4181 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
4182 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
4183 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
4184
4185 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
4186 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004187 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4188 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004189
4190 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-intvl".
4191
4192
4193clitcpka-intvl <timeout>
4194 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the client side.
4195 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4196 yes | yes | yes | no
4197 Arguments :
4198 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
4199 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
4200 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
4201 document.
4202
4203 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
4204 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004205 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4206 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004207
4208 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-idle".
4209
4210
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004211compression algo <algorithm> ...
4212compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004213compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004214 Enable HTTP compression.
4215 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4216 yes | yes | yes | yes
4217 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004218 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
4219 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
4220 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
4221
4222 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004223 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
4224 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
4225 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004226
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004227 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004228 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004229
4230 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
4231 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
4232 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
4233 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
4234 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004235 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004236
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004237 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
4238 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
4239 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
4240 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
4241 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
4242 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
4243 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004244 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004245
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04004246 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004247 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004248 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
4249 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
4250 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
4251 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
4252 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004253
4254 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
4255 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
4256 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
4257 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
4258 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004259 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
4260 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
4261 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
4262 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
4263 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02004264 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
4265 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004266
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004267 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004268 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
4269 "Accept-Encoding" header
Julien Pivottoff80c822021-03-29 12:41:40 +02004270 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1 or above
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004271 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004272 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
4273 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
4274 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
4275 "multipart"
4276 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
4277 header
4278 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
4279 and later
4280 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
4281 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004282 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004283
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01004284 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004285
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004286 Examples :
4287 compression algo gzip
4288 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004289
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004290
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004291cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004292 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
4293 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004294 [ dynamic ] [ attr <value> ]*
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004295 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
4296 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4297 yes | no | yes | yes
4298 Arguments :
4299 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
4300 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
4301 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
4302 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
4303 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
4304 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004305 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004306 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
4307 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
4308
4309 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
4310 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
4311 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
4312 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
4313 headers is left to the application. The application can then
4314 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004315 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
4316 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004317 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004318 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
4319 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004320
4321 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004322 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004323
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004324 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004325 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02004326 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004327 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004328 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
4329 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
4330 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
4331 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
4332 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
4333 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
4334 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004335
4336 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
4337 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
4338 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
4339 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
4340 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
4341 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
4342 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
4343 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
4344 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004345 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02004346 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
4347 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
4348 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004349
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004350 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
4351 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
4352 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004353 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
4354 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
4355 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
4356 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02004357 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
4358 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
4359 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004360
4361 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
4362 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
4363 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
4364 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
4365 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
4366 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
4367 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
4368 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
4369 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
4370
4371 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
4372 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
4373 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
4374 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
4375 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
4376 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
4377 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
4378 persistence cookie in the cache.
4379 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
4380
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004381 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
4382 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
4383 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
4384 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
4385 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004386 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004387 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
4388 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
4389 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
4390 they logout.
4391
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004392 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
4393 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
4394 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
4395 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
4396
4397 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
4398 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
4399 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
4400 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
4401 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
4402 this attribute.
4403
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02004404 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004405 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01004406 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
4407 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
4408 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
4409 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
4410 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
4411 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02004412
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004413 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
4414 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
4415 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
4416 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
4417 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
4418 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
4419 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
4420 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004421 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004422 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
4423 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
4424 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
4425 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
4426 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
4427 the site.
4428
4429 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
4430 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
4431 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
4432 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
4433 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
4434 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
4435 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
4436 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
4437 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
4438 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
4439 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
4440 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
4441 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004442 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004443 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
4444 redispatch after some absolute delay.
4445
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004446 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
4447 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
4448 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
4449 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
4450 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
4451 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
4452
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004453 attr This option tells haproxy to add an extra attribute when a
4454 cookie is inserted. The attribute value can contain any
4455 characters except control ones or ";". This option may be
4456 repeated.
4457
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004458 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
4459 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
4460 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
4461 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02004462
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004463 Examples :
4464 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
4465 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
4466 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004467 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004468
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02004469 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004470
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004471
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004472declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
4473 Declares a capture slot.
4474 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4475 no | yes | yes | no
4476 Arguments:
4477 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
4478
4479 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
4480 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
4481 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
4482 for use in the response.
4483
4484 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02004485 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004486 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
4487
4488
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004489default-server [param*]
4490 Change default options for a server in a backend
4491 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4492 yes | no | yes | yes
4493 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004494 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
4495 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
4496 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
4497 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004498
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004499 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004500 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
4501
4502 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004503
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004504
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004505default_backend <backend>
4506 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
4507 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4508 yes | yes | yes | no
4509 Arguments :
4510 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
4511
4512 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
4513 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
4514 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
4515 will catch all undetermined requests.
4516
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004517 Example :
4518
4519 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
4520 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
4521 default_backend dynamic
4522
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02004523 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004524
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004525
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02004526description <string>
4527 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
4528 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4529 no | yes | yes | yes
4530 Arguments : string
4531
4532 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
4533 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
4534 it describes.
4535 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
4536
4537
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004538disabled
4539 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4540 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4541 yes | yes | yes | yes
4542 Arguments : none
4543
4544 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
4545 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
4546 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
4547 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
4548 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
4549 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
4550 keyword in a "defaults" section.
4551
4552 See also : "enabled"
4553
4554
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004555dispatch <address>:<port>
4556 Set a default server address
4557 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4558 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004559 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004560
4561 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
4562 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
4563 during start-up.
4564
4565 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
4566 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
4567 possible with normal servers.
4568
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02004569 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004570 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
4571 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
4572 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
4573 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
4574
4575 See also : "server"
4576
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004577
4578dynamic-cookie-key <string>
4579 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
4580 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4581 yes | no | yes | yes
4582 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
4583
4584 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004585 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004586 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
4587 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004588 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004589 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004590
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004591enabled
4592 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4593 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4594 yes | yes | yes | yes
4595 Arguments : none
4596
4597 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
4598 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
4599
4600 See also : "disabled"
4601
4602
4603errorfile <code> <file>
4604 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4605 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4606 yes | yes | yes | yes
4607 Arguments :
4608 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004609 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004610 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004611
4612 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004613 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004614 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004615 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
4616 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004617
4618 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4619 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4620 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4621
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004622 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4623
Christopher Faulet70170672020-05-18 17:42:48 +02004624 The files are parsed when HAProxy starts and must be valid according to the
4625 HTTP specification. They should not exceed the configured buffer size
4626 (BUFSIZE), which generally is 16 kB, otherwise an internal error will be
4627 returned. It is also wise not to put any reference to local contents
4628 (e.g. images) in order to avoid loops between the client and HAProxy when all
4629 servers are down, causing an error to be returned instead of an
4630 image. Finally, The response cannot exceed (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite)
4631 so that "http-after-response" rules still have room to operate (see
4632 "tune.maxrewrite").
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004633
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004634 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
4635 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
4636 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004637 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004638 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
4639
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004640 See also : "http-error", "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004641
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004642 Example :
4643 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004644 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004645 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
4646 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
4647
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004648
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004649errorfiles <name> [<code> ...]
4650 Import, fully or partially, the error files defined in the <name> http-errors
4651 section.
4652 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4653 yes | yes | yes | yes
4654 Arguments :
4655 <name> is the name of an existing http-errors section.
4656
4657 <code> is a HTTP status code. Several status code may be listed.
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004658 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes 200, 400, 401,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004659 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503,
4660 and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004661
4662 Errors defined in the http-errors section with the name <name> are imported
4663 in the current proxy. If no status code is specified, all error files of the
4664 http-errors section are imported. Otherwise, only error files associated to
4665 the listed status code are imported. Those error files override the already
4666 defined custom errors for the proxy. And they may be overridden by following
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04004667 ones. Functionally, it is exactly the same as declaring all error files by
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004668 hand using "errorfile" directives.
4669
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004670 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302" ,
4671 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004672
4673 Example :
4674 errorfiles generic
4675 errorfiles site-1 403 404
4676
4677
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004678errorloc <code> <url>
4679errorloc302 <code> <url>
4680 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4681 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4682 yes | yes | yes | yes
4683 Arguments :
4684 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004685 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004686 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004687
4688 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4689 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4690 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4691 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004692 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004693
4694 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4695 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4696 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4697
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004698 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4699
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004700 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
4701 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
4702 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
4703 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004704 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004705 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
4706 request.
4707
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004708 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004709
4710
4711errorloc303 <code> <url>
4712 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4713 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4714 yes | yes | yes | yes
4715 Arguments :
4716 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004717 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004718 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004719
4720 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4721 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4722 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4723 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004724 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004725
4726 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4727 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4728 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4729
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004730 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4731
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004732 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
4733 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
4734 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
4735 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004736 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004737
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004738 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004739
4740
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004741email-alert from <emailaddr>
4742 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004743 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004744 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4745 yes | yes | yes | yes
4746
4747 Arguments :
4748
4749 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
4750
4751 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4752 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4753
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004754 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02004755 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
4756 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004757
4758
4759email-alert level <level>
4760 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
4761 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
4762 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4763 yes | yes | yes | yes
4764
4765 Arguments :
4766
4767 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
4768 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
4769 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
4770
4771 By default level is alert
4772
4773 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
4774 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
4775 for the proxy.
4776
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09004777 Alerts are sent when :
4778
4779 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
4780 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
4781 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
4782 is notice or lower
4783 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
4784 and a health check status update occurs
4785
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004786 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
4787 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004788 section 3.6 about mailers.
4789
4790
4791email-alert mailers <mailersect>
4792 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
4793 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4794 yes | yes | yes | yes
4795
4796 Arguments :
4797
4798 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
4799
4800 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
4801 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4802
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004803 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
4804 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004805
4806
4807email-alert myhostname <hostname>
4808 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
4809 mailers.
4810 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4811 yes | yes | yes | yes
4812
4813 Arguments :
4814
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01004815 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004816
4817 By default the systems hostname is used.
4818
4819 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
4820 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
4821 for the proxy.
4822
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004823 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
4824 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004825
4826
4827email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004828 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004829 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
4830 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4831 yes | yes | yes | yes
4832
4833 Arguments :
4834
4835 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
4836
4837 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4838 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4839
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004840 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004841 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
4842
4843
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004844force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
4845 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
4846 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01004847 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004848
4849 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
4850 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
4851 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
4852 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
4853 marked down for maintenance operations.
4854
4855 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
4856 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
4857 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
4858 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
4859 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
4860 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
4861 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
4862 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
4863 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
4864
4865 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
4866 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
4867 is used.
4868
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004869 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02004870 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004871
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004872
4873filter <name> [param*]
4874 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
4875 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4876 no | yes | yes | yes
4877 Arguments :
4878 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
4879 referenced in section 9.
4880
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01004881 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004882 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01004883 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
4884 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004885
4886 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
4887 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
4888
4889 Example:
4890 listen
4891 bind *:80
4892
4893 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
4894 filter compression
4895 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
4896
4897 compression algo gzip
4898 compression offload
4899
4900 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
4901
4902 See also : section 9.
4903
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01004904
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004905fullconn <conns>
4906 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
4907 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4908 yes | no | yes | yes
4909 Arguments :
4910 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
4911 servers use the maximal number of connections.
4912
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004913 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004914 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01004915 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004916 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
4917 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
4918 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
4919 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
4920 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004921 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004922
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02004923 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
4924 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01004925 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
4926 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
4927 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02004928
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004929 Example :
4930 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
4931 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
4932 # connections.
4933 backend dynamic
4934 fullconn 10000
4935 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
4936 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
4937
4938 See also : "maxconn", "server"
4939
4940
Willy Tarreauab0a5192020-10-09 19:07:01 +02004941grace <time> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004942 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
4943 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01004944 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004945 Arguments :
4946 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
4947 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
4948 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
4949
4950 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
4951 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004952 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004953 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
4954
4955 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
4956 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
4957 simplify it.
4958
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004959
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004960hash-balance-factor <factor>
4961 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
4962 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4963 yes | no | no | yes
4964 Arguments :
4965 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
4966 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01004967 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004968
4969 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
4970 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
4971 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
4972 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
4973 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
4974 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
4975 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
4976
4977 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
4978 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
4979 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
4980 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
4981 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
4982
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02004983 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
4984 consistent hashing mechanism.
4985
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04004986 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
4987
4988
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05004989hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004990 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
4991 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4992 yes | no | yes | yes
4993 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004994 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
4995 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004996
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04004997 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
4998 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
4999 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
5000 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
5001 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
5002 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
5003 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
5004 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
5005 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
5006 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01005007
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005008 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
5009 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
5010 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
5011 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
5012 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
5013 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
5014 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
5015 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
5016 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
5017 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
5018 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
5019 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
5020 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005021 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
5022 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005023
5024 <function> is the hash function to be used :
5025
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005026 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005027 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
5028 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
5029 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005030 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
5031 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
5032 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005033
5034 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
5035 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005036 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
5037 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
5038 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
5039 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
5040
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01005041 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
5042 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
5043 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
5044 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
5045 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
5046 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
5047 parameter.
5048
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01005049 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
5050 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
5051 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
5052 used on strings.
5053
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005054 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
5055
5056 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
5057 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
5058 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
5059 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
5060 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
5061 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
5062 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
5063 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
5064 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
5065 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
5066 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
5067 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005068
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005069 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
5070 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
5071 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005072
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005073 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005074
5075
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005076http-after-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5077 Access control for all Layer 7 responses (server, applet/service and internal
5078 ones).
5079
5080 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5081 no | yes | yes | yes
5082
5083 The http-after-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer
5084 7 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they
5085 are met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5086 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5087 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
5088 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
5089
5090 Unlike http-response rules, these ones are applied on all responses, the
5091 server ones but also to all responses generated by HAProxy. These rules are
5092 evaluated at the end of the responses analysis, before the data forwarding.
5093
5094 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5095 below.
5096
5097 There is no limit to the number of http-after-response statements per
5098 instance.
5099
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01005100 Note: Errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are handled by the
5101 multiplexer at a lower level, before any http analysis. Thus no
5102 http-after-response ruleset is evaluated on these errors.
5103
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005104 Example:
5105 http-after-response set-header Strict-Transport-Security "max-age=31536000"
5106 http-after-response set-header Cache-Control "no-store,no-cache,private"
5107 http-after-response set-header Pragma "no-cache"
5108
5109http-after-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5110
5111 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
5112 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
5113 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
5114 example, or to pass some internal information.
5115 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
5116 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
5117 the resulting header from a previous rule.
5118
5119http-after-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5120
5121 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
5122 No further "http-after-response" rules are evaluated.
5123
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005124http-after-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005125
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005126 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
5127 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
5128 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
5129 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
5130 method is used.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005131
5132http-after-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5133 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5134
5135 This works like "http-response replace-header".
5136
5137 Example:
5138 http-after-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
5139
5140 # applied to:
5141 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
5142
5143 # outputs:
5144 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
5145
5146 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
5147
5148http-after-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5149 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5150
5151 This works like "http-response replace-value".
5152
5153 Example:
5154 http-after-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
5155
5156 # applied to:
5157 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
5158
5159 # outputs:
5160 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
5161
5162http-after-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5163
5164 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
5165 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
5166 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
5167
5168http-after-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
5169 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5170
5171 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
5172 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
5173 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
5174 fallback.
5175
5176 Example:
5177 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
5178 http-response set-status 431
5179 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
5180 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down"
5181
5182http-after-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5183
5184 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5185 inline.
5186
5187 Arguments:
5188 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5189 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5190 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5191 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5192 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5193 (request and response)
5194 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5195 processing
5196 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5197 processing
5198 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5199 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
5200 and '_'.
5201
5202 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5203 followed by some converters.
5204
5205 Example:
5206 http-after-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
5207
5208http-after-response strict-mode { on | off }
5209
5210 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
5211 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
5212 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
5213 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
5214 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005215 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005216 processing.
5217
5218 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
5219 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005220 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005221 rules evaluation.
5222
5223http-after-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5224
5225 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-after-response set-var" for
5226 details about <var-name>.
5227
5228 Example:
5229 http-after-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
5230
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005231
5232http-check comment <string>
5233 Defines a comment for the following the http-check rule, reported in logs if
5234 it fails.
5235 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5236 yes | no | yes | yes
5237
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005238 Arguments :
5239 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following http-check
5240 rule fails.
5241
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005242 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
5243 user-friendly error reporting.
5244
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005245 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check send" and
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005246 "http-check expect".
5247
5248
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005249http-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy]
5250 [via-socks4] [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02005251 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005252 Opens a new connection to perform an HTTP health check
5253 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5254 yes | no | yes | yes
5255
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005256 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005257 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5258
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005259 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005260 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005261
5262 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
5263 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
5264 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
5265 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
5266
5267 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
5268
5269 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
5270
5271 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
5272
5273 ssl opens a ciphered connection
5274
5275 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
5276
5277 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
5278 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
5279 for instance: "h2,http/1.1". If it is not set, the server ALPN
5280 is used.
5281
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02005282 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
5283 It must be an HTTP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
5284 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
5285 haproxy -vv.
5286
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005287 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
5288
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005289 Just like tcp-check health checks, it is possible to configure the connection
5290 to use to perform HTTP health check. This directive should also be used to
5291 describe a scenario involving several request/response exchanges, possibly on
5292 different ports or with different servers.
5293
5294 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
5295 directive, then the first step of the http-check sequence must be to specify
5296 the port with a "http-check connect".
5297
5298 In an http-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
5299 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
5300 do.
5301
5302 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
5303 unset-var or comment rules.
5304
5305 Examples :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005306 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
5307 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
5308 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
5309 option httpchk
5310
5311 http-check connect
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02005312 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005313 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005314 http-check connect port 443 ssl sni haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02005315 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005316 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005317
5318 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
5319
5320 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send", "http-check expect"
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005321
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005322
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005323http-check disable-on-404
5324 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
5325 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005326 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005327 Arguments : none
5328
5329 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
5330 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
5331 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
5332 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
5333 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
5334 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
5335 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
5336 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005337 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
5338 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
Christopher Fauletfa8b89a2020-11-20 18:54:13 +01005339 responses will still be considered as soft-stop. Note also that a stopped
5340 server will stay stopped even if it replies 404s. This option is only
5341 evaluated for running servers.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005342
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005343 See also : "option httpchk" and "http-check expect".
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005344
5345
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005346http-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005347 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
5348 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
5349 [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005350 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005351 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02005352 yes | no | yes | yes
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005353
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005354 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005355 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5356
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005357 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
5358 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
5359 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
5360 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
5361 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
5362 incomplete. If an exact string is used, the minimum between the
5363 string length and this parameter is used. This parameter is
5364 ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule does not match,
5365 the check will wait for more data. If set to 0, the evaluation
5366 result is always conclusive.
5367
5368 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5369 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
5370 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005371 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
5372 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01005373 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
5374 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005375 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
5376 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
5377 By default "L7OK" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005378
5379 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5380 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01005381 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
5382 supported :
5383 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
5384 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005385 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
5386 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
5387 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
5388 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
5389 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005390
5391 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5392 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005393 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
5394 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
5395 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
5396 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005397 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
5398
5399 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
5400 informational message reported in logs if the expect
5401 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
5402 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
5403
5404 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
5405 informational message reported in logs if an error
5406 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
5407 log-format string.
5408
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005409 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005410 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus", "hdr",
5411 "fhdr", "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005412 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
5413 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
5414 details on the supported keywords.
5415
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005416 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string, a regular
5417 expression or a more complex pattern with several arguments. If
5418 the string pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped with the
5419 usual backslash ('\').
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005420
5421 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
5422 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
5423 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
5424 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
5425 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
5426
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005427 status <codes> : test the status codes found parsing <codes> string. it
5428 must be a comma-separated list of status codes or range
5429 codes. A health check response will be considered as
5430 valid if the response's status code matches any status
5431 code or is inside any range of the list. If the "status"
5432 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5433 considered invalid if the status code matches.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005434
5435 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005436 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005437 response's status code matches the expression. If the
5438 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5439 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
5440 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
5441
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005442 hdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5443 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005444 test the specified header pattern on the HTTP response
5445 headers. The name pattern is mandatory but the value
5446 pattern is optional. If not specified, only the header
5447 presence is verified. <meth> is the matching method,
5448 applied on the header name or the header value. Supported
5449 matching methods are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix
5450 match), "end" (suffix match), "sub" (substring match) or
5451 "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005452 method is used. If the "name-lf" parameter is used,
5453 <name> is evaluated as a log-format string. If "value-lf"
5454 parameter is used, <value> is evaluated as a log-format
5455 string. These parameters cannot be used with the regex
5456 matching method. Finally, the header value is considered
5457 as comma-separated list. Note that matchings are case
5458 insensitive on the header names.
5459
5460 fhdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5461 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
5462 test the specified full header pattern on the HTTP
5463 response headers. It does exactly the same than "hdr"
5464 keyword, except the full header value is tested, commas
5465 are not considered as delimiters.
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005466
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005467 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005468 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005469 response's body contains this exact string. If the
5470 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5471 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
5472 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
5473 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005474 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005475 trace).
5476
5477 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005478 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005479 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
5480 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5481 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
5482 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
5483 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005484 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005485
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +02005486 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the HTTP response body.
5487 A health check response will be considered valid if the
5488 response's body contains the string resulting of the
5489 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
5490 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5491 considered invalid if the body contains the string.
5492
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005493 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +01005494 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005495 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
5496 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
5497 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
5498 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
5499 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
5500 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
5501
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005502 In an http-check ruleset, the last expect rule may be implicit. If no expect
5503 rule is specified after the last "http-check send", an implicit expect rule
5504 is defined to match on 2xx or 3xx status codes. It means this rule is also
5505 defined if there is no "http-check" rule at all, when only "option httpchk"
5506 is set.
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01005507
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005508 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
5509 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
5510
5511 Examples :
5512 # only accept status 200 as valid
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005513 http-check expect status 200,201,300-310
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005514
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005515 # be sure a sessid coookie is set
5516 http-check expect header name "set-cookie" value -m beg "sessid="
5517
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005518 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005519 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005520
5521 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005522 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005523
5524 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005525 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005526
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005527 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check disable-on-404"
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005528 and "http-check send".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005529
5530
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005531http-check send [meth <method>] [{ uri <uri> | uri-lf <fmt> }>] [ver <version>]
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005532 [hdr <name> <fmt>]* [{ body <string> | body-lf <fmt> }]
5533 [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005534 Add a possible list of headers and/or a body to the request sent during HTTP
5535 health checks.
5536 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5537 yes | no | yes | yes
5538 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005539 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5540
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005541 meth <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not
5542 set, the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires
5543 low server processing and is easy to filter out from the
5544 logs. Any method may be used, though it is not recommended
5545 to invent non-standard ones.
5546
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005547 uri <uri> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5548 to the string <uri>. It defaults to "/" which is accessible
5549 by default on almost any server, but may be changed to any
5550 other URI. Query strings are permitted.
5551
5552 uri-lf <fmt> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5553 using the log-format string <fmt>. It defaults to "/" which
5554 is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
5555 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005556
Christopher Faulet907701b2020-04-28 09:37:00 +02005557 ver <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005558 "HTTP/1.0" but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005559 1.0, so turning it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005560 the Host field is mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "hdr" argument
5561 to add it.
5562
5563 hdr <name> <fmt> adds the HTTP header field whose name is specified in
5564 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt>, which follows
5565 to the log-format rules.
5566
5567 body <string> add the body defined by <string> to the request sent during
5568 HTTP health checks. If defined, the "Content-Length" header
5569 is thus automatically added to the request.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005570
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005571 body-lf <fmt> add the body defined by the log-format string <fmt> to the
5572 request sent during HTTP health checks. If defined, the
5573 "Content-Length" header is thus automatically added to the
5574 request.
5575
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005576 In addition to the request line defined by the "option httpchk" directive,
5577 this one is the valid way to add some headers and optionally a body to the
5578 request sent during HTTP health checks. If a body is defined, the associate
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005579 "Content-Length" header is automatically added. Thus, this header or
5580 "Transfer-encoding" header should not be present in the request provided by
5581 "http-check send". If so, it will be ignored. The old trick consisting to add
5582 headers after the version string on the "option httpchk" line is now
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01005583 deprecated.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005584
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005585 Also "http-check send" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01005586 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, unless a Connection
5587 header has already already been configured via a hdr entry.
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005588
5589 Note that the Host header and the request authority, when both defined, are
5590 automatically synchronized. It means when the HTTP request is sent, when a
5591 Host is inserted in the request, the request authority is accordingly
5592 updated. Thus, don't be surprised if the Host header value overwrites the
5593 configured request authority.
5594
5595 Note also for now, no Host header is automatically added in HTTP/1.1 or above
5596 requests. You should add it explicitly.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005597
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005598 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send-state" and "http-check expect".
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005599
5600
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005601http-check send-state
5602 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
5603 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5604 yes | no | yes | yes
5605 Arguments : none
5606
5607 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
5608 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
5609 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
5610 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
5611 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
5612
5613 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
5614 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
5615 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
5616 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
5617 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08005618 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
5619 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
5620 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5621
5622 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
5623 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
5624 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5625
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005626 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
5627 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
5628 checked in multiple backends.
5629
5630 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
5631 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
5632
5633 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
5634 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
5635 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
5636 one fails.
5637
5638 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
5639 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
5640 connections on all servers of the same backend.
5641
5642 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
5643 server's queue.
5644
5645 Example of a header received by the application server :
5646 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
5647 scur=13/22; qcur=0
5648
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005649 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404" and
5650 "http-check send".
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005651
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005652
5653http-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005654 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005655 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5656 yes | no | yes | yes
5657
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005658 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005659 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5660 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5661 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5662 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5663 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5664 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5665 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5666 and '-'.
5667
5668 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
5669
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005670 Examples :
5671 http-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005672
5673
5674http-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005675 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005676 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5677 yes | no | yes | yes
5678
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005679 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005680 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5681 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5682 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5683 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5684 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5685 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5686 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5687 and '-'.
5688
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005689 Examples :
5690 http-check unset-var(check.port)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005691
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005692
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005693http-error status <code> [content-type <type>]
5694 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5695 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
5696 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
5697 Defines a custom error message to use instead of errors generated by HAProxy.
5698 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5699 yes | yes | yes | yes
5700 Arguments :
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05005701 status <code> is the HTTP status code. It must be specified.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005702 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005703 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01005704 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005705
5706 content-type <type> is the response content type, for instance
5707 "text/plain". This parameter is ignored and should be
5708 omitted when an errorfile is configured or when the
5709 payload is empty. Otherwise, it must be defined.
5710
5711 default-errorfiles Reset the previously defined error message for current
5712 proxy for the status <code>. If used on a backend, the
5713 frontend error message is used, if defined. If used on
5714 a frontend, the default error message is used.
5715
5716 errorfile <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response.
5717 It is recommended to follow the common practice of
5718 appending ".http" to the filename so that people do
5719 not confuse the response with HTML error pages, and to
5720 use absolute paths, since files are read before any
5721 chroot is performed.
5722
5723 errorfiles <name> designates the http-errors section to use to import
5724 the error message with the status code <code>. If no
5725 such message is found, the proxy's error messages are
5726 considered.
5727
5728 file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5729 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5730 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5731 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5732 considered as a raw string.
5733
5734 string <str> specifies the raw string to use as response payload.
5735 The content-type must always be set as argument to
5736 "content-type".
5737
5738 lf-file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5739 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5740 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5741 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5742 evaluated as a log-format string.
5743
5744 lf-string <str> specifies the log-format string to use as response
5745 payload. The content-type must always be set as
5746 argument to "content-type".
5747
5748 hdr <name> <fmt> adds to the response the HTTP header field whose name
5749 is specified in <name> and whose value is defined by
5750 <fmt>, which follows to the log-format rules.
5751 This parameter is ignored if an errorfile is used.
5752
5753 This directive may be used instead of "errorfile", to define a custom error
5754 message. As "errorfile" directive, it is used for errors detected and
5755 returned by HAProxy. If an errorfile is defined, it is parsed when HAProxy
5756 starts and must be valid according to the HTTP standards. The generated
5757 response must not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFFSIZE), otherwise an
5758 internal error will be returned. Finally, if you consider to use some
5759 http-after-response rules to rewrite these errors, the reserved buffer space
5760 should be available (see "tune.maxrewrite").
5761
5762 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
5763 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
5764 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running.
5765
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01005766 Note: 400/408/500 errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are
5767 handled by the multiplexer at a lower level. No custom formatting is
5768 supported at this level. Thus only static error messages, defined with
5769 "errorfile" directive, are supported. However, this limitation only
5770 exists during the request headers parsing or between two transactions.
5771
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005772 See also : "errorfile", "errorfiles", "errorloc", "errorloc302",
5773 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
5774
5775
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005776http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005777 Access control for Layer 7 requests
5778
5779 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5780 no | yes | yes | yes
5781
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005782 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
5783 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
5784 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5785 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5786 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005787
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005788 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5789 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005790
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005791 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005792
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005793 Example:
5794 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
5795 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
5796 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005797
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005798 http-request allow if nagios
5799 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
5800 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
5801 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01005802
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005803 Example:
5804 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
5805 acl add path /addacl
5806 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005807
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005808 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005809
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005810 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
5811 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02005812
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005813 Example:
5814 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
5815 acl setmap path /setmap
5816 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005817
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005818 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005819
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005820 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
5821 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005822
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005823 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
5824 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005825
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005826http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005827
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005828 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5829 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5830 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5831 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
5832 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
5833 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
5834 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5835 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005836
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005837http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005838
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005839 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
5840 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
5841 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
5842 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
5843 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
5844 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
5845 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
5846 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005847
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005848http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005849
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005850 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
5851 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005852
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005853
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005854http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005855
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005856 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
5857 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
5858 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
5859 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
5860 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005861
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02005862 The corresponding proxy's error message is used. It may be customized using
5863 an "errorfile" or an "http-error" directive. For 401 responses, all
5864 occurrences of the WWW-Authenticate header are removed and replaced by a new
5865 one with a basic authentication challenge for realm "<realm>". For 407
5866 responses, the same is done on the Proxy-Authenticate header. If the error
5867 message must not be altered, consider to use "http-request return" rule
5868 instead.
5869
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005870 Example:
5871 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
5872 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005873
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02005874http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06005875
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02005876 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005877
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005878http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
5879 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005880
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005881 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
5882 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
5883 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
5884 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
5885 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
5886 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
5887 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
5888 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
5889 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005890
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005891 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
5892 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
5893 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01005894 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
5895
5896 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
5897 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
5898 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
5899 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005900
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005901http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005902
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005903 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
5904 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
5905 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5906 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5907 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
5908 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01005909
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005910http-request del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02005911
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005912 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
5913 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
5914 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
5915 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
5916 method is used.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02005917
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005918http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02005919
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005920 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
5921 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
5922 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
5923 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
5924 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
5925 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02005926
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005927http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5928http-request deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
5929 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5930 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
5931 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
5932 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04005933
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005934 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request.
5935 By default an HTTP 403 error is returned. But the response may be customized
5936 using same syntax than "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05005937 return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined,
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005938 or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
5939 "http-request deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
5940 "http-request deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005941 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02005942 See also "http-request return".
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04005943
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02005944http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5945 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
5946 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
5947 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
5948
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01005949http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
5950
5951 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
5952 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
5953 pointed by <resolvers>.
5954 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
5955 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
5956 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
5957 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
5958 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
5959 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
5960 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
5961 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
5962 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
5963 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
5964 to 0.0.0.0.
5965
5966 Example:
5967 resolvers mydns
5968 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
5969 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
5970 timeout retry 1s
5971 hold valid 10s
5972 hold nx 3s
5973 hold other 3s
5974 hold obsolete 0s
5975 accepted_payload_size 8192
5976
5977 frontend fe
5978 bind 10.42.0.1:80
5979 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
5980 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
5981
5982 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
5983 # which mean DNS resolution error
5984 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
5985
5986 default_backend be
5987
5988 backend b_503
5989 # dummy backend used to return 503.
5990 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
5991 # 503 error page to end users
5992
5993 backend be
5994 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
5995 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
5996 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
5997 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
5998 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
5999
6000 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
6001 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
6002
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01006003http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6004
6005 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
6006 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
6007 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
6008 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01006009 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
6010 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01006011
6012 See RFC 8297 for more information.
6013
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006014http-request normalize-uri <normalizer> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006015http-request normalize-uri dotdot [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006016http-request normalize-uri merge-slashes [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6017
6018 Performs normalization of the request's URI. The following normalizers are
6019 available:
6020
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006021 - dotdot: Normalizes "/../" segments within the "path" component. This merges
6022 segments that attempt to access the parent directory with their preceding
6023 segment. Empty segments do not receive special treatment. Use the
6024 "merge-slashes" normalizer first if this is undesired.
6025
6026 Example:
6027 - /foo/../ -> /
6028 - /foo/../bar/ -> /bar/
6029 - /foo/bar/../ -> /foo/
6030 - /../bar/ -> /../bar/
6031 - /foo//../ -> /foo/
6032
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006033 - merge-slashes: Merges adjacent slashes within the "path" component into a
6034 single slash.
6035
6036 Example:
6037 - // -> /
6038 - /foo//bar -> /foo/bar
6039
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006040http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006041
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006042 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
6043 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
6044 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
6045 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
6046 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006047
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006048http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006049
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006050 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
6051 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
6052 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
6053 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006054
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006055http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6056 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02006057
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006058 This matches the value of all occurrences of header field <name> against
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006059 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
6060 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
6061 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
6062 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
6063 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02006064
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006065 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
6066 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
6067 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
6068 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
6069 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01006070
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006071 Example:
6072 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
6073
6074 # applied to:
6075 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
6076
6077 # outputs:
6078 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
6079
6080 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006081
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006082 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
6083
6084 # applied to:
6085 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006086
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006087 # outputs:
6088 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006089
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006090http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6091 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6092
6093 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
6094 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
Christopher Faulet82c83322020-09-02 14:16:59 +02006095 after an optional scheme+authority and ends before the question mark. Thus,
6096 the replacement does not modify the scheme, the authority and the
6097 query-string.
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006098
6099 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
6100 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
6101 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
6102
6103 Example:
6104 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
6105 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
6106
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006107 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
6108 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
6109 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
6110 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
6111
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02006112http-request replace-pathq <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6113 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6114
6115 This does the same as "http-request replace-path" except that the path
6116 contains the query-string if any is present. Thus, the path and the
6117 query-string are replaced.
6118
6119 Example:
6120 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
6121 http-request replace-pathq ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
6122
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006123http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6124 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6125
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006126 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
6127 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
6128 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
6129 against.
6130
6131 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
6132 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
6133 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006134
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006135 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
6136 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
6137 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
6138 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
6139 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
6140 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
6141 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
6142 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
6143 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006144 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
6145 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006146
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006147 Example:
6148 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
6149 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006150
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006151 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
6152 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006153
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006154http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6155 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006156
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006157 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
6158 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
6159 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
6160 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006161
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006162 Example:
6163 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02006164
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006165 # applied to:
6166 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02006167
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006168 # outputs:
6169 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01006170
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006171http-request return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
6172 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6173 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006174 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006175 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6176
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006177 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006178 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
6179 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006180 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006181 be defined. It can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006182 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006183 are followed to create the response :
6184
6185 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
6186 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
6187 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
6188 ignored.
6189
6190 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
6191 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006192 status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006193 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if
6194 any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006195
6196 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
6197 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
6198 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006199 by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501,
6200 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006201
6202 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
6203 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
6204 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006205 must be one of the status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006206 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006207 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006208
6209 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
6210 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
6211 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
6212 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
6213 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
6214 as a raw content.
6215
6216 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
6217 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
6218 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
6219 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
6220 considered as a raw string.
6221
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006222 When the response is not based on an errorfile, it is possible to append HTTP
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006223 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
6224 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
6225 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
6226
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006227 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
6228 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006229 reserved for the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006230
6231 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6232
6233 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006234 http-request return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006235 if { path /ping }
6236
6237 http-request return content-type image/x-icon file /var/www/favicon.ico \
6238 if { path /favicon.ico }
6239
6240 http-request return status 403 content-type text/plain \
6241 lf-string "Access denied. IP %[src] is blacklisted." \
6242 if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
6243
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006244http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6245http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006246
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006247 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
6248 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
6249 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006250
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006251http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6252 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006253
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006254 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
6255 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
6256 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
6257 evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006258
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006259http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006260
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006261 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
6262 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
6263 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
6264 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
6265 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006266
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006267 Arguments:
6268 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6269 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006270
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006271 Example:
6272 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
6273 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006274
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006275 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
6276 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006277
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006278http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006279
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006280 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
6281 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
6282 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006283
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006284 Arguments:
6285 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6286 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006287
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006288 Example:
6289 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
6290 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006291
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006292 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
6293 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
6294 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006295
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006296http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006297
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006298 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
6299 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
6300 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
6301 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
6302 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006303
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006304 Example:
6305 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
6306 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
6307 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
6308 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
6309 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
6310 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
6311 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
6312 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
6313 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006314
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006315http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006316
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006317 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
6318 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
6319 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
6320 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
6321 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006322
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006323http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
6324 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006325
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006326 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6327 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6328 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
6329 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
6330 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
6331 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
6332 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
6333 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
6334 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006335
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006336http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006337
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006338 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
6339 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
6340 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
6341 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
6342 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
6343 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
6344 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02006345
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006346http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006347
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006348 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
6349 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
6350 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006351
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006352http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006353
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006354 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
6355 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
6356 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
6357 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
6358 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
6359 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
6360 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
6361 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006362
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006363http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02006364
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006365 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
6366 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
6367 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
6368 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
6369 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
6370 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02006371
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006372 Example :
6373 # prepend the host name before the path
6374 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006375
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02006376http-request set-pathq <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6377
6378 This does the same as "http-request set-path" except that the query-string is
6379 also rewritten. It may be used to remove the query-string, including the
6380 question mark (it is not possible using "http-request set-query").
6381
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006382http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02006383
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006384 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
6385 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
6386 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
6387 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
6388 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006389
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006390http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006391
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006392 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
6393 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
6394 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
6395 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
6396 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
6397 values have higher priority.
6398 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
6399 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
6400 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
6401 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
6402 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006403
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006404http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006405
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006406 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
6407 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
6408 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
6409 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
6410 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
6411 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
6412 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006413
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006414 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006415
6416 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006417 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
6418 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006419
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006420http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6421 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
6422 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
6423 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006424 privacy. All subsequent calls to "src" fetch will return this value
6425 (see example).
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006426
6427 Arguments :
6428 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6429 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006430
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006431 See also "option forwardfor".
6432
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006433 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006434 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
6435 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
6436
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006437 # After the masking this will track connections
6438 # based on the IP address with the last byte zeroed out.
6439 http-request track-sc0 src
6440
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006441 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
6442 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
6443
6444http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6445
6446 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
6447 expression.
6448
6449 Arguments:
6450 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6451 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006452
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006453 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006454 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
6455 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
6456
6457 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
6458 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
6459 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
6460
Amaury Denoyelle8d228232020-12-10 13:43:54 +01006461http-request set-timeout server|tunnel { <timeout> | <expr> }
6462 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6463
6464 This action overrides the specified "server" or "tunnel" timeout for the
6465 current stream only. The timeout can be specified in millisecond or with any
6466 other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit as explained at the top of
6467 this document. It is also possible to write an expression which must returns
6468 a number interpreted as a timeout in millisecond.
6469
6470 Note that the server/tunnel timeouts are only relevant on the backend side
6471 and thus this rule is only available for the proxies with backend
6472 capabilities. Also the timeout value must be non-null to obtain the expected
6473 results.
6474
6475 Example:
6476 http-request set-timeout server 5s
6477 http-request set-timeout hdr(host),map_int(host.lst)
6478
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006479http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6480
6481 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
6482 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
6483 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
6484 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
6485 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
6486 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
6487 information from the request.
6488
6489 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
6490
6491http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6492
6493 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
6494 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
6495 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
6496 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
6497 path and the query string.
6498 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
6499
6500http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6501
6502 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
6503 inline.
6504
6505 Arguments:
6506 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6507 scope. The scopes allowed are:
6508 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
6509 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
6510 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
6511 (request and response)
6512 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
6513 processing
6514 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
6515 processing
6516 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6517 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
6518 and '_'.
6519
6520 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6521 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006522
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006523 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006524 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006525
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006526http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
6527 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006528
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006529 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
6530 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
6531 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
6532 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
6533 agent name must be used.
6534
6535 Arguments:
6536 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
6537
6538 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
6539 configuration.
6540
6541http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6542
6543 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
6544 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
6545 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
6546 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
6547 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
6548 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
6549 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
6550 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
6551 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
6552 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
6553 action.
6554 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
6555 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
6556 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
6557 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
6558 you fully understand how it works.
6559
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006560http-request strict-mode { on | off }
6561
6562 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
6563 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
6564 performing a rewrite on the requests. When the strict mode is enabled, any
6565 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
6566 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006567 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the request
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006568 processing.
6569
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01006570 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006571 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
6572 the frontend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the backend
6573 rules evaluation.
6574
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006575http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6576http-request tarpit [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6577 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6578 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6579 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6580 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006581
6582 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
6583 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
6584 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006585 is still connected, a response is returned so that the client does not
6586 suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT". The goal of
6587 the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when they're limited
6588 on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very efficient against very
6589 dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load on firewalls compared to
6590 a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly" developed robots, it can make
6591 things worse by forcing haproxy and the front firewall to support insane
6592 number of concurrent connections. By default an HTTP error 500 is returned.
6593 But the response may be customized using same syntax than
6594 "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request return" for details.
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006595 For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined, or only "deny_status",
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006596 the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
6597 "http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
6598 "http-request tarpit [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
6599 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6600 See also "http-request return" and "http-request silent-drop".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006601
6602http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6603http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6604http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6605
6606 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
6607 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
6608 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
6609 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
Matteo Contrini1857b8c2020-10-16 17:35:54 +02006610 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). The first
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006611 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6612 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
6613 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
6614 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6615 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
6616 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
6617 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
6618
6619 Arguments :
6620 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
6621 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
6622 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
6623 select which table entry to update the counters.
6624
6625 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
6626 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
6627 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
6628 that table until the session ends.
6629
6630 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
6631 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
6632 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
6633 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
6634 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
6635 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
6636 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
6637 useful information.
6638
6639 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
6640 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
6641 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
6642 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
6643 checks that make use of it.
6644
6645http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6646
6647 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006648
6649 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006650 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006651
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01006652http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6653
6654 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
6655 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
6656 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
6657 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
6658 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
6659 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6660
6661 Arguments :
6662 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
6663
6664 Example:
6665 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
6666
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02006667http-request wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
6668 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6669
6670 This will delay the processing of the request waiting for the payload for at
6671 most <time> milliseconds. if "at-least" argument is specified, HAProxy stops
6672 to wait the payload when the first <bytes> bytes are received. 0 means no
6673 limit, it is the default value. Regardless the "at-least" argument value,
6674 HAProxy stops to wait if the whole payload is received or if the request
6675 buffer is full. This action may be used as a replacement to "option
6676 http-buffer-request".
6677
6678 Arguments :
6679
6680 <time> is mandatory. It is the maximum time to wait for the body. It
6681 follows the HAProxy time format and is expressed in milliseconds.
6682
6683 <bytes> is optional. It is the minimum payload size to receive to stop to
6684 wait. It fallows the HAProxy size format and is expressed in
6685 bytes.
6686
6687 Example:
6688 http-request wait-for-body time 1s at-least 1k if METH_POST
6689
6690 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
6691
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006692http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006693
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006694 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
6695 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
6696 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006697
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01006698
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006699http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006700 Access control for Layer 7 responses
6701
6702 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6703 no | yes | yes | yes
6704
6705 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
6706 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
6707 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
6708 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
6709 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
6710 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
6711
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006712 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
6713 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006714
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006715 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006716
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006717 Example:
6718 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02006719
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006720 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006721
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006722 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
6723 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006724
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006725 Example:
6726 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006727
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006728 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006729
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006730 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
6731 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006732
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006733 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
6734 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006735
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006736http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006737
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006738 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6739 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6740 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6741 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
6742 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
6743 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
6744 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6745 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006746
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006747http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006748
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006749 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
6750 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
6751 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
6752 example, or to pass some internal information.
6753 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
6754 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
6755 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006756
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006757http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006758
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006759 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
6760 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006761
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02006762http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006763
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006764 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006765
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006766http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006767
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006768 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
6769 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
6770 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
6771 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
6772 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
6773 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
6774 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02006775
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006776 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
6777 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
6778 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
6779 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
6780 keyword.
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01006781
6782 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
6783 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
6784 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
6785 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02006786
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006787http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02006788
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006789 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6790 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6791 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6792 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6793 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6794 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02006795
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006796http-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02006797
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006798 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
6799 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
6800 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
6801 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
6802 method is used.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02006803
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006804http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02006805
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006806 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6807 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6808 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6809 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6810 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
6811 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006812
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006813http-response deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6814http-response deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6815 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6816 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6817 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6818 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006819
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006820 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response.
6821 By default an HTTP 502 error is returned. But the response may be customized
6822 using same syntax than "http-response return" rules. Thus, see
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006823 "http-response return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006824 argument is defined, or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles"
6825 is implied. It means "http-response deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias
6826 of "http-response deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01006827 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006828 See also "http-response return".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006829
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006830http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006831
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006832 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
6833 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
6834 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
6835 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
6836 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
6837 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02006838
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006839http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
6840 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02006841
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006842 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
6843 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01006844
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006845 Example:
6846 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02006847
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006848 # applied to:
6849 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006850
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006851 # outputs:
6852 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006853
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006854 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006855
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006856http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
6857 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006858
Tim Duesterhus6bd909b2020-01-17 15:53:18 +01006859 This works like "http-request replace-value" except that it works on the
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006860 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006861
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006862 Example:
6863 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006864
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006865 # applied to:
6866 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006867
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006868 # outputs:
6869 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006870
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006871http-response return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
6872 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6873 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006874 [ hdr <name> <value> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006875 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6876
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006877 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006878 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
6879 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006880 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006881 be defined. If can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006882 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006883 are followed to create the response :
6884
6885 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
6886 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
6887 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
6888 ignored.
6889
6890 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
6891 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006892 status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006893 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if
6894 any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006895
6896 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
6897 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
6898 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006899 by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501,
6900 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006901
6902 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
6903 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
6904 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006905 must be one of the status code handled by haproxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006906 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006907 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006908
6909 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
6910 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
6911 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
6912 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
6913 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
6914 as a raw content.
6915
6916 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
6917 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
6918 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
6919 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
6920 considered as a raw string.
6921
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006922 When the response is not based an errorfile, it is possible to appends HTTP
6923 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
6924 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
6925 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
6926
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006927 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
6928 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006929 reserved to the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006930
6931 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
6932
6933 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006934 http-response return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006935 if { status eq 404 }
6936
6937 http-response return content-type text/plain \
6938 string "This is the end !" \
6939 if { status eq 500 }
6940
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006941http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6942http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08006943
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006944 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
6945 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
6946 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02006947
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006948http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6949 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02006950
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006951 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
6952 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
6953 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
6954 evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01006955
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006956http-response send-spoe-group [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02006957
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006958 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
6959 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
6960 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
6961 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
6962 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006963
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006964 Arguments:
6965 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006966
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006967 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
6968 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006969
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006970http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006971
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006972 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
6973 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
6974 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02006975
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02006976http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6977
6978 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
6979 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
6980 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
6981 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
6982 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
6983
6984http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
6985
6986 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6987 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6988 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
6989 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
6990 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
6991 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
6992 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
6993 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
6994 be triggered by an HTTP response.
6995
6996http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6997
6998 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
6999 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
7000 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
7001 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
7002 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
7003 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
7004 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
7005
7006http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7007
7008 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
7009 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
7010 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
7011 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
7012 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
7013 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
7014 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
7015 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
7016
7017http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
7018 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7019
7020 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
7021 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
7022 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
7023 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007024
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007025 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007026 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
7027 http-response set-status 431
7028 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
7029 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007030
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007031http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007032
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007033 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
7034 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
7035 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
7036 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
7037 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
7038 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
7039 based on some information from the request.
7040
7041 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
7042
7043http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7044
7045 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
7046 inline.
7047
7048 Arguments:
7049 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
7050 scope. The scopes allowed are:
7051 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
7052 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
7053 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
7054 (request and response)
7055 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
7056 processing
7057 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
7058 processing
7059 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
7060 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
7061 and '_'.
7062
7063 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
7064 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007065
7066 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007067 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007068
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007069http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007070
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007071 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
7072 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
7073 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
7074 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
7075 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
7076 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
7077 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
7078 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
7079 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
7080 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
7081 action.
7082 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
7083 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
7084 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
7085 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
7086 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007087
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007088http-response strict-mode { on | off }
7089
7090 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
7091 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
7092 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
7093 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
7094 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007095 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007096 processing.
7097
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01007098 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007099 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007100 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007101 rules evaluation.
7102
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007103http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7104http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7105http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007106
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007107 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
7108 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
7109 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
7110 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
7111 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
7112 supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
7113
7114http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7115
7116 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
7117 about <var-name>.
7118
7119 Example:
7120 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
7121
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007122http-response wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
7123 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7124
7125 This will delay the processing of the response waiting for the payload for at
7126 most <time> milliseconds. if "at-least" argument is specified, HAProxy stops
7127 to wait the payload when the first <bytes> bytes are received. 0 means no
7128 limit, it is the default value. Regardless the "at-least" argument value,
7129 HAProxy stops to wait if the whole payload is received or if the response
7130 buffer is full.
7131
7132 Arguments :
7133
7134 <time> is mandatory. It is the maximum time to wait for the body. It
7135 follows the HAProxy time format and is expressed in milliseconds.
7136
7137 <bytes> is optional. It is the minimum payload size to receive to stop to
7138 wait. It fallows the HAProxy size format and is expressed in
7139 bytes.
7140
7141 Example:
7142 http-response wait-for-body time 1s at-least 10k
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02007143
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007144http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
7145 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
7146
7147 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7148 yes | no | yes | yes
7149
7150 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007151 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
7152 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
7153 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007154
7155 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
7156
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007157 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
7158 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
7159 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
7160 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
7161 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
7162 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
7163 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
7164 such an application could be an old haproxy using cookie
7165 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
7166 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007167
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007168 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
7169 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
7170 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
7171 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
7172 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
7173 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
7174 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
Amaury Denoyelle27179652020-10-14 18:17:12 +02007175 effects. There is also a special handling for the connections
7176 using protocols subject to Head-of-line blocking (backend with
7177 h2 or fcgi). In this case, when at least one stream is
7178 processed, the used connection is reserved to handle streams
7179 of the same session. When no more streams are processed, the
7180 connection is released and can be reused.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007181
7182 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
7183 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
7184 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
7185 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
7186 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
7187 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
7188 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
7189 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02007190 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007191 downsides of rare connection failures.
7192
7193 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
7194 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
7195 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
7196 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
7197 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
7198 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007199 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007200 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
7201 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
7202 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
7203 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
7204 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
7205
7206 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01007207 connection properties and compatibility. Indeed, some properties are specific
7208 and it is not possibly to reuse it blindly. Those are the SSL SNI, source
7209 and destination address and proxy protocol block. A connection is reused only
7210 if it shares the same set of properties with the request.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007211
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01007212 Also note that connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying
7213 on the connection) like NTLM are marked private and never shared.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007214
Lukas Tribuse8adfeb2019-11-06 11:50:25 +01007215 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007216
7217 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
7218 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
7219 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
7220
7221 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
7222
7223
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007224http-send-name-header [<header>]
7225 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007226 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7227 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007228 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007229 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
7230
Willy Tarreau81bef7e2019-10-07 14:58:02 +02007231 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
7232 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
7233 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
7234 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
7235 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
7236 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
7237 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
7238 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
7239 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
7240 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
7241 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
7242 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
7243 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
7244 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
7245 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
7246 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007247
7248 See also : "server"
7249
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01007250id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02007251 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
7252 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7253 no | yes | yes | yes
7254 Arguments : none
7255
7256 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
7257 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
7258 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01007259
7260
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007261ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
7262 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
7263 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01007264 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007265
7266 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
7267 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
7268 and running).
7269
7270 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
7271 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
7272 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007273 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007274 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
7275
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007276 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
7277 "unless" condition is met.
7278
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03007279 Example:
7280 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
7281 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
7282 ignore-persist if url_static
7283
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007284 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
7285
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007286load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
7287 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
7288 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7289 yes | no | yes | yes
7290
7291 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
7292 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
7293 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007294 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007295 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
7296 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
7297 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
7298 over the stats socket and redirect output.
7299
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007300 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007301 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02007302 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007303
7304 Arguments:
7305 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
7306 named "server-state-file".
7307
7308 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
7309 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
7310 name is used as a file name.
7311
7312 none don't load any stat for this backend
7313
7314 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01007315 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
7316 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
7317 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007318 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01007319 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007320
7321 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
7322 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
7323
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007324 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007325
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007326 global
7327 stats socket /tmp/socket
7328 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007329
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007330 defaults
7331 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007332
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007333 backend bk
7334 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
7335 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007336
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007337
7338 Then one can run :
7339
7340 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
7341
7342 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
7343
7344 1
7345 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
7346 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7347 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7348
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007349 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007350
7351 global
7352 stats socket /tmp/socket
7353 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
7354
7355 defaults
7356 load-server-state-from-file local
7357
7358 backend bk
7359 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
7360 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
7361
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007362
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007363 Then one can run :
7364
7365 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
7366
7367 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
7368
7369 1
7370 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
7371 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7372 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7373
7374 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
7375 "show servers state"
7376
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007377
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007378log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01007379log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02007380 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007381no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007382 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
7383 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7384 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007385
7386 Prefix :
7387 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
7388 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
7389 prefix does not allow arguments.
7390
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007391 Arguments :
7392 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
7393 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
7394 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
7395 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
7396 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
7397 parameter.
7398
7399 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
7400 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
7401
7402 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
7403 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
7404 standard syslog port).
7405
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01007406 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
7407 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
7408 standard syslog port).
7409
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007410 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
7411 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
7412 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007413 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007414
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007415 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
7416 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
7417 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
7418 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
7419 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
7420 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
7421 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
7422 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
7423 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
7424 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
7425 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
7426 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
7427 significantly slow haproxy down as non-blocking calls will be
7428 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
7429 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
7430 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007431 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
7432 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007433
7434 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
7435 and "fd@2", see above.
7436
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02007437 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
7438 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
7439 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
7440 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
7441 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
7442 having the logs instantly available.
7443
Emeric Brun94aab062021-04-02 10:41:36 +02007444 - An explicit stream address prefix such as "tcp@","tcp6@",
7445 "tcp4@" or "uxst@" will allocate an implicit ring buffer with
7446 a stream forward server targeting the given address.
7447
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007448 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7449 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01007450
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02007451 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
7452 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
7453 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
7454 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
7455 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
7456 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
7457 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
7458 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
7459 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
7460 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007461 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02007462
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02007463 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
7464 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
7465 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
7466 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
7467 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
7468
7469 <sample_size>
7470 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
7471 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
7472 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
7473 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
7474 (see also <ranges> parameter).
7475
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01007476 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
7477 one of the following :
7478
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01007479 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
7480 field is stripped. This is the default.
7481 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
7482 rfc3164.
7483
7484 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01007485 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
7486
7487 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
7488 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
7489
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02007490 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
7491 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
7492 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
7493 designed to be used with a local log server.
7494
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01007495 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
7496 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
7497 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
7498 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
7499 systemd logger consumes.
7500
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02007501 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
7502 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
7503 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
7504 used with a local log server.
7505
7506 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
7507 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
7508 designed to be used with a local log server.
7509
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007510 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
7511 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
7512 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
7513 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
7514
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007515 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
7516
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01007517 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
7518 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
7519 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
7520
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007521 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
7522 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
7523 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
7524 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007525
7526 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
7527 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
7528 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02007529 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
7530 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
7531 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
7532 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
7533 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007534
7535 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
7536
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007537 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
7538 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
7539 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007540
7541 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
7542 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
7543 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
7544 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
7545
7546 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
7547 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007548
7549 Example :
7550 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007551 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
7552 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
7553 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02007554 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
Emeric Brun94aab062021-04-02 10:41:36 +02007555 log tcp@127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output
7556 # level and send in tcp
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007557 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01007558
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007559
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007560log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01007561 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
7562 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7563 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007564
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01007565 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
7566 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
7567 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
7568 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
7569 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007570
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007571 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
7572 "option httplog" directives.
7573
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02007574log-format-sd <string>
7575 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
7576 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7577 yes | yes | yes | no
7578
7579 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
7580 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
7581 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
7582 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
7583 which covers the log format string in depth.
7584
7585 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
7586 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
7587
7588 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
7589 log format to "rfc5424".
7590
7591 Example :
7592 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
7593
7594
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01007595log-tag <string>
7596 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
7597 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7598 yes | yes | yes | yes
7599
7600 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
7601 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
7602 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
7603 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
7604 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
7605 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
7606 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
7607 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
7608 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007609
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007610max-keep-alive-queue <value>
7611 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
7612 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7613 yes | no | yes | yes
7614
7615 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
7616 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
7617 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
7618 servers.
7619
7620 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
7621 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
7622 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
7623 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
7624 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007625 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007626 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
7627 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
7628 picking a different server.
7629
7630 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
7631 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
7632 even if they have to be queued.
7633
7634 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
7635 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
7636
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01007637max-session-srv-conns <nb>
7638 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
7639 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
7640 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007641
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007642maxconn <conns>
7643 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
7644 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7645 yes | yes | yes | no
7646 Arguments :
7647 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
7648 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
7649 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
7650 closes.
7651
7652 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
7653 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
7654 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
7655 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01007656 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
7657 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
7658 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
7659 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007660
7661 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
7662 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
7663 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
7664
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01007665 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
7666 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02007667
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007668 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
7669
7670
Willy Tarreau77e0dae2020-10-14 15:44:27 +02007671mode { tcp|http }
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007672 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
7673 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7674 yes | yes | yes | yes
7675 Arguments :
7676 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
7677 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
7678 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
7679 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
7680
7681 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
7682 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
7683 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
7684 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
7685 brings HAProxy most of its value.
7686
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007687 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
7688 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
7689 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007690
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02007691 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007692 defaults http_instances
7693 mode http
7694
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007695
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01007696monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007697 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007698 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7699 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007700 Arguments :
7701 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
7702 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007703 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007704 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
7705 backend and its backup.
7706
7707 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
7708 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
7709 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
7710 servers in a list of backends.
7711
7712 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
7713 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
7714 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
7715 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
7716 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
7717 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
7718 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02007719 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
7720 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007721
7722 Example:
7723 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007724 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007725 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
7726 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
7727 monitor-uri /site_alive
7728 monitor fail if site_dead
7729
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02007730 See also : "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007731
7732
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007733monitor-uri <uri>
7734 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
7735 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7736 yes | yes | yes | no
7737 Arguments :
7738 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
7739 health status instead of forwarding the request.
7740
7741 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
7742 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
7743 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
7744 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
7745 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
7746 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
7747 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
7748 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
7749
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01007750 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007751 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
7752 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
7753 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
7754 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
7755 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
7756 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007757
Christopher Faulet6072beb2020-02-18 15:34:58 +01007758 Note: if <uri> starts by a slash ('/'), the matching is performed against the
7759 request's path instead of the request's uri. It is a workaround to let
7760 the HTTP/2 requests match the monitor-uri. Indeed, in HTTP/2, clients
7761 are encouraged to send absolute URIs only.
7762
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007763 Example :
7764 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
7765 frontend www
7766 mode http
7767 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
7768
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02007769 See also : "monitor fail"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007770
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01007771
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007772option abortonclose
7773no option abortonclose
7774 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
7775 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7776 yes | no | yes | yes
7777 Arguments : none
7778
7779 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
7780 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
7781 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
7782 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007783 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007784 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
7785 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
7786 encountered while delivering the response.
7787
7788 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
7789 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
7790 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
7791 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
7792 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
7793 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007794 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007795 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007796 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007797 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
7798 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
7799 still not served and not pollute the servers.
7800
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007801 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
7802 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007803 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
7804 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
7805 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
7806 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
7807 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
7808 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007809 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007810
7811 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7812 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7813
7814 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
7815
7816
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007817option accept-invalid-http-request
7818no option accept-invalid-http-request
7819 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
7820 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7821 yes | yes | yes | no
7822 Arguments : none
7823
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007824 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007825 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007826 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007827 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
7828 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
7829 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
7830 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
7831 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01007832 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
7833 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
7834 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
7835 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007836 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007837 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02007838 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
7839 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
7840 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007841
7842 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
7843 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
7844 been confirmed.
7845
7846 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
7847 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01007848 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
7849 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007850 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
7851
7852 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7853 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7854
7855 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
7856 stats socket.
7857
7858
7859option accept-invalid-http-response
7860no option accept-invalid-http-response
7861 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
7862 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7863 yes | no | yes | yes
7864 Arguments : none
7865
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007866 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007867 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007868 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007869 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
7870 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
7871 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
7872 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
7873 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02007874 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
7875 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
7876 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02007877
7878 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
7879 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
7880 been confirmed.
7881
7882 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
7883 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
7884 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
7885 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
7886
7887 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7888 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7889
7890 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
7891 stats socket.
7892
7893
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007894option allbackups
7895no option allbackups
7896 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
7897 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7898 yes | no | yes | yes
7899 Arguments : none
7900
7901 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
7902 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
7903 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
7904 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
7905 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
7906 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
7907 order between the backup servers anymore.
7908
7909 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
7910 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
7911
7912 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7913 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7914
7915
7916option checkcache
7917no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08007918 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007919 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7920 yes | no | yes | yes
7921 Arguments : none
7922
7923 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
7924 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007925 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007926 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
7927 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007928 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007929
7930 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01007931 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007932 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007933 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
7934 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01007935 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007936 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01007937 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
7938 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007939 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01007940 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
7941 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007942 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007943 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
7944 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
7945 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
7946 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
7947 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
7948 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
7949 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
7950 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
7951 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
7952
7953 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007954 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
7955 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
7956 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
7957 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007958
7959 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
7960 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007961 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007962 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007963
7964 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7965 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7966
7967
7968option clitcpka
7969no option clitcpka
7970 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
7971 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7972 yes | yes | yes | no
7973 Arguments : none
7974
7975 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
7976 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007977 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01007978 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
7979
7980 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
7981 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
7982 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
7983 operating system and its tuning parameters.
7984
7985 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
7986 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
7987 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
7988 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
7989 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
7990
7991 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
7992
7993 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
7994 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
7995 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
7996
7997 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
7998 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
7999
8000 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
8001
8002
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008003option contstats
8004 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
8005 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8006 yes | yes | yes | no
8007 Arguments : none
8008
8009 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
8010 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
8011 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
8012 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01008013 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
8014 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
8015 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
8016 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
8017 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008018
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02008019option disable-h2-upgrade
8020no option disable-h2-upgrade
8021 Enable or disable the implicit HTTP/2 upgrade from an HTTP/1.x client
8022 connection.
8023 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8024 yes | yes | yes | no
8025 Arguments : none
8026
8027 By default, HAProxy is able to implicitly upgrade an HTTP/1.x client
8028 connection to an HTTP/2 connection if the first request it receives from a
8029 given HTTP connection matches the HTTP/2 connection preface (i.e. the string
8030 "PRI * HTTP/2.0\r\n\r\nSM\r\n\r\n"). This way, it is possible to support
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +01008031 HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 clients on a non-SSL connections. This option must be
8032 used to disable the implicit upgrade. Note this implicit upgrade is only
8033 supported for HTTP proxies, thus this option too. Note also it is possible to
8034 force the HTTP/2 on clear connections by specifying "proto h2" on the bind
8035 line. Finally, this option is applied on all bind lines. To disable implicit
8036 HTTP/2 upgrades for a specific bind line, it is possible to use "proto h1".
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02008037
8038 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8039 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008040
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008041option dontlog-normal
8042no option dontlog-normal
8043 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
8044 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8045 yes | yes | yes | no
8046 Arguments : none
8047
8048 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
8049 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
8050 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
8051 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
8052 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
8053 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
8054 logged.
8055
8056 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
8057 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
8058 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
8059
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008060 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008061 logging.
8062
8063
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008064option dontlognull
8065no option dontlognull
8066 Enable or disable logging of null connections
8067 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8068 yes | yes | yes | no
8069 Arguments : none
8070
8071 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
8072 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
8073 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
8074 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
8075 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
8076 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008077 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
8078 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
8079 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008080
8081 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008082 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008083 would not be logged.
8084
8085 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8086 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8087
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008088 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-uri", and
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008089 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008090
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008091
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008092option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008093 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
8094 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8095 yes | yes | yes | yes
8096 Arguments :
8097 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
8098 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008099 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008100 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008101
8102 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
8103 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
8104 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
8105 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
8106 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
8107 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
8108 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008109 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
8110 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
8111 possible that the client has already brought one.
8112
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008113 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008114 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008115 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008116 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008117 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008118 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008119
8120 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
8121 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
8122 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
8123 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
8124 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
8125 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
Christopher Faulet5d1def62021-02-26 09:19:15 +01008126 private networks or 127.0.0.1. IPv4 and IPv6 are both supported.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008127
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008128 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
8129 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
8130 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
8131 are under the control of the end-user.
8132
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008133 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008134 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
8135 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008136 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
8137 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
8138 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008139
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008140 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008141 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
8142 frontend www
8143 mode http
8144 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
8145
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008146 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
8147 backend www
8148 mode http
8149 option forwardfor header X-Client
8150
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008151 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008152 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008153
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008154
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02008155option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
8156no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
8157 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
8158 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8159 yes | yes | yes | no
8160 Arguments : none
8161
8162 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
8163 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
8164 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
8165 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
8166 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
8167 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
8168 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
8169
8170 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
8171 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
8172 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
8173 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
8174 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
8175 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
8176 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
8177 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
8178 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
8179 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
8180
8181 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
8182
8183 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8184 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8185
8186 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
8187 "h1-case-adjust-file".
8188
8189
8190option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
8191no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
8192 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
8193 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8194 yes | no | yes | yes
8195 Arguments : none
8196
8197 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
8198 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
8199 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
8200 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
8201 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
8202 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
8203 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
8204
8205 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
8206 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
8207 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
8208 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
8209 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
8210 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
8211 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
8212 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
8213 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
8214 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
8215
8216 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
8217
8218 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8219 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8220
8221 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
8222 "h1-case-adjust-file".
8223
8224
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008225option http-buffer-request
8226no option http-buffer-request
8227 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
8228 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8229 yes | yes | yes | yes
8230 Arguments : none
8231
8232 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
8233 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
8234 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
8235 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
8236 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
8237 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
Christopher Faulet6db8a2e2019-11-19 16:27:25 +01008238 body is received or the request buffer is full. It can have undesired side
8239 effects with some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered
8240 transmissions between the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely
8241 not be used by default.
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008242
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02008243 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request",
8244 "http-request wait-for-body"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008245
8246
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008247option http-ignore-probes
8248no option http-ignore-probes
8249 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
8250 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8251 yes | yes | yes | no
8252 Arguments : none
8253
8254 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
8255 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
8256 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
8257 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
8258 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
8259 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
8260 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
8261 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
8262 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008263 was received over a connection before it was closed;
8264 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008265 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
8266
8267 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
8268 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
8269 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
8270 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
8271 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
8272 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
8273 are often the only way to detect them.
8274
8275 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8276 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8277
8278 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
8279
8280
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008281option http-keep-alive
8282no option http-keep-alive
8283 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
8284 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8285 yes | yes | yes | yes
8286 Arguments : none
8287
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008288 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8289 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008290 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8291 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008292 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". This option allows to
8293 set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when another mode was used
8294 in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008295
8296 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
8297 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008298 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
8299 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
8300 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
8301 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
8302 situations where this option may be useful :
8303
8304 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008305 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008306
8307 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
8308 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
8309
8310 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
8311 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
8312 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
8313 request.
8314
8315 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
8316 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008317 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
8318 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
8319 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008320
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008321 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
8322 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
8323 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
8324 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
8325 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
8326 not set.
8327
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008328 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
8329 http-server-close". When backend and frontend options differ, all of these 4
8330 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008331
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008332 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008333 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01008334 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008335
8336
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008337option http-no-delay
8338no option http-no-delay
8339 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
8340 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8341 yes | yes | yes | yes
8342 Arguments : none
8343
8344 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
8345 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
8346 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
8347 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
8348 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
8349 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
8350 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
8351 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
8352 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
8353 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
8354 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
8355 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
8356 affected.
8357
8358 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
8359 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
8360 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
8361 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
8362 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
8363 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
8364 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
8365 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
8366 latency environments.
8367
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008368 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
8369
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008370
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008371option http-pretend-keepalive
8372no option http-pretend-keepalive
8373 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
8374 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02008375 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008376 Arguments : none
8377
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008378 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", haproxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008379 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
8380 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
8381 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
8382 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
8383 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
8384 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
8385 consider the response complete.
8386
8387 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
8388 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
8389 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
8390 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008391 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008392 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
8393
8394 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
8395 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
8396 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
8397 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
8398 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
8399 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
8400 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
8401
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02008402 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
8403 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
8404 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
8405 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
8406 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
8407 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008408
8409 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8410 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8411
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008412 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008413 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008414
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008415
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008416option http-server-close
8417no option http-server-close
8418 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
8419 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8420 yes | yes | yes | yes
8421 Arguments : none
8422
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008423 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8424 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
8425 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8426 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008427 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". Setting "option
8428 http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server side
8429 while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the
8430 client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
8431 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
8432 resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits non-keepalive
8433 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
8434 conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers do not
8435 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
8436 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
8437 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008438
8439 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
8440 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
8441 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
8442 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01008443 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
8444 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008445
8446 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
8447 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008448 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
8449 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
8450 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008451
8452 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8453 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8454
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008455 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
8456 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008457
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008458option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008459no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008460 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
8461 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8462 yes | yes | yes | no
8463 Arguments : none
8464
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00008465 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008466 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
8467 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
8468 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
8469 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
8470 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
8471 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
8472
8473 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
8474 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01008475 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
8476 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
8477 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008478
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01008479 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
8480 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
8481 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
8482 front of an existing proxy.
8483
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008484 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
8485
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008486 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008487
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008488option httpchk
8489option httpchk <uri>
8490option httpchk <method> <uri>
8491option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008492 Enables HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008493 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8494 yes | no | yes | yes
8495 Arguments :
8496 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
8497 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
8498 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
8499 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
8500 ones.
8501
8502 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
8503 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
8504 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
8505
8506 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
8507 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
8508 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02008509 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "http-check send" directive to add it.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008510
8511 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
8512 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
8513 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
8514 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
8515 the lack of any response.
8516
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02008517 Combined with "http-check" directives, it is possible to customize the
8518 request sent during the HTTP health checks or the matching rules on the
8519 response. It is also possible to configure a send/expect sequence, just like
8520 with the directive "tcp-check" for TCP health checks.
8521
8522 The server configuration is used by default to open connections to perform
8523 HTTP health checks. By it is also possible to overwrite server parameters
8524 using "http-check connect" rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008525
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02008526 "httpchk" option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works
8527 with plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02008528 bound to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon. However, it will always
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04008529 internally relies on an HTX multiplexer. Thus, it means the request
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02008530 formatting and the response parsing will be strict.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008531
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02008532 Note : For a while, there was no way to add headers or body in the request
8533 used for HTTP health checks. So a workaround was to hide it at the end
8534 of the version string with a "\r\n" after the version. It is now
8535 deprecated. The directive "http-check send" must be used instead.
8536
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008537 Examples :
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008538 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
8539 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
8540 backend https_relay
8541 mode tcp
8542 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1
8543 http-check send hdr Host www
8544 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008545
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09008546 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
8547 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
8548 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008549
8550
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008551option httpclose
8552no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008553 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008554 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8555 yes | yes | yes | yes
8556 Arguments : none
8557
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008558 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8559 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
8560 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8561 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008562 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008563
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008564 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
8565 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05008566 also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008567 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
8568 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008569
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008570 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
8571 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
8572 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008573
8574 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
8575 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008576 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
8577 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
8578 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008579
8580 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8581 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8582
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008583 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008584
8585
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008586option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008587 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
8588 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01008589 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008590 Arguments :
8591 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
8592 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
8593 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008594 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008595 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008596
8597 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
8598 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
8599 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
8600 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
8601 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
8602 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
8603 ports.
8604
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01008605 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
8606 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008607
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02008608 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
8609
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008610 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008611
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008612
8613option http_proxy
8614no option http_proxy
8615 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
8616 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8617 yes | yes | yes | yes
8618 Arguments : none
8619
8620 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
8621 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
8622 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
8623 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
8624 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
8625
8626 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
8627 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01008628 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
8629 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008630
8631 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8632 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8633
8634 Example :
8635 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
8636 backend direct_forward
8637 option httpclose
8638 option http_proxy
8639
8640 See also : "option httpclose"
8641
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008642
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008643option independent-streams
8644no option independent-streams
8645 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008646 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8647 yes | yes | yes | yes
8648 Arguments : none
8649
8650 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
8651 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
8652 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
8653 receive data or not.
8654
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008655 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008656 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
8657 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
8658 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
8659 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
8660 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
8661 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
8662 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
8663 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
8664 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
8665 socket buffers.
8666
8667 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
8668 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
8669 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
8670 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
8671 slow lines, so use it with caution.
8672
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008673 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008674
8675
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02008676option ldap-check
8677 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
8678 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8679 yes | no | yes | yes
8680 Arguments : none
8681
8682 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
8683 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
8684 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
8685 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
8686
8687 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
8688 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
8689
8690 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
8691 configure it.
8692
8693 Example :
8694 option ldap-check
8695
8696 See also : "option httpchk"
8697
8698
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09008699option external-check
8700 Use external processes for server health checks
8701 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8702 yes | no | yes | yes
8703
8704 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
8705 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
8706 command".
8707
8708 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
8709
8710 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
8711
8712
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008713option log-health-checks
8714no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008715 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008716 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8717 yes | no | yes | yes
8718 Arguments : none
8719
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008720 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
8721 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
8722 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008723
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008724 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
8725 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
8726 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
8727 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
8728 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
8729
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008730 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008731 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008732
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02008733 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
8734 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
8735 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008736
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008737
8738option log-separate-errors
8739no option log-separate-errors
8740 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
8741 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8742 yes | yes | yes | no
8743 Arguments : none
8744
8745 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
8746 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
8747 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
8748 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
8749 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
8750 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
8751 provides very important information.
8752
8753 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
8754 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
8755 error logs.
8756
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008757 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008758 logging.
8759
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008760
8761option logasap
8762no option logasap
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02008763 Enable or disable early logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008764 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8765 yes | yes | yes | no
8766 Arguments : none
8767
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02008768 By default, logs are emitted when all the log format variables and sample
8769 fetches used in the definition of the log-format string return a value, or
8770 when the session is terminated. This allows the built in log-format strings
8771 to account for the transfer time, or the number of bytes in log messages.
8772
8773 When handling long lived connections such as large file transfers or RDP,
8774 it may take a while for the request or connection to appear in the logs.
8775 Using "option logasap", the log message is created as soon as the server
8776 connection is established in mode tcp, or as soon as the server sends the
8777 complete headers in mode http. Missing information in the logs will be the
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05008778 total number of bytes which will only indicate the amount of data transferred
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02008779 before the message was created and the total time which will not take the
8780 remainder of the connection life or transfer time into account. For the case
8781 of HTTP, it is good practice to capture the Content-Length response header
8782 so that the logs at least indicate how many bytes are expected to be
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05008783 transferred.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008784
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01008785 Examples :
8786 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
8787 mode http
8788 option httplog
8789 option logasap
8790 log 192.168.2.200 local3
8791
8792 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
8793 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
8794 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
8795 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
8796
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008797 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008798 logging.
8799
8800
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02008801option mysql-check [ user <username> [ { post-41 | pre-41 } ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008802 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008803 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8804 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008805 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008806 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
8807 server.
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02008808 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks (the default)
8809 pre-41 Send pre v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008810
8811 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
8812 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008813 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008814 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
8815 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
8816 in the MySQL table, like this :
8817
8818 USE mysql;
8819 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
8820 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
8821
8822 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008823 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02008824 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
8825 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
8826 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
8827 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
8828 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
8829 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
8830 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
8831
8832 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
8833 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008834
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02008835 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008836
8837 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
8838 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
8839 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
8840 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02008841 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
8842 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01008843
8844 See also: "option httpchk"
8845
8846
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008847option nolinger
8848no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008849 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008850 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8851 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008852 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008853
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008854 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008855 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
8856 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
8857 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
8858 connections.
8859
8860 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
8861 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02008862 a TCP RST is emitted, any pending data are truncated, and the session is
8863 instantly purged from the system's tables. The generally visible effect for
8864 a client is that responses are truncated if the close happens with a last
8865 block of data (e.g. on a redirect or error response). On the server side,
8866 it may help release the source ports immediately when forwarding a client
8867 aborts in tunnels. In both cases, TCP resets are emitted and given that
8868 the session is instantly destroyed, there will be no retransmit. On a lossy
8869 network this can increase problems, especially when there is a firewall on
8870 the lossy side, because the firewall might see and process the reset (hence
8871 purge its session) and block any further traffic for this session,, including
8872 retransmits from the other side. So if the other side doesn't receive it,
8873 it will never receive any RST again, and the firewall might log many blocked
8874 packets.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008875
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02008876 For all these reasons, it is strongly recommended NOT to use this option,
8877 unless absolutely needed as a last resort. In most situations, using the
8878 "client-fin" or "server-fin" timeouts achieves similar results with a more
8879 reliable behavior. On Linux it's also possible to use the "tcp-ut" bind or
8880 server setting.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008881
8882 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
8883 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02008884 for servers. While this option is technically supported in "defaults"
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +05008885 sections, it must really not be used there as it risks to accidentally
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02008886 propagate to sections that must no use it and to cause problems there.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008887
8888 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8889 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8890
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02008891 See also: "timeout client-fin", "timeout server-fin", "tcp-ut" bind or server
8892 keywords.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008893
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008894option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
8895 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
8896 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8897 yes | yes | yes | yes
8898 Arguments :
8899 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
8900 matching <network>
8901 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
8902 header name.
8903
8904 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
8905 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
8906 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
8907 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
8908 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
8909 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
8910 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
8911 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
8912 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
8913 possible that the client has already brought one.
8914
8915 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
8916 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
8917 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
8918 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
8919 header and requires different one.
8920
8921 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
8922 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
8923 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
Amaury Denoyellef8b42922021-03-04 18:41:14 +01008924 header for a known destination address or network by adding the "except"
8925 keyword followed by the network address. In this case, any destination IP
8926 matching the network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common
8927 uses are with private networks or 127.0.0.1. IPv4 and IPv6 are both
8928 supported.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008929
8930 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
8931 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
8932 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
8933 both are defined.
8934
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008935 Examples :
8936 # Original Destination address
8937 frontend www
8938 mode http
8939 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
8940
8941 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
8942 backend www
8943 mode http
8944 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
8945
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008946 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008947
8948
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008949option persist
8950no option persist
8951 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
8952 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8953 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008954 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008955
8956 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
8957 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
8958 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
8959 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
8960 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
8961 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
8962 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
8963 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
8964 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
8965 redirected to another valid server.
8966
8967 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8968 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8969
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01008970 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01008971
8972
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01008973option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
8974 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
8975 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8976 yes | no | yes | yes
8977 Arguments :
8978 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
8979 PostgreSQL server.
8980
8981 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
8982 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
8983 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
8984 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
8985
8986 See also: "option httpchk"
8987
8988
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008989option prefer-last-server
8990no option prefer-last-server
8991 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
8992 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8993 yes | no | yes | yes
8994 Arguments : none
8995
8996 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
8997 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
8998 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
8999 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
9000 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
9001 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
9002 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
9003 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
9004 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01009005 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
9006 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02009007 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
9008 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
9009 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01009010 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
9011 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
9012 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009013
9014 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9015 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9016
9017 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
9018
9019
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009020option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009021option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009022no option redispatch
9023 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
9024 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9025 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009026 Arguments :
9027 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
9028 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
9029 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009030 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009031 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009032 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009033 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
9034 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
9035 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
9036
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009037
9038 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
9039 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
9040 be able to access the service anymore.
9041
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01009042 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
9043 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009044
Olivier Carrère6e6f59b2020-04-15 11:30:18 +02009045 Active servers are selected from a subset of the list of available
9046 servers. Active servers that are not down or in maintenance (i.e., whose
9047 health is not checked or that have been checked as "up"), are selected in the
9048 following order:
9049
9050 1. Any active, non-backup server, if any, or,
9051
9052 2. If the "allbackups" option is not set, the first backup server in the
9053 list, or
9054
9055 3. If the "allbackups" option is set, any backup server.
9056
9057 When a retry occurs, HAProxy tries to select another server than the last
9058 one. The new server is selected from the current list of servers.
9059
9060 Sometimes, if the list is updated between retries (e.g., if numerous retries
9061 occur and last longer than the time needed to check that a server is down,
9062 remove it from the list and fall back on the list of backup servers),
9063 connections may be redirected to a backup server, though.
9064
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009065 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009066 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
9067 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009068
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009069 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9070 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9071
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02009072 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009073
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009074
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02009075option redis-check
9076 Use redis health checks for server testing
9077 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9078 yes | no | yes | yes
9079 Arguments : none
9080
9081 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
9082 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
9083 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
9084 find the "+PONG" response message.
9085
9086 Example :
9087 option redis-check
9088
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009089 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02009090
9091
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009092option smtpchk
9093option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
9094 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
9095 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9096 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009097 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009098 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02009099 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009100 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
9101
9102 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
9103 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
9104 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
9105
9106 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
9107 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
9108 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
9109 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
9110 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
9111 dead server.
9112
9113 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
9114 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009115 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009116 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
9117
9118 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
9119 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
9120 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
9121 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02009122 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009123
9124 Example :
9125 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
9126
9127 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
9128
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009129
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02009130option socket-stats
9131no option socket-stats
9132
9133 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
9134 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9135 yes | yes | yes | no
9136
9137 Arguments : none
9138
9139
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009140option splice-auto
9141no option splice-auto
9142 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
9143 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9144 yes | yes | yes | yes
9145 Arguments : none
9146
9147 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
9148 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009149 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009150 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009151 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009152 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
9153 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
9154 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
9155 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9156
9157 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
9158 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
9159 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
9160 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
9161 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
9162 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
9163 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
9164 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
9165 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
9166 keyword.
9167
9168 Example :
9169 option splice-auto
9170
9171 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9172 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9173
9174 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
9175 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9176
9177
9178option splice-request
9179no option splice-request
9180 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
9181 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9182 yes | yes | yes | yes
9183 Arguments : none
9184
9185 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009186 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009187 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
9188 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
9189 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
9190 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9191
9192 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
9193
9194 Example :
9195 option splice-request
9196
9197 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9198 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9199
9200 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
9201 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9202
9203
9204option splice-response
9205no option splice-response
9206 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
9207 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9208 yes | yes | yes | yes
9209 Arguments : none
9210
9211 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009212 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009213 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
9214 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
9215 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
9216 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9217
9218 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
9219
9220 Example :
9221 option splice-response
9222
9223 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9224 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9225
9226 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
9227 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9228
9229
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01009230option spop-check
9231 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
9232 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9233 no | no | no | yes
9234 Arguments : none
9235
9236 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
9237 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
9238 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
9239 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
9240
9241 Example :
9242 option spop-check
9243
9244 See also : "option httpchk"
9245
9246
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009247option srvtcpka
9248no option srvtcpka
9249 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
9250 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9251 yes | no | yes | yes
9252 Arguments : none
9253
9254 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
9255 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009256 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009257 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
9258
9259 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
9260 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
9261 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
9262 operating system and its tuning parameters.
9263
9264 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
9265 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
9266 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
9267 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
9268 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
9269
9270 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
9271
9272 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
9273 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
9274 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
9275
9276 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9277 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9278
9279 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
9280
9281
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009282option ssl-hello-chk
9283 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
9284 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9285 yes | no | yes | yes
9286 Arguments : none
9287
9288 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
9289 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
9290 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
9291 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
9292 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
9293 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
9294 hello message.
9295
9296 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
9297 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
9298 messages, which is appreciable.
9299
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009300 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
9301 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
9302 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009303
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009304 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
9305
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009306
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009307option tcp-check
9308 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
9309 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9310 yes | no | yes | yes
9311
9312 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
9313 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
9314
9315 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
9316 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
9317 attempt, which remains the default mode.
9318
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009319 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009320 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
9321 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
9322 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
9323 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
9324 only.
9325
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009326 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009327 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
9328 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
9329 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
9330 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
9331
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009332 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009333 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
9334 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009335 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009336 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
9337 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
9338 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
9339 the respective protocols.
9340 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009341 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009342
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009343 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the script.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009344
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009345 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
9346 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr in
9347 debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting. The
9348 "comment" is of course optional.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009349
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009350 During the execution of a health check, a variable scope is made available to
9351 store data samples, using the "tcp-check set-var" operation. Freeing those
9352 variable is possible using "tcp-check unset-var".
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +01009353
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009354
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009355 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009356 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009357 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009358 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009359
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009360 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009361 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009362 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009363
9364 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
9365 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009366 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009367 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009368 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009369 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009370 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009371 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009372 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9373 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009374 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009375 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9376 tcp-check expect string +OK
9377
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009378 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009379 (send many headers before analyzing)
9380 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009381 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009382 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
9383 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
9384 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
9385 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009386 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009387
9388
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009389 See also : "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect" and "tcp-check send".
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009390
9391
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009392option tcp-smart-accept
9393no option tcp-smart-accept
9394 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
9395 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9396 yes | yes | yes | no
9397 Arguments : none
9398
9399 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
9400 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
9401 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
9402 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
9403 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
9404 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
9405
9406 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
9407 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
9408 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
9409 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
9410
9411 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
9412 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
9413 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009414 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009415
9416 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
9417 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
9418 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
9419
9420 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
9421 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
9422 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
9423
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02009424 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
9425
9426
9427option tcp-smart-connect
9428no option tcp-smart-connect
9429 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
9430 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9431 yes | no | yes | yes
9432 Arguments : none
9433
9434 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
9435 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
9436 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
9437 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
9438 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
9439
9440 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
9441 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
9442 complex.
9443
9444 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
9445 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
9446 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
9447
9448 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9449 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9450
9451 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
9452
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009453
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009454option tcpka
9455 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
9456 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9457 yes | yes | yes | yes
9458 Arguments : none
9459
9460 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
9461 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009462 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009463 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
9464
9465 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
9466 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
9467 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
9468 operating system and its tuning parameters.
9469
9470 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
9471 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
9472 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
9473 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
9474 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
9475
9476 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
9477
9478 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
9479 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
9480 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
9481 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
9482 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
9483 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
9484 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
9485 backends.
9486
9487 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
9488
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009489
9490option tcplog
9491 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
9492 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01009493 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009494 Arguments : none
9495
9496 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
9497 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
9498 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
9499 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
9500 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
9501 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
9502 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
9503 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
9504
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02009505 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
9506
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009507 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009508
9509
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009510option transparent
9511no option transparent
9512 Enable client-side transparent proxying
9513 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01009514 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009515 Arguments : none
9516
9517 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
9518 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
9519 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
9520 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
9521 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
9522 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
9523 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
9524 appropriate server.
9525
9526 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
9527 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
9528
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01009529 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009530 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009531
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009532
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009533external-check command <command>
9534 Executable to run when performing an external-check
9535 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9536 yes | no | yes | yes
9537
9538 Arguments :
9539 <command> is the external command to run
9540
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009541 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
9542
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01009543 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009544
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01009545 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
9546 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
9547 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
9548 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
9549 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
9550 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009551
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01009552 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
9553
9554 Environment variables :
9555 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
9556 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
9557
9558 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
9559
9560 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
9561
9562 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
9563 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
9564 for a UNIX socket).
9565
9566 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
9567
9568 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
9569
9570 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
9571
9572 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
9573
9574 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
9575
9576 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
9577 socket).
9578
9579 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
9580 the command may be set using "external-check path".
9581
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +02009582 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
9583
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009584 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
9585 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
9586 failed.
9587
9588 Example :
9589 external-check command /bin/true
9590
9591 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
9592
9593
9594external-check path <path>
9595 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
9596 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9597 yes | no | yes | yes
9598
9599 Arguments :
9600 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
9601
9602 The default path is "".
9603
9604 Example :
9605 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
9606
9607 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
9608 "external-check command"
9609
9610
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009611persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009612persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009613 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
9614 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9615 yes | no | yes | yes
9616 Arguments :
9617 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02009618 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
9619 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009620
9621 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
9622 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009623 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009624 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
9625 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
9626 forwarded to this server.
9627
9628 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
9629 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
9630 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009631 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009632 a single "listen" section.
9633
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02009634 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
9635 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
9636 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
9637
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009638 Example :
9639 listen tse-farm
9640 bind :3389
9641 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
9642 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9643 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
9644 # apply RDP cookie persistence
9645 persist rdp-cookie
9646 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009647 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009648 balance rdp-cookie
9649 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
9650 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
9651
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09009652 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
9653 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009654
9655
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009656rate-limit sessions <rate>
9657 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
9658 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9659 yes | yes | yes | no
9660 Arguments :
9661 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
9662 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
9663
9664 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
9665 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
9666 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
9667 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
9668 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
9669 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
9670
9671 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
9672 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
9673 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
9674 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
9675
9676 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
9677 listen smtp
9678 mode tcp
9679 bind :25
9680 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02009681 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009682
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02009683 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
9684 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
9685 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009686
9687 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
9688
9689
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009690redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9691redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9692redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009693 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
9694 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9695 no | yes | yes | yes
9696
9697 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01009698 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009699
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009700 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009701 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009702 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
9703 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
9704 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009705
9706 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
9707 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
9708 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
9709 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
9710 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009711 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
9712 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
9713 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
9714 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009715
9716 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
9717 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
9718 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
9719 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
9720 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
9721 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009722 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009723 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009724 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
9725 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
9726 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009727
9728 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01009729 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
9730 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
9731 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02009732 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01009733 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
9734 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
9735 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
9736 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009737
9738 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009739 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009740
9741 - "drop-query"
9742 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
9743 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
9744 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
9745 with a location-type redirect.
9746
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01009747 - "append-slash"
9748 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
9749 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
9750 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
9751 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
9752
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009753 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
9754 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
9755 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
9756 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
9757 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
9758 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
9759 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
9760
9761 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
9762 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
9763 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
9764 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
9765 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
9766 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
9767 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009768
9769 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
9770 acl clear dst_port 80
9771 acl secure dst_port 8080
9772 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009773 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01009774 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009775 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
9776
9777 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01009778 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
9779 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
9780 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01009781 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009782
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01009783 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
9784 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
9785 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
9786
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009787 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01009788 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02009789
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009790 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02009791 http-request redirect code 301 location \
9792 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
9793 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01009794
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009795 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02009796
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01009797
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02009798retries <value>
9799 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
9800 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9801 yes | no | yes | yes
9802 Arguments :
9803 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
9804 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
9805 default value is 3.
9806
9807 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
9808 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
9809 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
9810
9811 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009812 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
9813 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02009814
9815 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
9816 server even if a cookie references a different server.
9817
9818 See also : "option redispatch"
9819
9820
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009821retry-on [list of keywords]
Jerome Magnin5ce3c142020-05-13 20:09:57 +02009822 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request.
9823 This setting is only valid when "mode" is set to http and is silently ignored
9824 otherwise.
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009825 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9826 yes | no | yes | yes
9827 Arguments :
9828 <keywords> is a list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each representing a
9829 type of failure event on which an attempt to retry the request
9830 is desired. Please read the notes at the bottom before changing
9831 this setting. The following keywords are supported :
9832
9833 none never retry
9834
9835 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
9836 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
9837
9838 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
9839 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
9840 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
9841 request timeout on the server side, poor network
9842 condition, or a server crash or restart while
9843 processing the request.
9844
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +02009845 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
9846 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
9847 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
9848 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
9849 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
9850 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
9851 overflow attack for example).
9852
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009853 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
9854 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
9855 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
9856 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
9857 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
9858 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
9859 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
9860 amplify denial of service attacks.
9861
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +02009862 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
9863 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
9864 considered to be safe to retry.
9865
Julien Pivotto2de240a2020-11-12 11:14:05 +01009866 <status> any HTTP status code among "401" (Unauthorized), "403"
9867 (Forbidden), "404" (Not Found), "408" (Request Timeout),
9868 "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server Error), "501" (Not
9869 Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway), "503" (Service
9870 Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009871
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +02009872 all-retryable-errors
9873 retry request for any error that are considered
9874 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
9875 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
9876 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
9877
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02009878 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
9879 not cumulative.
9880
9881 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
9882 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
9883 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
9884 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
9885
9886 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
9887 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
9888 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
9889 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
9890 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
9891 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
9892 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
9893 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
9894 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
9895 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
9896 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
9897 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
9898
9899 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
9900 should not use this directive.
9901
9902 The default is "conn-failure".
9903
9904 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
9905
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01009906server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009907 Declare a server in a backend
9908 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9909 no | no | yes | yes
9910 Arguments :
9911 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009912 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05009913 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009914
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01009915 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
9916 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
9917 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
9918 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02009919 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
9920 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
9921 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
9922 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
9923 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009924 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
9925 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
9926 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
9927 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
9928 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
9929 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
9930 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02009931 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02009932 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
9933 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
9934 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
9935 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
9936 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
9937 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02009938 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
9939 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01009940 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
9941 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009942
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02009943 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009944 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
9945 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
9946 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
9947 adding this value to the client's port.
9948
9949 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
9950 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009951 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009952
9953 Examples :
9954 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
9955 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01009956 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02009957 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
9958 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
9959 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009960
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02009961 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
9962 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
9963 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
9964 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
9965 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
9966
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05009967 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
9968 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009969
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +01009970server-state-file-name [ { use-backend-name | <file> } ]
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02009971 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +01009972 this backend.
9973 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9974 no | no | yes | yes
9975
9976 It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file" is set to
9977 "local". When <file> is not provided, if "use-backend-name" is used or if
9978 this directive is not set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a
9979 slash '/', then it is considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is
9980 concatenated to the global directive "server-state-base".
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02009981
9982 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
9983 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
9984
9985 global
9986 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
9987
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +01009988 backend bk
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02009989 load-server-state-from-file
9990
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +01009991 See also: "server-state-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02009992 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009993
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02009994server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
9995 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
9996 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
9997 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9998 no | no | yes | yes
9999
10000 Arguments:
10001 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
10002
10003 <num | range>
10004 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
10005 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
10006 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
10007 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
10008
10009 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
10010
10011 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
10012
10013 <params*>
10014 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
10015 keyword.
10016
10017 Examples:
10018 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
10019 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
10020 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
10021
10022 # or
10023 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
10024
10025 # would be equivalent to:
10026 server srv1 google.com:80 check
10027 server srv2 google.com:80 check
10028 server srv3 google.com:80 check
10029
10030
10031
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010032source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010033source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +010010034source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010035 Set the source address for outgoing connections
10036 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10037 yes | no | yes | yes
10038 Arguments :
10039 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
10040 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010041
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010042 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010043 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
10044 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
10045 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
10046 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
10047 supported prefixes are :
10048 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
10049 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
10050 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +020010051 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020010052 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
10053 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010054
10055 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
10056 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020010057 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
10058 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
10059 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010060
10061 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
10062 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
10063 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
10064 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
10065 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
10066 <addr>.
10067
10068 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
10069 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
10070 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
10071 port.
10072
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010073 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
10074 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
10075 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
10076 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +010010077 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010078 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
10079 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
10080 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
10081 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
10082 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
10083 HTTP header.
10084
10085 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
10086 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010087 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010088 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
10089 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
10090 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
10091 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
10092 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
10093 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
10094 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
10095
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +010010096 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
10097 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
10098 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
10099 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
10100 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
10101 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
10102
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010103 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
10104 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
10105 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
10106 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
10107
10108 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
10109 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
10110 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
10111 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
10112 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
10113 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
10114
10115 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
10116 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
10117 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
10118 there are two methods :
10119
10120 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
10121 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
10122 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
10123 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
10124 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
10125 of the client ranges may be used.
10126
10127 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
10128 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
10129 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
10130 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
10131 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
10132 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
10133 same session.
10134
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010135 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
10136 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
10137 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010138 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010139
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +020010140 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
10141
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010142 Examples :
10143 backend private
10144 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
10145 source 192.168.1.200
10146
10147 backend transparent_ssl1
10148 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
10149 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
10150
10151 backend transparent_ssl2
10152 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
10153 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
10154 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
10155
10156 backend transparent_ssl3
10157 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
10158 # is more conntrack-friendly.
10159 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
10160
10161 backend transparent_smtp
10162 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
10163 # with Tproxy version 4.
10164 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
10165
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010166 backend transparent_http
10167 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
10168 # proxy.
10169 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
10170
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010171 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010172 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
10173
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010174
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010175srvtcpka-cnt <count>
10176 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
10177 the connection on the server side.
10178 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10179 yes | no | yes | yes
10180 Arguments :
10181 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
10182
10183 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
10184 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010185 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10186 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010187
10188 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-idle", "srvtcpka-intvl".
10189
10190
10191srvtcpka-idle <timeout>
10192 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
10193 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
10194 server side.
10195 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10196 yes | no | yes | yes
10197 Arguments :
10198 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
10199 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
10200 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
10201 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
10202
10203 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
10204 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010205 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10206 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010207
10208 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-intvl".
10209
10210
10211srvtcpka-intvl <timeout>
10212 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the server side.
10213 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10214 yes | no | yes | yes
10215 Arguments :
10216 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
10217 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
10218 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
10219 document.
10220
10221 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
10222 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010223 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10224 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010225
10226 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-idle".
10227
10228
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010229stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
10230 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
10231 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010232 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010233
10234 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
10235 matched.
10236
10237 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
10238 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
10239
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010240 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10241 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010242 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010243
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +010010244 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
10245 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
10246 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
10247 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010248
10249 Example :
10250 # statistics admin level only for localhost
10251 backend stats_localhost
10252 stats enable
10253 stats admin if LOCALHOST
10254
10255 Example :
10256 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
10257 backend stats_auth
10258 stats enable
10259 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
10260 stats admin if TRUE
10261
10262 Example :
10263 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
10264 userlist stats-auth
10265 group admin users admin
10266 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
10267 group readonly users haproxy
10268 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
10269
10270 backend stats_auth
10271 stats enable
10272 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
10273 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
10274 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
10275 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
10276
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010277 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
10278 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
10279 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010280
10281
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010282stats auth <user>:<passwd>
10283 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
10284 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010285 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010286 Arguments :
10287 <user> is a user name to grant access to
10288
10289 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
10290
10291 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
10292 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
10293 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
10294 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
10295 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
10296 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
10297
10298 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
10299 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
10300 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020010301 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010302
10303 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
10304 report using "stats scope".
10305
10306 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10307 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10308 unobvious parameters.
10309
10310 Example :
10311 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10312 backend public_www
10313 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10314 stats enable
10315 stats hide-version
10316 stats scope .
10317 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010318 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010319 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10320 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10321
10322 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10323 backend private_monitoring
10324 stats enable
10325 stats uri /admin?stats
10326 stats refresh 5s
10327
10328 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
10329
10330
10331stats enable
10332 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
10333 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010334 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010335 Arguments : none
10336
10337 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
10338 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
10339 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
10340 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
10341 - stats auth : no authentication
10342 - stats scope : no restriction
10343
10344 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10345 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10346 unobvious parameters.
10347
10348 Example :
10349 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10350 backend public_www
10351 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10352 stats enable
10353 stats hide-version
10354 stats scope .
10355 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010356 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010357 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10358 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10359
10360 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10361 backend private_monitoring
10362 stats enable
10363 stats uri /admin?stats
10364 stats refresh 5s
10365
10366 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10367
10368
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010369stats hide-version
10370 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010371 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010372 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010373 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010374
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010375 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
10376 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
10377 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
10378 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
10379 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
10380 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010381
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020010382 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10383 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10384 unobvious parameters.
10385
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010386 Example :
10387 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10388 backend public_www
10389 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020010390 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010391 stats hide-version
10392 stats scope .
10393 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010394 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010395 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10396 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010397
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010398 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10399 backend private_monitoring
10400 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010401 stats uri /admin?stats
10402 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +010010403
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010404 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010405
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010010406
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +020010407stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
10408 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
10409 Access control for statistics
10410
10411 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10412 no | no | yes | yes
10413
10414 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
10415 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
10416 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
10417 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
10418 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
10419 should be asked to enter a username and password.
10420
10421 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
10422 instance.
10423
10424 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
10425 about ACL usage.
10426
10427
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010428stats realm <realm>
10429 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
10430 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010431 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010432 Arguments :
10433 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
10434 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
10435 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
10436
10437 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
10438 using a backslash ('\').
10439
10440 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
10441 only related to authentication.
10442
10443 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10444 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10445 unobvious parameters.
10446
10447 Example :
10448 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10449 backend public_www
10450 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10451 stats enable
10452 stats hide-version
10453 stats scope .
10454 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010455 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010456 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10457 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10458
10459 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10460 backend private_monitoring
10461 stats enable
10462 stats uri /admin?stats
10463 stats refresh 5s
10464
10465 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
10466
10467
10468stats refresh <delay>
10469 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
10470 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010471 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010472 Arguments :
10473 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
10474 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
10475 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
10476 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
10477 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
10478 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
10479
10480 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
10481 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
10482 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
Jackie Tapia749f74c2020-07-22 18:59:40 -050010483 they want automatic refresh of the page or not.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010484
10485 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10486 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10487 unobvious parameters.
10488
10489 Example :
10490 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10491 backend public_www
10492 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10493 stats enable
10494 stats hide-version
10495 stats scope .
10496 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010497 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010498 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10499 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10500
10501 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10502 backend private_monitoring
10503 stats enable
10504 stats uri /admin?stats
10505 stats refresh 5s
10506
10507 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10508
10509
10510stats scope { <name> | "." }
10511 Enable statistics and limit access scope
10512 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010513 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010514 Arguments :
10515 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
10516 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
10517 section in which the statement appears.
10518
10519 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
10520 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
10521 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
10522 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
10523 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
10524 exists.
10525
10526 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10527 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10528 unobvious parameters.
10529
10530 Example :
10531 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10532 backend public_www
10533 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10534 stats enable
10535 stats hide-version
10536 stats scope .
10537 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010538 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010539 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10540 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10541
10542 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10543 backend private_monitoring
10544 stats enable
10545 stats uri /admin?stats
10546 stats refresh 5s
10547
10548 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10549
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010550
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010551stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010552 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
10553 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010554 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010555
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010556 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010557 description from global section is automatically used instead.
10558
10559 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
10560 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
10561
10562 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10563 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010564 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010565
10566 Example :
10567 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10568 backend private_monitoring
10569 stats enable
10570 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
10571 stats uri /admin?stats
10572 stats refresh 5s
10573
10574 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
10575 global section.
10576
10577
10578stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010579 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
10580 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10581 yes | yes | yes | yes
10582 Arguments : none
10583
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010584 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010585 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
10586 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
10587 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
10588 - IP (socket, server)
10589 - cookie (backend, server)
10590
10591 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10592 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010593 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010594
10595 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
10596
10597
Amaury Denoyelle0b70a8a2020-10-05 11:49:45 +020010598stats show-modules
10599 Enable display of extra statistics module on the statistics page
10600 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10601 yes | yes | yes | yes
10602 Arguments : none
10603
10604 New columns are added at the end of the line containing the extra statistics
10605 values as a tooltip.
10606
10607 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10608 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10609 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
10610
10611 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
10612
10613
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010614stats show-node [ <name> ]
10615 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
10616 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010617 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010618 Arguments:
10619 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
10620 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
10621
10622 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
10623 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010624 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010625
10626 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10627 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10628 unobvious parameters.
10629
10630 Example:
10631 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10632 backend private_monitoring
10633 stats enable
10634 stats show-node Europe-1
10635 stats uri /admin?stats
10636 stats refresh 5s
10637
10638 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
10639 section.
10640
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010641
10642stats uri <prefix>
10643 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
10644 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010645 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010646 Arguments :
10647 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
10648 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
10649 query string.
10650
10651 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
10652 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
10653 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
10654 possible to reach it in the application.
10655
10656 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010657 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010658 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
10659 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
10660 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
10661 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
10662
10663 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
10664 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
10665 an address or a port to statistics only.
10666
10667 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10668 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10669 unobvious parameters.
10670
10671 Example :
10672 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10673 backend public_www
10674 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10675 stats enable
10676 stats hide-version
10677 stats scope .
10678 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010679 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010680 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10681 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10682
10683 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10684 backend private_monitoring
10685 stats enable
10686 stats uri /admin?stats
10687 stats refresh 5s
10688
10689 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
10690
10691
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010692stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
10693 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010694 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010695 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010696
10697 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010698 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010699 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010700 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010701 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
10702
10703 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
10704 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
10705 the "stick-table" statement.
10706
10707 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
10708 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
10709 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
10710 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
10711 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
10712
10713 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
10714 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
10715 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
10716 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
10717 transformation rules.
10718
10719 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
10720 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
10721 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
10722 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
10723 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
10724 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
10725 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
10726
10727 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
10728 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
10729 ACL based conditions.
10730
10731 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
10732 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
10733 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
10734 matches can be used as fallbacks.
10735
10736 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
10737 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
10738 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
10739 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
10740
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010741 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10742 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010743 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010744
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010745 Example :
10746 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
10747 # last 30 minutes
10748 backend pop
10749 mode tcp
10750 balance roundrobin
10751 stick store-request src
10752 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
10753 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
10754 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
10755
10756 backend smtp
10757 mode tcp
10758 balance roundrobin
10759 stick match src table pop
10760 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
10761 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
10762
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010763 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010764 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010765
10766
10767stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
10768 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
10769 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10770 no | no | yes | yes
10771
10772 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
10773 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
10774 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
10775 for writing more maintainable configurations.
10776
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010777 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10778 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010779 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010780
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010781 Examples :
10782 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +010010783 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010784
10785 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
10786 stick match src table pop if !localhost
10787 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
10788
10789
10790 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
10791 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
10792 backend http
10793 mode http
10794 balance roundrobin
10795 stick on src table https
10796 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
10797 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
10798 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
10799
10800 backend https
10801 mode tcp
10802 balance roundrobin
10803 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
10804 stick on src
10805 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
10806 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
10807
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010808 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010809
10810
10811stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
10812 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
10813 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10814 no | no | yes | yes
10815
10816 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010817 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010818 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010819 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010820 server is selected.
10821
10822 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
10823 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
10824 the "stick-table" statement.
10825
10826 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
10827 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
10828 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
10829 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
10830 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
10831 address.
10832
10833 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
10834 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
10835 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
10836 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
10837 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
10838 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
10839 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
10840 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
10841 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
10842 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
10843
10844 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
10845 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
10846 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
10847 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
10848 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
10849 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
10850 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
10851
10852 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
10853 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
10854 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
10855 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
10856
10857 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
10858 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
10859 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
10860 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
10861 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
10862 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010010863 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
10864 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
10865 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
10866 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
10867 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
10868 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010869
10870 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
10871 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
10872 the request.
10873
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010874 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10875 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010876 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010877
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010878 Example :
10879 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
10880 # last 30 minutes
10881 backend pop
10882 mode tcp
10883 balance roundrobin
10884 stick store-request src
10885 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
10886 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
10887 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
10888
10889 backend smtp
10890 mode tcp
10891 balance roundrobin
10892 stick match src table pop
10893 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
10894 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
10895
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010896 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010897 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010898
10899
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010900stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070010901 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>] [srvkey <srvkey>]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020010902 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +080010903 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010904 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020010905 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010906
10907 Arguments :
10908 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
10909 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
10910 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
10911 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
10912
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +010010913 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
10914 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
10915 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
10916 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
10917
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010918 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
10919 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
10920 instance.
10921
10922 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
10923 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
10924 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
10925 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
10926 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
10927 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010928 to 32 characters.
10929
10930 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
10931 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
10932 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020010933 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010934 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
10935 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010936
10937 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020010938 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
10939 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010940 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
10941 increase.
10942
10943 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010010944 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
10945 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
10946 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010947
10948 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
10949 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
10950 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
10951 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010952 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010953 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
10954 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
10955 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
10956 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
10957 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
10958 parameter (see below).
10959
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020010960 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
10961 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
10962 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
10963 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
10964 soft restart.
10965
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +020010966 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
10967 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010968
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010969 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
10970 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
10971 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
10972 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +010010973 section 2.5 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010974 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010010975 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
10976 if not expiration delay is specified.
10977
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070010978 <srvkey> specifies how each server is identified for the purposes of the
10979 stick table. The valid values are "name" and "addr". If "name" is
10980 given, then <name> argument for the server (may be generated by
10981 a template). If "addr" is given, then the server is identified
10982 by its current network address, including the port. "addr" is
10983 especially useful if you are using service discovery to generate
10984 the addresses for servers with peered stick-tables and want
10985 to consistently use the same host across peers for a stickiness
10986 token.
10987
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020010988 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
10989 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
10990 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
10991 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010992 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
10993 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
10994 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
10995 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
10996 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
10997 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
10998 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
10999 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
11000 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
11001 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
11002 types and their arguments.
11003
11004 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
11005 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
11006 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
11007 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
11008
11009 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11010 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11011 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011012 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011013
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011014 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
11015 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
11016 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011017 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011018 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011019 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011020
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011021 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11022 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11023 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
11024 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
11025
11026 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
11027 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
11028 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
11029 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
11030 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
11031 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
11032
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011033 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
11034 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
11035 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
11036 they were received.
11037
11038 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11039 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
11040 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
11041 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
11042 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
11043
11044 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11045 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11046 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11047 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
11048 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11049
11050 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
11051 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
11052 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
11053
11054 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11055 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11056 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11057 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
11058 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11059
11060 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11061 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
11062 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
11063 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
11064 the client side.
11065
11066 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11067 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11068 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11069 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
11070 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
11071 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
11072 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
11073
11074 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11075 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
11076 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
11077 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
11078 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
11079 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011080 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011081
11082 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11083 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11084 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11085 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
11086 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
11087 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11088
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010011089 - http_fail_cnt : HTTP Failure Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11090 counts the absolute number of HTTP response failures induced by servers
11091 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
11092 responses, as well as any 5xx response other than 501 or 505. It aims at
11093 being used combined with path or URI to detect service failures.
11094
11095 - http_fail_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
11096 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11097 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11098 HTTP response failure rate over that period, in requests per period (see
11099 http_fail_cnt above for what is accounted as a failure). The result is an
11100 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11101
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011102 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011103 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011104 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
11105 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
11106
11107 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11108 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11109 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11110 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
11111 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
11112 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
11113 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
11114 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
11115 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
11116 recommended for better fairness.
11117
11118 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011119 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011120 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
11121 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
11122
11123 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
11124 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11125 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11126 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
11127 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
11128 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
11129 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
11130 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
11131 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
11132 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020011133
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020011134 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
11135 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011136 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
11137 reference it.
11138
11139 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
11140 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +010011141 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
11142 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
11143 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011144
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011145 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
11146 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
11147 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
11148 something that can be ignored.
11149
11150 Example:
11151 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
11152 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
11153 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
11154 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
11155
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +010011156 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.5
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +010011157 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011158
11159
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011160stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +010011161 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011162 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11163 no | no | yes | yes
11164
11165 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011166 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011167 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011168 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011169 server is selected.
11170
11171 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
11172 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
11173 the "stick-table" statement.
11174
11175 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
11176 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
11177 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
11178 when the response is a SSL server hello.
11179
11180 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11181 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
11182 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
11183 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
11184 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
11185 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011186 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011187 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
11188 rules.
11189
11190 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11191 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11192 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11193 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11194 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11195 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11196 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11197
11198 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
11199 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
11200 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
11201 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
11202
11203 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
11204 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
11205 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
11206 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
11207 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
11208 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010011209 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
11210 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
11211 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
11212 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
11213 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
11214 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
11215 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
11216 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
11217 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011218
11219 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
11220
11221 Example :
11222 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
11223 backend https
11224 mode tcp
11225 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011226 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011227 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011228
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011229 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
11230 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
11231
11232 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
11233 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
11234 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
11235
11236 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
11237 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011238
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011239 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
11240 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
11241 # at offset 44.
11242
11243 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
11244 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
11245
11246 # Learn on response if server hello.
11247 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011248
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011249 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
11250 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
11251
11252 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
11253 extraction.
11254
11255
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011256tcp-check comment <string>
11257 Defines a comment for the following the tcp-check rule, reported in logs if
11258 it fails.
11259 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11260 yes | no | yes | yes
11261
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011262 Arguments :
11263 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following tcp-check
11264 rule fails.
11265
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011266 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
11267 user-friendly error reporting.
11268
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011269 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send" and
11270 "tcp-check expect".
11271
11272
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011273tcp-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy] [via-socks4]
11274 [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020011275 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011276 Opens a new connection
11277 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011278 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011279
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011280 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011281 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11282
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020011283 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040011284 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020011285
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020011286 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011287 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
11288 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020011289 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011290
11291 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011292
11293 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
11294
Christopher Faulet085426a2020-03-30 13:07:02 +020011295 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
11296
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011297 ssl opens a ciphered connection
11298
Christopher Faulet79b31d42020-03-30 13:00:05 +020011299 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
11300
Christopher Faulet98572322020-03-30 13:16:44 +020011301 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
11302 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
11303 for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
11304 If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
11305
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020011306 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
11307 It must be a TCP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
11308 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
11309 haproxy -vv.
11310
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011311 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011312
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011313 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
11314 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
11315 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
11316
11317 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
11318 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
11319 of the sequence.
11320
11321 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
11322 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
11323 do.
11324
11325 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
11326 unset-var or comment rules.
11327
11328 Examples :
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011329 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
11330 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
11331 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
11332 option tcp-check
11333 tcp-check connect
11334 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
11335 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
11336 tcp-check send \r\n
11337 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
11338 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
11339 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
11340 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
11341 tcp-check send \r\n
11342 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
11343 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
11344
11345 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
11346 option tcp-check
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011347 tcp-check connect port 110 linger
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011348 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
11349 tcp-check connect port 143
11350 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
11351 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
11352
11353 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
11354
11355
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011356tcp-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011357 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020011358 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011359 [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011360 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011361 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011362 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011363
11364 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011365 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11366
Gaetan Rivet1afd8262020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011367 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
11368 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
11369 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
11370 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
11371 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
11372 incomplete. If an exact string (string or binary) is used, the
11373 minimum between the string length and this parameter is used.
11374 This parameter is ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule
11375 does not match, the check will wait for more data. If set to 0,
11376 the evaluation result is always conclusive.
11377
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011378 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011379 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring", "binary" or
11380 "rbinary".
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011381 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
11382 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
11383 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
11384
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011385 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
11386 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
11387 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011388 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
11389 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010011390 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
11391 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011392 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
11393 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011394 By default "L7OK" is used.
11395
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011396 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
11397 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010011398 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
11399 supported :
11400 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
11401 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011402 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
11403 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
11404 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
11405 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
11406 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011407
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011408 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011409 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011410 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
11411 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
11412 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
11413 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011414 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
11415
Christopher Fauletbe52b4d2020-04-01 16:30:22 +020011416 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
11417 informational message reported in logs if the expect
11418 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
11419 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
11420
11421 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
11422 informational message reported in logs if an error
11423 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
11424 log-format string.
11425
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020011426 status-code <expr> is optional and can be used to set the check status code
11427 reported in logs, on success or on error. <expr> is a
11428 standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11429 followed by some converters.
11430
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011431 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
11432 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
11433 with the usual backslash ('\').
11434 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011435 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011436 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
11437 used upper or lower case.
11438
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011439 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
11440
11441 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
11442 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11443 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
11444 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
11445 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
11446 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
11447 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
11448 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
11449
11450 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
11451 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11452 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
11453 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
11454 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
11455 expression.
11456
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020011457 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the response's buffer.
11458 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11459 response's buffer contains the string resulting of the
11460 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
11461 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
11462 considered invalid if the buffer contains the string.
11463
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011464 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
11465 in the response buffer. A health check response will
11466 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
11467 this exact hexadecimal string.
11468 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
11469
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011470 rbinary <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer, like
11471 "rstring". However, the response buffer is transformed
11472 into its hexadecimal form, including NUL-bytes. This
11473 allows using all regex engines to match any binary
11474 content. The hexadecimal transformation takes twice the
11475 size of the original response. As such, the expected
11476 pattern should work on at-most half the response buffer
11477 size.
11478
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020011479 binary-lf <hexfmt> : test a log-format string in its hexadecimal form
11480 match in the response's buffer. A health check response
11481 will be considered valid if the response's buffer
11482 contains the hexadecimal string resulting of the
11483 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format
11484 rules. If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
11485 considered invalid if the buffer contains the
11486 hexadecimal string. The hexadecimal string is converted
11487 in a binary string before matching the response's
11488 buffer.
11489
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011490 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011491 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011492 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
11493 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
11494 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
11495 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
11496 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
11497 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
11498 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
11499 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
11500 the null character.
11501
11502 Examples :
11503 # perform a POP check
11504 option tcp-check
11505 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
11506
11507 # perform an IMAP check
11508 option tcp-check
11509 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
11510
11511 # look for the redis master server
11512 option tcp-check
11513 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +020011514 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011515 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
11516 tcp-check expect string role:master
11517 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
11518 tcp-check expect string +OK
11519
11520
11521 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011522 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011523
11524
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011525tcp-check send <data> [comment <msg>]
11526tcp-check send-lf <fmt> [comment <msg>]
11527 Specify a string or a log-format string to be sent as a question during a
11528 generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011529 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011530 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011531
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011532 Arguments :
11533 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11534
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011535 <data> is the string that will be sent during a generic health
11536 check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020011537
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011538 <fmt> is the log-format string that will be sent, once evaluated,
11539 during a generic health check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011540
11541 Examples :
11542 # look for the redis master server
11543 option tcp-check
11544 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
11545 tcp-check expect string role:master
11546
11547 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011548 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011549
11550
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011551tcp-check send-binary <hexstring> [comment <msg>]
11552tcp-check send-binary-lf <hexfmt> [comment <msg>]
11553 Specify an hex digits string or an hex digits log-format string to be sent as
11554 a binary question during a raw tcp health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011555 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011556 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011557
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011558 Arguments :
11559 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011560
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011561 <hexstring> is the hexadecimal string that will be send, once converted
11562 to binary, during a generic health check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020011563
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011564 <hexfmt> is the hexadecimal log-format string that will be send, once
11565 evaluated and converted to binary, during a generic health
11566 check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011567
11568 Examples :
11569 # redis check in binary
11570 option tcp-check
11571 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
11572 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
11573
11574
11575 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011576 "tcp-check send", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011577
11578
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011579tcp-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011580 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011581 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011582 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011583
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011584 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011585 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
11586 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
11587 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
11588 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
11589 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
11590 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
11591 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
11592 and '-'.
11593
11594 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
11595
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011596 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011597 tcp-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
11598
11599
11600tcp-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011601 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011602 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011603 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011604
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011605 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011606 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
11607 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
11608 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
11609 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
11610 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
11611 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
11612 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
11613 and '-'.
11614
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011615 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011616 tcp-check unset-var(check.port)
11617
11618
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011619tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11620 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020011621 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11622 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011623 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020011624 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11625 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020011626
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011627 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011628
11629 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
11630 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011631 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
11632 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
11633 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
11634 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
11635 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
11636 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011637
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011638 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
11639 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
11640 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
11641 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011642
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020011643 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011644 - accept :
11645 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11646 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
11647 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011648
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011649 - reject :
11650 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
11651 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
11652 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
11653 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
11654 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
11655 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
11656 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
11657 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
11658 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
11659 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
11660 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011661 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011662
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020011663 - expect-proxy layer4 :
11664 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
11665 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
11666 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
11667 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
11668 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
11669 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
11670 hosts.
11671
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010011672 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
11673 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
11674 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
11675 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
11676 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
11677 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
11678 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
11679 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
11680
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011681 - capture <sample> len <length> :
11682 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
11683 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
11684 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
11685 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
11686 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
11687 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
11688 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
11689 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020011690 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
11691 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011692
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011693 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011694 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020011695 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
11696 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
11697 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050011698 haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
Matteo Contrini1857b8c2020-10-16 17:35:54 +020011699 and (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020011700 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
11701 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
11702 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
11703 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
11704 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
11705 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
11706 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011707
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011708 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011709 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011710 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011711 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011712 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
11713 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
11714 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011715
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011716 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
11717 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
11718 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
11719 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011720
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011721 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
11722 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
11723 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
11724 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
11725 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011726 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
11727 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
11728 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
11729 layer7 information is extracted.
11730
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011731 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
11732 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
11733 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
11734 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
11735 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011736
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020011737 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
11738 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
11739 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
11740 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
11741
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011742 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
11743 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
11744 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
11745 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
11746
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011747 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }:
11748 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
11749 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
11750 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
11751 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011752
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011753 - set-src <expr> :
11754 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
11755 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
11756 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020011757 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011758
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020011759 Arguments:
11760 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11761 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011762
11763 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011764 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
11765
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011766 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
11767 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020011768
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011769 - set-src-port <expr> :
11770 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
11771 expression.
11772
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020011773 Arguments:
11774 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11775 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011776
11777 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011778 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
11779
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011780 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
11781 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
11782 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020011783
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020011784 - set-dst <expr> :
11785 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
11786 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
11787 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
11788 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
11789 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
11790
11791 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11792 followed by some converters.
11793
11794 Example:
11795
11796 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
11797 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
11798
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011799 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
11800 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
11801
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020011802 - set-dst-port <expr> :
11803 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
11804 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
11805 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
11806
11807
11808 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11809 followed by some converters.
11810
11811 Example:
11812
11813 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
11814
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020011815 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
11816 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
11817 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
11818
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011819 - "silent-drop" :
11820 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011821 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011822 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
11823 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
11824 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
11825 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
11826 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011827 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
11828 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011829 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
11830 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011831 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011832 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
11833 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
11834 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
11835 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
11836
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011837 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
11838 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11839 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011840
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011841 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
11842 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
11843 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011844
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011845 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011846 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011847 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011848
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011849 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
11850 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
11851 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011852
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011853 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011854 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
11855 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011856
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020011857 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
11858
11859 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
11860
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011861 See section 7 about ACL usage.
11862
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011863 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020011864
11865
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011866tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
11867 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011868 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020011869 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011870 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020011871 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
11872 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011873
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011874 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011875
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011876 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011877 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
11878 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010011879 "accept", a "reject" or a "switch-mode" rule matches, or the TCP request
11880 inspection delay expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011881
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011882 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
11883 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
11884 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
11885 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010011886 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
11887 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
11888 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
11889 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
11890 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
11891 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030011892 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010011893 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011894
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011895 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
11896 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
11897 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
11898 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011899
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020011900 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011901 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010011902 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020011903 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
11904 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040011905 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020011906 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020011907 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011908 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010011909 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020011910 - set-dst <expr>
11911 - set-dst-port <expr>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011912 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010011913 - switch-mode http [ proto <name> ]
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011914 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020011915 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011916 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010011917 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011918
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011919 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
11920 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010011921 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
11922 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011923
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010011924 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
11925 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
11926 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
11927 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
11928 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
11929 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011930
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011931 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011932 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
11933 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011934
Christopher Faulet2079a4a2020-10-02 11:48:57 +020011935 Note also that it is recommended to use a "tcp-request session" rule to track
11936 information that does *not* depend on Layer 7 contents, especially for HTTP
11937 frontends. Some HTTP processing are performed at the session level and may
11938 lead to an early rejection of the requests. Thus, the tracking at the content
11939 level may be disturbed in such case. A warning is emitted during startup to
11940 prevent, as far as possible, such unreliable usage.
11941
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020011942 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Christopher Faulet7ea509e2020-10-02 11:38:46 +020011943 rules from a TCP proxy, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to
11944 preliminarily parse the contents of a buffer before extracting the required
11945 data. If the buffered contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the
11946 ACL does not match. The parser which is involved there is exactly the same
11947 as for all other HTTP processing, so there is no risk of parsing something
11948 differently. In an HTTP frontend or an HTTP backend, it is guaranteed that
11949 HTTP contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated
11950 first because the HTTP parsing is performed in the early stages of the
11951 connection processing, at the session level. But for such proxies, using
11952 "http-request" rules is much more natural and recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020011953
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011954 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020011955 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
11956 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
11957 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010011958
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020011959 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
11960 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
11961
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011962 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020011963 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
11964 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011965
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011966 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
11967 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010011968 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011969 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
11970 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011971 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011972 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011973 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010011974 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
11975 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011976 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010011977 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
11978 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020011979
11980 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11981 followed by some converters.
11982
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010011983 The "switch-mode" is used to perform a conntection upgrade. Only HTTP
11984 upgrades are supported for now. The protocol may optionally be
11985 specified. This action is only available for a proxy with the frontend
11986 capability. The connection upgrade is immediately performed, following
11987 "tcp-request content" rules are not evaluated. This upgrade method should be
11988 preferred to the implicit one consisting to rely on the backend mode. When
11989 used, it is possible to set HTTP directives in a frontend without any
11990 warning. These directives will be conditionnaly evaluated if the HTTP upgrade
11991 is performed. However, an HTTP backend must still be selected. It remains
11992 unsupported to route an HTTP connection (upgraded or not) to a TCP server.
11993
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +010011994 See section 4 about Proxies for more details on HTTP upgrades.
11995
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010011996 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
11997 <var-name>.
11998
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040011999 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
12000 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
12001 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
12002 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
12003 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
12004
12005 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
12006 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
12007 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
12008 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
12009 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
12010 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
12011 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
12012 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
12013 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
12014 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
12015 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
12016
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012017 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
12018 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
12019 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
12020 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
12021 the SPOE agent name must be used.
12022
12023 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
12024
12025 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
12026
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010012027 The "use-service" is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the
12028 request and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to
12029 reply by sending any valid response or it may immediately close the
12030 connection without sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible
12031 to write your own services in Lua. No further "tcp-request" rules are
12032 evaluated.
12033
12034 Example:
12035 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
12036
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012037 Example:
12038
12039 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012040 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012041
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012042 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012043 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012044 # and reject everything else. (Only works for HTTP/1 connections)
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012045 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
12046 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020012047 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012048 tcp-request content reject
12049
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012050 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
12051 # and reject everything else. (works for HTTP/1 and HTTP/2 connections)
12052 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
12053 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
12054 tcp-request switch-mode http if HTTP
12055 tcp-request reject # non-HTTP traffic is implicit here
12056 ...
12057 http-request reject unless is_host_com
12058
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012059 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012060 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
12061 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
12062 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012063 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012064
12065 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
12066 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
12067 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012068 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012069 tcp-request content reject
12070
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012071 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012072 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012073 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012074 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012075 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
12076 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012077
12078 Example:
12079 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
12080 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012081 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012082
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012083 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012084 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012085
12086 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012087 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012088 # protecting all our sites
12089 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012090 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
12091 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012092 ...
12093 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
12094
12095 backend http_dynamic
12096 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012097 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012098 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012099 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012100 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012101 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012102 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012103
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012104 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012105
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030012106 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
12107 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012108
12109
12110tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
12111 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
12112 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020012113 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012114 Arguments :
12115 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12116 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12117 as explained at the top of this document.
12118
12119 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
12120 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
12121 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
12122 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
12123 data for at most the specified amount of time.
12124
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020012125 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
12126 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
12127 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
12128 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
12129
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012130 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
12131 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012132 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012133 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010012134 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
12135 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
12136 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
12137 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012138
12139 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
12140 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
12141 it pass through unaffected.
12142
12143 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
12144 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
12145 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012146 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012147 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
12148 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020012149 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
12150 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
12151 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012152
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012153 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012154 "timeout client".
12155
12156
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012157tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12158 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
12159 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12160 no | no | yes | yes
12161 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020012162 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12163 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012164
12165 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
12166
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012167 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012168 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
12169 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012170 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
12171 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012172
12173 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
12174
12175 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
12176 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
12177 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
12178 inserted.
12179
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012180 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012181 - accept :
12182 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
12183 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
12184 the rules evaluation.
12185
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012186 - close :
12187 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
12188 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
12189 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
12190 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
12191 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
12192 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012193 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012194 protocols.
12195
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012196 - reject :
12197 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
12198 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012199 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012200
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012201 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
12202 Sets a variable.
12203
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012204 - unset-var(<var-name>)
12205 Unsets a variable.
12206
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020012207 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
12208 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
12209 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
12210 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
12211
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012212 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
12213 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
12214 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
12215 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
12216
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012217 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12218 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
12219 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
12220 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
12221 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012222
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012223 - "silent-drop" :
12224 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012225 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012226 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
12227 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
12228 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
12229 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
12230 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012231 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
12232 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012233 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
12234 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012235 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012236 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
12237 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
12238 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
12239 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
12240
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012241 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
12242 Send a group of SPOE messages.
12243
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012244 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12245 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12246 for changing the default action to a reject.
12247
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012248 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
12249 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
12250 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
12251 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012252 period.
12253
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012254 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
12255 declared inline.
12256
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012257 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
12258 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012259 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012260 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12261 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012262 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012263 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012264 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012265 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
12266 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012267 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012268 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
12269 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012270
12271 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12272 followed by some converters.
12273
12274 Example:
12275
12276 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
12277
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012278 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
12279 <var-name>.
12280
12281 Example:
12282
12283 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
12284
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012285 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
12286 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
12287 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
12288 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
12289 the SPOE agent name must be used.
12290
12291 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
12292
12293 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
12294
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012295 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12296
12297 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
12298
12299
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012300tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12301 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
12302 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12303 no | yes | yes | no
12304 Arguments :
12305 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12306 below.
12307
12308 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
12309
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012310 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012311 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
12312 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
12313 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
12314 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
12315 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
12316 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
12317 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012318 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012319 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
12320 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
12321 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
12322 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
12323 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
12324 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
12325 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
12326 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
12327 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
12328 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
12329 instead.
12330
12331 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
12332 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
12333 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
12334 rules which may be inserted.
12335
12336 Several types of actions are supported :
12337 - accept : the request is accepted
12338 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
12339 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
12340 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012341 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012342 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012343 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012344 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012345 - silent-drop
12346
12347 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
12348 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
12349 sections for a complete description.
12350
12351 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12352 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12353 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
12354
12355 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
12356 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
12357 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
12358 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
12359 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
12360
12361 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
12362 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12363
12364 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
12365 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
12366 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
12367
12368 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12369 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
12370 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12371
12372 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
12373 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
12374 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
12375
12376 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12377 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12378 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
12379
12380 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12381
12382 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
12383
12384
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012385tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
12386 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
12387 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12388 no | no | yes | yes
12389 Arguments :
12390 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12391 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12392 as explained at the top of this document.
12393
12394 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
12395
12396
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012397timeout check <timeout>
12398 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
12399 established.
12400
12401 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12402 yes | no | yes | yes
12403 Arguments:
12404 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12405 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12406 as explained at the top of this document.
12407
12408 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
12409 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012410 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012411 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010012412 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
12413 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
12414 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012415
12416 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
12417 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
12418
12419 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
12420 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010012421 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012422
12423 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12424 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12425 forget about it.
12426
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010012427 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
12428 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012429
12430
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012431timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012432 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
12433 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12434 yes | yes | yes | no
12435 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012436 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012437 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12438 as explained at the top of this document.
12439
12440 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
12441 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
12442 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010012443 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
12444 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
12445 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
12446 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012447 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
12448 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
12449 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012450 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012451 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012452 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
12453 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012454 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
12455 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012456
12457 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
12458 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12459 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12460 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012461 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012462 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12463
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012464 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010012465
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012466 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012467
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012468
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012469timeout client-fin <timeout>
12470 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
12471 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12472 yes | yes | yes | no
12473 Arguments :
12474 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12475 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12476 as explained at the top of this document.
12477
12478 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
12479 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
12480 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
12481 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
12482 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
12483 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
12484 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010012485 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
12486 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
12487 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012488
12489 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
12490 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
12491 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
12492
12493 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
12494
12495
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012496timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012497 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
12498 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12499 yes | no | yes | yes
12500 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012501 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012502 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12503 as explained at the top of this document.
12504
12505 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012506 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012507 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012508 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012509 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
12510 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012511
12512 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12513 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12514 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12515 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012516 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012517 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12518
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012519 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012520
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012521
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012522timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
12523 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
12524 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12525 yes | yes | yes | yes
12526 Arguments :
12527 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12528 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12529 as explained at the top of this document.
12530
12531 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
12532 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
12533 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
12534 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
12535 once the request has started to present itself.
12536
12537 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
12538 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
12539 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
12540 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
12541 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
12542
12543 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
12544 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
12545 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
12546 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
12547
12548 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
12549 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012550 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012551 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
12552 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020012553 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012554
12555 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
12556 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
12557 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
12558 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
12559
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010012560 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
12561 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010012562 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
12563
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012564 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
12565
12566
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012567timeout http-request <timeout>
12568 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
12569 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020012570 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012571 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012572 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012573 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12574 as explained at the top of this document.
12575
12576 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
12577 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
12578 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
12579 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
12580 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
12581 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
12582 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020012583 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
12584 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
12585 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
12586 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012587 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020012588 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
12589 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012590
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010012591 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
12592 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
12593 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
12594 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
12595 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012596 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012597
12598 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
12599 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012600 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012601 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
12602 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
12603
12604 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020012605 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
12606 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
12607 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012608
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020012609 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010012610 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012611
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012612
12613timeout queue <timeout>
12614 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
12615 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12616 yes | no | yes | yes
12617 Arguments :
12618 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12619 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12620 as explained at the top of this document.
12621
12622 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
12623 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
12624 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
12625 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
12626 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
12627
12628 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
12629 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
12630 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
12631 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
12632
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012633 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012634
12635
12636timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012637 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
12638 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12639 yes | no | yes | yes
12640 Arguments :
12641 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12642 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12643 as explained at the top of this document.
12644
12645 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
12646 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
12647 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
12648 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
12649 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
12650 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
12651 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
12652
12653 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
12654 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
12655 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
12656 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
12657 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012658 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012659 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012660 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
12661 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012662 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
12663 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012664
12665 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12666 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12667 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12668 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012669 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012670 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12671
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012672 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012673
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012674
12675timeout server-fin <timeout>
12676 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
12677 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12678 yes | no | yes | yes
12679 Arguments :
12680 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12681 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12682 as explained at the top of this document.
12683
12684 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
12685 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
12686 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
12687 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
12688 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
12689 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
12690 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
12691 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
12692 situations, it should not be needed.
12693
12694 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12695 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
12696 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
12697
12698 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
12699
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012700
12701timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010012702 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012703 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12704 yes | yes | yes | yes
12705 Arguments :
12706 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
12707 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12708 as explained at the top of this document.
12709
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020012710 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
12711 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
12712 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012713
12714 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
12715 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
12716 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
12717 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010012718 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012719
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012720 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012721
12722
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012723timeout tunnel <timeout>
12724 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
12725 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12726 yes | no | yes | yes
12727 Arguments :
12728 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12729 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12730 as explained at the top of this document.
12731
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012732 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012733 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
12734 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
12735 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012736 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
12737 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012738 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
12739 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
12740 specified.
12741
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012742 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
12743 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
12744 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
12745 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
12746 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
12747 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
12748 state.
12749
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012750 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
12751 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
12752 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
12753 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012754 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012755
12756 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12757 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12758 forget about it.
12759
12760 Example :
12761 defaults http
12762 option http-server-close
12763 timeout connect 5s
12764 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012765 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012766 timeout server 30s
12767 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
12768
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012769 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020012770
12771
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012772transparent (deprecated)
12773 Enable client-side transparent proxying
12774 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010012775 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012776 Arguments : none
12777
12778 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
12779 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
12780 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
12781 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
12782 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
12783 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
12784 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
12785 appropriate server.
12786
12787 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
12788
12789 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
12790 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
12791
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012792 See also: "option transparent"
12793
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012794unique-id-format <string>
12795 Generate a unique ID for each request.
12796 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12797 yes | yes | yes | no
12798 Arguments :
12799 <string> is a log-format string.
12800
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012801 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
12802 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
12803 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
12804 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012805
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012806 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
12807 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
12808 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
12809 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
12810 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
12811 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
12812 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
12813 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012814
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012815 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
12816 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012817
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012818 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012819
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050012820 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012821
12822 will generate:
12823
12824 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
12825
12826 See also: "unique-id-header"
12827
12828unique-id-header <name>
12829 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
12830 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12831 yes | yes | yes | no
12832 Arguments :
12833 <name> is the name of the header.
12834
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012835 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
12836 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012837
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020012838 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012839
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050012840 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010012841 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
12842
12843 will generate:
12844
12845 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
12846
12847 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012848
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020012849use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020012850 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012851 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12852 no | yes | yes | no
12853 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010012854 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
12855 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012856
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020012857 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
12858 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012859
12860 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
12861 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
12862 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020012863 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012864 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020012865 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
12866 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012867
12868 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
12869 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
12870 assign the backend.
12871
12872 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
12873 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
12874 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
12875 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
12876 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
12877 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
12878
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020012879 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012880 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020012881 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
12882 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
12883 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
12884
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010012885 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
12886 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
12887 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
12888 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
12889 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
12890 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
12891 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
12892 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
12893 cannot be forced from the request.
12894
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012895 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010012896 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
12897 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
12898
12899 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
12900 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012901
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012902use-fcgi-app <name>
12903 Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
12904 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12905 no | no | yes | yes
12906 Arguments :
12907 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
12908
12909 See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012910
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012911use-server <server> if <condition>
12912use-server <server> unless <condition>
12913 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
12914 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12915 no | no | yes | yes
12916 Arguments :
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020012917 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section
12918 or a "log-format" string resolving to a server name.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012919
12920 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
12921
12922 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
12923 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
12924 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
12925
12926 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
12927 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
12928 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
12929 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
12930 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
12931 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
12932 matches will assign the server.
12933
12934 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
12935 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
12936 with the next rules until one matches.
12937
12938 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
12939 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
12940 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
12941 according to other persistence mechanisms.
12942
12943 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
12944 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
12945 stripped.
12946
12947 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
12948 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020012949 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field when using protocols with
12950 implicit TLS (also see "req_ssl_sni"). And if these servers have their weight
12951 set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012952
12953 Example :
12954 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
12955 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
12956 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
12957 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020012958 server mail 192.168.0.1:465 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012959 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000012960 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012961 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
12962 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
12963
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020012964 When <server> is a simple name, it is checked against existing servers in the
12965 configuration and an error is reported if the specified server does not exist.
12966 If it is a log-format, no check is performed when parsing the configuration,
12967 and if we can't resolve a valid server name at runtime but the use-server rule
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050012968 was conditioned by an ACL returning true, no other use-server rule is applied
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020012969 and we fall back to load balancing.
12970
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012971 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020012972
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012973
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100129745. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020012975--------------------------
12976
12977The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
12978depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
12979settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
12980written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
12981described in this section.
12982
12983
129845.1. Bind options
12985-----------------
12986
12987The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
12988as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
12989no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
12990parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
12991while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
12992provided immediately after the setting name.
12993
12994The currently supported settings are the following ones.
12995
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010012996accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
12997 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
12998 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
12999 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
13000 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
13001 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
13002 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
13003 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
13004 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
13005 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010013006 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
13007 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
13008 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013009
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013010accept-proxy
13011 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020013012 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
13013 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013014 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
13015 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
13016 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
13017 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013018 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013019 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
13020 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020013021 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
13022 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013023
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020013024allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010013025 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010013026 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013027 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010013028 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
13029 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020013030
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013031alpn <protocols>
13032 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
13033 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
13034 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013035 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013036 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010013037 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
13038 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
13039 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
13040 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
13041 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
13042 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
13043 preference, like below :
13044
13045 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013046
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013047backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010013048 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013049 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
13050
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010013051curves <curves>
13052 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
13053 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
13054 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
13055 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
13056 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
13057 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
13058
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020013059ecdhe <named curve>
13060 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010013061 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
13062 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020013063
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013064ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013065 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13066 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
13067 client's certificate.
13068
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013069ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
13070 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
13071 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
13072 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
13073 error is ignored.
13074
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013075ca-sign-file <cafile>
13076 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13077 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
13078 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
13079 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
13080 'generate-certificates' for details.
13081
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000013082ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013083 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
13084 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
13085 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
13086 'generate-certificates' for details.
13087
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010013088ca-verify-file <cafile>
13089 This setting designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to
13090 verify client's certificate. It designates CA certificates which must not be
13091 included in CA names sent in server hello message. Typically, "ca-file" must
13092 be defined with intermediate certificates, and "ca-verify-file" with
13093 certificates to ending the chain, like root CA.
13094
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013095ciphers <ciphers>
13096 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
13097 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000013098 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013099 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013100 information and recommendations see e.g.
13101 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
13102 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
13103 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
13104
13105ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
13106 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
13107 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
13108 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
13109 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013110 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
13111 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013112
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013113crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013114 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13115 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
13116 to verify client's certificate.
13117
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013118crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013119 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13120 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
13121 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
13122 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
13123 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +010013124 file. Intermediate certificate can also be shared in a directory via
13125 "issuers-chain-path" directive.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013126
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +010013127 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load
13128 the key at the same path suffixed by a ".key".
13129
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013130 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
13131 are loaded.
13132
13133 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
William Lallemand3f25ae32020-02-24 16:30:12 +010013134 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends
13135 with '.key', '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This
13136 directive may be specified multiple times in order to load certificates from
13137 multiple files or directories. The certificates will be presented to clients
13138 who provide a valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their
13139 CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*'
13140 is used instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010013141 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013142
13143 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
13144 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
13145 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
13146 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010013147 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
13148 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013149
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020013150 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013151
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013152 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013153 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013154 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
13155 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013156 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
13157 clients).
13158
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020013159 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
13160 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
13161 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
13162 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
13163 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
13164 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
13165 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
13166 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
13167 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
13168 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
13169 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
13170 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
13171 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
13172
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010013173 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
13174 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
13175 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
13176 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
13177 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
13178
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050013179 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
13180 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
13181 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
13182 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013183
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020013184 To achieve this, OpenSSL 1.1.1 is required, you can configure this behavior
13185 by providing one crt entry per certificate type, or by configuring a "cert
13186 bundle" like it was required before HAProxy 1.8. See "ssl-load-extra-files".
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013187
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013188crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013189 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013190 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013191 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013192 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013193
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013194crt-list <file>
13195 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013196 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
13197 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013198
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013199 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
13200
William Lallemand5d036392020-06-30 16:11:36 +020013201 sslbindconf supports "allow-0rtt", "alpn", "ca-file", "ca-verify-file",
13202 "ciphers", "ciphersuites", "crl-file", "curves", "ecdhe", "no-ca-names",
13203 "npn", "verify" configuration. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1
13204 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported. It overrides the
13205 configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013206
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020013207 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013208 useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI, or
13209 after the first certificate to exclude a pattern from its CN or Subject Alt
13210 Name (SAN). The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid
13211 TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI
13212 filter is specified, the CN and SAN are used. This directive may be specified
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020013213 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
13214 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
13215 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013216
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020013217 Multi-cert bundling (see "ssl-load-extra-files") is supported with crt-list,
13218 as long as only the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do
13219 the same work on all bundled certificates.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013220
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020013221 Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a hash ('#') will be ignored.
13222
Joao Moraisaa8fcc42020-11-24 08:24:30 -030013223 The first declared certificate of a bind line is used as the default
13224 certificate, either from crt or crt-list option, which haproxy should use in
13225 the TLS handshake if no other certificate matches. This certificate will also
13226 be used if the provided SNI matches its CN or SAN, even if a matching SNI
13227 filter is found on any crt-list. The SNI filter !* can be used after the first
13228 declared certificate to not include its CN and SAN in the SNI tree, so it will
13229 never match except if no other certificate matches. This way the first
13230 declared certificate act as a fallback.
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013231
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013232 crt-list file example:
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013233 cert1.pem !*
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020013234 # comment
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010013235 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013236 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010013237 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013238
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013239defer-accept
13240 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
13241 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
13242 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013243 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013244 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
13245 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
13246 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
13247 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
13248 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
13249 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
13250 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
13251
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020013252expose-fd listeners
13253 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
13254 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020013255 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
13256 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013257 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020013258
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013259force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013260 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013261 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013262 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013263 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013264
13265force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013266 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013267 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013268 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013269
13270force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013271 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013272 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013273 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013274
13275force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013276 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013277 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013278 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013279
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013280force-tlsv13
13281 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
13282 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013283 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013284
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013285generate-certificates
13286 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13287 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
13288 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
13289 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
13290 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
13291 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
13292 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
13293 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
13294 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
13295 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
13296 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
13297
13298 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
13299 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013300 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013301 certificate is used many times.
13302
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013303gid <gid>
13304 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
13305 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
13306 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
13307 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
13308 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13309
13310group <group>
13311 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
13312 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
13313 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
13314 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
13315 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13316
13317id <id>
13318 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
13319 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
13320 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
13321 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
13322
13323interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010013324 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
13325 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
13326 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
13327 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
13328 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
13329 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010013330 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
13331 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
13332 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
13333 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
13334 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
13335 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013336
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013337level <level>
13338 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
13339 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
13340 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013341 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013342 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
13343 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
13344 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013345 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013346 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013347 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013348 all counters).
13349
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020013350severity-output <format>
13351 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
13352 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
13353 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
13354 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
13355 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
13356 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
13357 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
13358 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
13359 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
13360 rfc5424 convention.
13361
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013362maxconn <maxconn>
13363 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
13364 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
13365 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
13366 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
13367 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
13368 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
13369 eat all memory.
13370
13371mode <mode>
13372 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
13373 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
13374 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
13375 UNIX sockets.
13376
13377mss <maxseg>
13378 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
13379 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
13380 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
13381 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
13382 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
13383 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
13384 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
13385 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
13386 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
13387 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
13388 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
13389
13390name <name>
13391 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
13392 page.
13393
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020013394namespace <name>
13395 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
13396 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
13397 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
13398 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
13399
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013400nice <nice>
13401 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
13402 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
13403 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
13404 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
13405 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
13406 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
13407 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
13408 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
13409 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
13410 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
13411 one for an RDP socket.
13412
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020013413no-ca-names
13414 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13415 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010013416 Use "ca-verify-file" instead of "ca-file" with "no-ca-names".
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020013417
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013418no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013419 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013420 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013421 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013422 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013423 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
13424 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013425
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020013426no-tls-tickets
13427 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13428 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
13429 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013430 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
13431 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010013432 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
13433 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
13434 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020013435
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013436no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013437 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013438 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013439 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013440 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013441 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13442 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013443
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013444no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013445 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013446 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013447 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013448 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013449 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13450 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013451
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013452no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013453 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013454 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013455 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013456 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013457 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13458 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013459
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013460no-tlsv13
13461 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13462 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
13463 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
13464 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013465 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13466 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013467
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020013468npn <protocols>
13469 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
13470 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
13471 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013472 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013473 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010013474 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
13475 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
13476 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
13477 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
13478 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020013479
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000013480prefer-client-ciphers
13481 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
13482 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
13483 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020013484 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
13485 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
13486 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000013487
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013488process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010013489 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013490 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013491 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013492 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
13493 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
13494 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
13495 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013496 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010013497 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
13498 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
13499 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
13500 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
13501 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013502
13503 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
13504
13505 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
13506 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
13507 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
13508 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
13509 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
13510 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
13511 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
13512 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020013513
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013514proto <name>
13515 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
13516 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
13517 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010013518 in haproxy -vv. The protocols properties are reported : the mode (TCP/HTTP),
13519 the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
13520
13521 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
13522 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
13523 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
13524 also reported (flag=HTX).
13525
13526 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "proto" directive on
13527 a bind line :
13528
13529 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
13530 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
13531 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
13532
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040013533 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013534 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080013535 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013536 h2" on the bind line.
13537
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013538ssl
13539 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013540 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013541 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
13542 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020013543 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
13544 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013545
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013546ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
13547 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020013548 from this listener. Using this setting without "ssl-min-ver" can be
13549 ambiguous because the default ssl-min-ver value could change in future HAProxy
13550 versions. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013551 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
13552
13553ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020013554 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections
13555 instantiated from this listener. The default value is "TLSv1.2". This option
13556 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
13557 See also "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013558
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010013559strict-sni
13560 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
13561 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
13562 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
13563 See the "crt" option for more information.
13564
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013565tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013566 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013567 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
13568 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013569 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013570 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
13571 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
13572 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
13573 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
13574 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
13575 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
13576 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
13577
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013578tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010013579 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013580 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
13581 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
13582 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
13583 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
13584 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
13585 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
13586 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020013587 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
13588 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
13589 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013590
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010013591tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
13592 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010013593 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
13594 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
13595 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
13596 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
13597 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
13598 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
13599 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
13600 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
13601 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
13602 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010013603 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
13604 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
13605
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013606transparent
13607 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
13608 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
13609 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
13610 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
13611 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
13612 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
13613 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
13614 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
13615 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
13616 so check for support with your vendor.
13617
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010013618v4v6
13619 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
13620 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
13621 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
13622 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013623 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010013624
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010013625v6only
13626 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
13627 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
13628 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010013629 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
13630 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010013631
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013632uid <uid>
13633 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
13634 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
13635 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
13636 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
13637 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13638
13639user <user>
13640 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
13641 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
13642 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
13643 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
13644 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13645
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013646verify [none|optional|required]
13647 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
13648 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
13649 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
13650 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
13651 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013652 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
13653 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
13654 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
13655 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013656
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200136575.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010013658------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013659
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010013660The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
13661which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
13662arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
13663settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
13664after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
13665Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
13666address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013667
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013668 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010013669 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013670
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013671Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
13672keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
13673
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013674The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013675
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020013676addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013677 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010013678 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
13679 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
13680 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
13681 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
13682 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013683
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013684agent-check
13685 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013686 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010013687 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
13688 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
13689 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013690
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013691 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013692 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020013693 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
13694 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
13695 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013696
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013697 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
13698 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
13699 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
13700 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
13701 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020013702
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013703 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013704 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013705
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013706 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
13707 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
13708 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013709
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013710 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
13711 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
13712 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013713
William Dauchyf8e795c2020-09-26 13:35:51 +020013714 - The words "down", "fail", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013715 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
13716 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
13717 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
13718 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013719 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013720 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013721
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013722 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
13723 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013724
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013725 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
13726 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
13727 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
13728 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
13729 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
13730 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
13731 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
13732 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
13733 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013734
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090013735 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
13736 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013737 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
13738 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
13739 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010013740 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090013741
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010013742 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013743 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013744
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070013745agent-send <string>
13746 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
13747 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
13748 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
13749 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
13750 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
13751
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013752agent-inter <delay>
13753 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
13754 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
13755
13756 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
13757 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
13758 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
13759 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
13760 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
13761 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
13762 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
13763 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
13764 of backends use the same servers.
13765
13766 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
13767
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010013768agent-addr <addr>
13769 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
13770
13771 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
13772 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
13773 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
13774 hostname, it will be resolved.
13775
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090013776agent-port <port>
13777 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
13778
13779 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
13780
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020013781allow-0rtt
13782 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020013783 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
13784 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020013785
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013786alpn <protocols>
13787 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
13788 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
13789 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013790 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010013791 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
13792 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
13793 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
13794 now obsolete NPN extension.
13795 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
13796 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
13797
13798 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
13799
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013800backup
13801 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
13802 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
13803 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
13804 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013805 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
13806 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013807
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020013808ca-file <cafile>
13809 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13810 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
13811 server's certificate.
13812
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013813check
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020013814 This option enables health checks on a server:
13815 - when not set, no health checking is performed, and the server is always
13816 considered available.
13817 - when set and no other check method is configured, the server is considered
13818 available when a connection can be established at the highest configured
13819 transport layer. This means TCP by default, or SSL/TLS when "ssl" or
13820 "check-ssl" are set, both possibly combined with connection prefixes such
13821 as a PROXY protocol header when "send-proxy" or "check-send-proxy" are
13822 set.
13823 - when set and an application-level health check is defined, the
13824 application-level exchanges are performed on top of the configured
13825 transport layer and the server is considered available if all of the
13826 exchanges succeed.
13827
13828 By default, health checks are performed on the same address and port as
13829 configured on the server, using the same encapsulation parameters (SSL/TLS,
13830 proxy-protocol header, etc... ). It is possible to change the destination
13831 address using "addr" and the port using "port". When done, it is assumed the
13832 server isn't checked on the service port, and configured encapsulation
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +050013833 parameters are not reused. One must explicitly set "check-send-proxy" to send
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020013834 connection headers, "check-ssl" to use SSL/TLS.
13835
13836 When "sni" or "alpn" are set on the server line, their value is not used for
13837 health checks and one must use "check-sni" or "check-alpn".
13838
13839 The default source address for health check traffic is the same as the one
13840 defined in the backend. It can be changed with the "source" keyword.
13841
13842 The interval between checks can be set using the "inter" keyword, and the
13843 "rise" and "fall" keywords can be used to define how many successful or
13844 failed health checks are required to flag a server available or not
13845 available.
13846
13847 Optional application-level health checks can be configured with "option
13848 httpchk", "option mysql-check" "option smtpchk", "option pgsql-check",
13849 "option ldap-check", or "option redis-check".
13850
13851 Example:
13852 # simple tcp check
13853 backend foo
13854 server s1 192.168.0.1:80 check
13855 # this does a tcp connect + tls handshake
13856 backend foo
13857 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
13858 # simple tcp check is enough for check success
13859 backend foo
13860 option tcp-check
13861 tcp-check connect
13862 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013863
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020013864check-send-proxy
13865 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
13866 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
13867 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
13868 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
13869 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
13870 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
13871 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
13872
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010013873check-alpn <protocols>
13874 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
13875 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
13876 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
13877
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020013878check-proto <name>
13879 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the server's health-check
13880 connections. It must be compatible with the health-check type (TCP or
13881 HTTP). It must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010013882 protocols is reported in haproxy -vv. The protocols properties are
13883 reported : the mode (TCP/HTTP), the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
13884
13885 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
13886 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
13887 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
13888 also reported (flag=HTX).
13889
13890 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "check-proto"
13891 directive on a server line:
13892
13893 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
13894 fcgi : mode=HTTP side=BE mux=FCGI flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
13895 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
13896 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
13897
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040013898 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020013899 protocol for health-check connections established to this server.
13900 If not defined, the server one will be used, if set.
13901
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010013902check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020013903 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010013904 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
13905 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020013906
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013907check-ssl
13908 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
13909 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
13910 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
13911 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013912 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013913 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
13914 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013915 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013916 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
13917 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020013918
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080013919check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013920 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080013921 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
13922 for normal traffic.
13923
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013924ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013925 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
13926 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
13927 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013928 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
13929 information and recommendations see e.g.
13930 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
13931 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
13932 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020013933
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013934ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
13935 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
13936 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
13937 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
13938 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013939 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
13940 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
13941 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013942
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013943cookie <value>
13944 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
13945 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
13946 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
13947 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
13948 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
13949 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
13950 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
13951
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020013952crl-file <crlfile>
13953 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13954 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
13955 to verify server's certificate.
13956
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020013957crt <cert>
13958 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
13959 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
13960 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
13961 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
13962 certificate request.
13963
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020013964disabled
13965 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
13966 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
13967 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
13968 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
13969 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013970 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020013971
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010013972enabled
13973 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
13974 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
13975 default value.
13976 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
13977 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020013978
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013979error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010013980 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
13981 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
13982 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013983
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013984 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010013985
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010013986fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013987 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
13988 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
13989 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
13990
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013991force-sslv3
13992 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
13993 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013994 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013995 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020013996
13997force-tlsv10
13998 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013999 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014000 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014001
14002force-tlsv11
14003 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014004 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014005 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014006
14007force-tlsv12
14008 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014009 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014010 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014011
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014012force-tlsv13
14013 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
14014 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014015 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014016
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014017id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020014018 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
14019 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
14020 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014021
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014022init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
14023 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
14024 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014025 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014026 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
14027 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
14028 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
14029 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
14030 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
14031 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
14032 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
14033 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
14034 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014035 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014036 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
14037 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
14038 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
14039 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
14040 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
14041 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014042 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014043
14044 Example:
14045 defaults
14046 # never fail on address resolution
14047 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
14048
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014049inter <delay>
14050fastinter <delay>
14051downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014052 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
14053 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
14054 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
14055 between checks depending on the server state :
14056
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020014057 Server state | Interval used
14058 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14059 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
14060 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14061 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
14062 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
14063 or yet unchecked. |
14064 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14065 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
14066 | "inter" otherwise.
14067 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014068
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014069 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
14070 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
14071 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
14072 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014073 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
14074 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
14075 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
14076 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
14077 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014078
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +020014079log-proto <logproto>
14080 The "log-proto" specifies the protocol used to forward event messages to
14081 a server configured in a ring section. Possible values are "legacy"
14082 and "octet-count" corresponding respectively to "Non-transparent-framing"
14083 and "Octet counting" in rfc6587. "legacy" is the default.
14084
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014085maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014086 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
14087 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010014088 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
14089 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014090 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
14091 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
14092 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
14093 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
14094
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010014095 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
14096 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
14097 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
14098 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
14099 than 50 concurrent requests.
14100
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014101maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014102 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
14103 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
14104 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
14105 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
Willy Tarreau8ae8c482020-10-22 17:19:07 +020014106 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. Some load
14107 balancing algorithms such as leastconn take this into account and accept to
14108 add requests into a server's queue up to this value if it is explicitly set
14109 to a value greater than zero, which often allows to better smooth the load
14110 when dealing with single-digit maxconn values. The default value is "0" which
14111 means the queue is unlimited. See also the "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters
14112 and "balance leastconn".
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014113
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010014114max-reuse <count>
14115 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
14116 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
14117 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
14118 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
14119 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
14120 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
14121 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
14122 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
14123
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014124minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014125 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
14126 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
14127 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
14128 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
14129 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
14130 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014131 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014132 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014133
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020014134namespace <name>
14135 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
14136 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
14137 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
14138 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
14139
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014140no-agent-check
14141 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
14142 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14143 default value.
14144 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14145 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
14146
14147no-backup
14148 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
14149 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14150 default value.
14151 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14152 "default-server" "backup" setting.
14153
14154no-check
14155 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
14156 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14157 default value.
14158 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14159 "default-server" "check" setting.
14160
14161no-check-ssl
14162 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
14163 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14164 default value.
14165 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14166 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
14167
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014168no-send-proxy
14169 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
14170 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14171 default value.
14172 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14173 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
14174
14175no-send-proxy-v2
14176 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
14177 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14178 default value.
14179 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14180 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
14181
14182no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
14183 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
14184 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14185 default value.
14186 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14187 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
14188
14189no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
14190 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
14191 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14192 default value.
14193 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14194 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
14195
14196no-ssl
14197 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
14198 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14199 default value.
14200 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14201 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
14202
William Dauchyf6370442020-11-14 19:25:33 +010014203 Note that using `default-server ssl` setting and `no-ssl` on server will
14204 however init SSL connection, so it can be later be enabled through the
14205 runtime API: see `set server` commands in management doc.
14206
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010014207no-ssl-reuse
14208 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
14209 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
14210 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
14211 and for paranoid users.
14212
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014213no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014214 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
14215 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014216 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014217
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014218 Supported in default-server: No
14219
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020014220no-tls-tickets
14221 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14222 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
14223 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014224 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
14225 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010014226 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
14227 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
14228 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014229 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020014230
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014231no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014232 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014233 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14234 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014235 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14236 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014237 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014238
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014239 Supported in default-server: No
14240
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014241no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014242 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014243 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14244 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014245 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14246 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014247 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014248
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014249 Supported in default-server: No
14250
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014251no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014252 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014253 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14254 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014255 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14256 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014257 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014258
14259 Supported in default-server: No
14260
14261no-tlsv13
14262 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
14263 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14264 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
14265 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14266 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014267 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014268
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014269 Supported in default-server: No
14270
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014271no-verifyhost
14272 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
14273 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14274 default value.
14275 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14276 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014277
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020014278no-tfo
14279 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
14280 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14281 default value.
14282 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14283 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
14284
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090014285non-stick
14286 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
14287 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
14288 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
14289
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014290npn <protocols>
14291 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
14292 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
14293 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014294 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014295 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
14296 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
14297 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
14298
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014299observe <mode>
14300 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
14301 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
14302 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
14303 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
14304 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
14305 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010014306 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014307
14308 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
14309
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014310on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014311 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
14312 Currently, four modes are available:
14313 - fastinter: force fastinter
14314 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
14315 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
14316 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
14317 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
14318
14319 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
14320
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090014321on-marked-down <action>
14322 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
14323 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014324 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
14325 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
14326 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
14327 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
14328 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
14329 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
14330 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
14331 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090014332
14333 Actions are disabled by default
14334
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014335on-marked-up <action>
14336 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
14337 Currently one action is available:
14338 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
14339 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
14340 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
14341 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014342 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
14343 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014344 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
14345 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
14346
14347 Actions are disabled by default
14348
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020014349pool-low-conn <max>
14350 Set a low threshold on the number of idling connections for a server, below
14351 which a thread will not try to steal a connection from another thread. This
14352 can be useful to improve CPU usage patterns in scenarios involving many very
14353 fast servers, in order to ensure all threads will keep a few idle connections
14354 all the time instead of letting them accumulate over one thread and migrating
14355 them from thread to thread. Typical values of twice the number of threads
14356 seem to show very good performance already with sub-millisecond response
14357 times. The default is zero, indicating that any idle connection can be used
14358 at any time. It is the recommended setting for normal use. This only applies
14359 to connections that can be shared according to the same principles as those
Willy Tarreau0784db82021-02-19 11:45:22 +010014360 applying to "http-reuse". In case connection sharing between threads would
14361 be disabled via "tune.idle-pool.shared", it can become very important to use
14362 this setting to make sure each thread always has a few connections, or the
14363 connection reuse rate will decrease as thread count increases.
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020014364
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010014365pool-max-conn <max>
14366 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
14367 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
14368 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
14369 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
14370 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
14371 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
14372
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010014373pool-purge-delay <delay>
14374 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010014375 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020014376 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010014377
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014378port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014379 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
William Dauchy4858fb22021-02-03 22:30:09 +010014380 send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
14381 desirable to dedicate a port to a specific component able to perform complex
14382 tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application. It is
14383 common to run a simple script in inetd for instance. This parameter is
14384 ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "addr" parameter.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014385
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014386proto <name>
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014387 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
14388 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
14389 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014390 reported in haproxy -vv.The protocols properties are reported : the mode
14391 (TCP/HTTP), the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
14392
14393 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
14394 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
14395 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
14396 also reported (flag=HTX).
14397
14398 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "proto" directive on
14399 a server line :
14400
14401 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14402 fcgi : mode=HTTP side=BE mux=FCGI flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14403 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
14404 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
14405
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040014406 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014407 protocol for all connections established to this server.
14408
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014409redir <prefix>
14410 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
14411 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
14412 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
14413 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
14414 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
14415 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
14416 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
14417 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014418 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014419 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014420 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
14421 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
14422 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
14423 loop between the client and HAProxy!
14424
14425 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
14426
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014427rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014428 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
14429 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
14430 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
14431
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020014432resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
14433 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
14434 server.
14435
14436 Available options:
14437
14438 * allow-dup-ip
14439 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
14440 resolution at runtime is in operation.
14441 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
14442 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
14443 For such case, simply enable this option.
14444 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
14445
Daniel Corbettf8716912019-11-17 09:48:56 -050014446 * ignore-weight
14447 Ignore any weight that is set within an SRV record. This is useful when
14448 you would like to control the weights using an alternate method, such as
14449 using an "agent-check" or through the runtime api.
14450
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020014451 * prevent-dup-ip
14452 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
14453 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
14454 same fqdn.
14455 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
14456
14457 Example:
14458 backend b_myapp
14459 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
14460 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
14461 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
14462
14463 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
14464 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
14465 it
14466 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
14467 different address
14468
14469 Default value: not set
14470
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014471resolve-prefer <family>
14472 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
14473 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
14474 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
14475 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
14476
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020014477 Default value: ipv6
14478
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014479 Example:
14480
14481 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014482
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014483resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014484 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014485 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014486 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014487 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
14488 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014489 configured network, another address is selected.
14490
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014491 Example:
14492
14493 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014494
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014495resolvers <id>
14496 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
14497 hostname.
14498
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014499 Example:
14500
14501 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014502
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014503 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014504
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010014505send-proxy
14506 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
14507 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
14508 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
14509 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014510 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
14511 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
14512 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
14513 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
14514 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
14515 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
14516 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
14517 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
14518 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
14519 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014520 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
14521 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010014522
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014523send-proxy-v2
14524 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
14525 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14526 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14527 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020014528 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
14529 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
14530 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
14531 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014532
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010014533proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
Tim Duesterhuscf6e0c82020-03-13 12:34:24 +010014534 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add options to send in PROXY protocol
14535 version 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are:
14536
14537 - ssl : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl".
14538 - cert-cn : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn".
14539 - ssl-cipher: Name of the used cipher.
14540 - cert-sig : Signature algorithm of the used certificate.
14541 - cert-key : Key algorithm of the used certificate
14542 - authority : Host name value passed by the client (only SNI from a TLS
14543 connection is supported).
14544 - crc32c : Checksum of the PROXYv2 header.
14545 - unique-id : Send a unique ID generated using the frontend's
14546 "unique-id-format" within the PROXYv2 header.
14547 This unique-id is primarily meant for "mode tcp". It can
14548 lead to unexpected results in "mode http", because the
14549 generated unique ID is also used for the first HTTP request
14550 within a Keep-Alive connection.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010014551
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014552send-proxy-v2-ssl
14553 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
14554 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14555 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14556 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
14557 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
14558 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
14559 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014560 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
14561 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014562
14563send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
14564 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
14565 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14566 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14567 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
14568 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
14569 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
14570 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
14571 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014572 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
14573 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014574
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014575slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014576 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
14577 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
14578 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
14579 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
14580 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
14581 parameters :
14582
14583 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
14584 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
14585
14586 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
14587 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
14588 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
14589 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
14590
14591 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
14592 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
14593 seen as failed.
14594
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020014595sni <expression>
14596 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
14597 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
14598 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
14599 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020014600 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
14601 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014602 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010014603 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
14604 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020014605
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020014606source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020014607source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020014608source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014609 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
14610 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
14611 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
14612 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
14613
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020014614 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
14615 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
14616 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
14617 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
14618 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
14619 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
14620 server.
14621
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000014622 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
14623 specifying the source address without port(s).
14624
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014625ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020014626 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
14627 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
14628 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
14629 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
14630 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
14631 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014632 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
14633 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014634
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014635ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
14636 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
14637 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
14638 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
14639
14640ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
14641 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
14642 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
14643 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
14644
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014645ssl-reuse
14646 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
14647 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14648 default value.
14649 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14650 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
14651
14652stick
14653 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
14654 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14655 default value.
14656 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14657 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014658
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014659socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014660 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014661 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
14662 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
14663
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020014664tcp-ut <delay>
14665 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
14666 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
14667 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014668 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020014669 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
14670 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
14671 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
14672 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
14673 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
14674 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
14675 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
14676 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
14677 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
14678
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010014679tfo
14680 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
14681 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
14682 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
14683 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
14684 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or haproxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020014685 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010014686
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014687track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020014688 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
14689 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
14690 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
14691 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014692 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
14693
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014694tls-tickets
14695 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
14696 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14697 default value.
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010014698 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
14699 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
14700 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014701 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
Bjoern Jacke5ab7eb62020-02-13 14:16:16 +010014702 "default-server" "no-tls-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014703
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014704verify [none|required]
14705 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010014706 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014707 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
14708 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014709 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014710 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
14711 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
14712 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
14713 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
14714 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
14715 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
14716 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
14717 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014718
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070014719verifyhost <hostname>
14720 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014721 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
14722 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
14723 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
14724 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
14725 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
14726 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
14727 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
14728 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070014729
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014730weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014731 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
14732 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
14733 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020014734 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
14735 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
14736 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
14737 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
14738 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
14739 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014740
14741
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200147425.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
14743-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014744
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014745HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
14746using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070014747configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process's life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014748This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
14749can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
14750workload.
14751This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
14752resolution at run time.
14753Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
14754carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
14755
14756
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200147575.3.1. Global overview
14758----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014759
14760As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
14761different steps of the process life:
14762
14763 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
14764 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
14765 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
14766
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014767 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
14768 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014769
14770A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
14771 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
14772 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
14773 resolution to know this new IP.
14774
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014775When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014776HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014777SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
14778from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
14779will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, haproxy
14780will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020014781
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014782A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014783 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014784 first valid response.
14785
14786 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
14787 servers return an error.
14788
14789
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200147905.3.2. The resolvers section
14791----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014792
14793This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014794HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
14795contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014796
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014797When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
14798uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
14799is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
14800answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
14801
14802When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014803used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014804
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014805 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
14806 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
14807 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014808
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014809 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
14810 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014811
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014812 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retires> times. If no valid
14813 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
14814 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014815
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014816For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
14817following scenarios are possible:
14818
14819 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
14820 ignored
14821
14822 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
14823 applied
14824
14825 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
14826 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
14827
14828 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
14829 retries the query with a new type
14830
14831 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
14832 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014833
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020014834As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, haproxy keeps
14835a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014836<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020014837
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014838
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014839resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014840 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014841
14842A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
14843
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020014844accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014845 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014846 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020014847 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
14848 by RFC 6891)
14849
Emeric Brun4c751952021-03-08 16:41:29 +010014850 Note: the maximum allowed value is 65535. Recommended value for UDP is
14851 4096 and it is not recommended to exceed 8192 except if you are sure
14852 that your system and network can handle this (over 65507 makes no sense
14853 since is the maximum UDP payload size). If you are using only TCP
14854 nameservers to handle huge DNS responses, you should put this value
14855 to the max: 65535.
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020014856
Emeric Brunc8f3e452021-04-07 16:04:54 +020014857nameserver <name> <address>[:port] [param*]
14858 Used to configure a nameserver. <name> of the nameserver should ne unique.
14859 By default the <address> is considered of type datagram. This means if an
14860 IPv4 or IPv6 is configured without special address prefixes (paragraph 11.)
14861 the UDP protocol will be used. If an stream protocol address prefix is used,
14862 the nameserver will be considered as a stream server (TCP for instance) and
14863 "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph which are relevant for DNS
14864 resolving will be considered. Note: currently, in TCP mode, 4 queries are
14865 pipelined on the same connections. A batch of idle connections are removed
14866 every 5 seconds. "maxconn" can be configured to limit the amount of those
Emeric Brun56fc5d92021-02-12 20:05:45 +010014867 concurrent connections and TLS should also usable if the server supports.
14868
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060014869parse-resolv-conf
14870 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
14871 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
14872 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
14873
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014874hold <status> <period>
14875 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
14876 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010014877 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020014878 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014879 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
14880 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
14881 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
14882
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020014883 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014884
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014885resolve_retries <nb>
14886 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
14887 giving up.
14888 Default value: 3
14889
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020014890 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
14891 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
14892 type.
14893
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014894timeout <event> <time>
14895 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
14896 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
14897 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014898 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
14899 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014900 Default value: 1s
14901 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010014902 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014903 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014904 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
14905 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
14906
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014907 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014908
14909 resolvers mydns
14910 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
14911 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Emeric Brunc8f3e452021-04-07 16:04:54 +020014912 nameserver dns3 tcp@10.0.0.3:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060014913 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014914 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020014915 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014916 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010014917 hold other 30s
14918 hold refused 30s
14919 hold nx 30s
14920 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014921 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020014922 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014923
14924
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200149256. Cache
14926---------
14927
14928HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
14929(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
14930RAM.
14931
14932The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
14933this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
14934
14935If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
14936independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
14937when we try to allocate a new one.
14938
14939The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
14940
14941It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
14942"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
14943for more details.
14944
14945When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
14946replaced by "<CACHE>".
14947
14948
149496.1. Limitation
14950----------------
14951
14952The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
14953
14954- If the response is not a 200
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4f730832020-11-26 15:51:50 +010014955- If the response contains a Vary header and either the process-vary option is
14956 disabled, or a currently unmanaged header is specified in the Vary value (only
14957 accept-encoding and referer are managed for now)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020014958- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
14959- If the response is not cacheable
Remi Tricot-Le Bretond493bc82020-11-26 15:51:29 +010014960- If the response does not have an explicit expiration time (s-maxage or max-age
14961 Cache-Control directives or Expires header) or a validator (ETag or Last-Modified
14962 headers)
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010014963- If the process-vary option is enabled and there are already max-secondary-entries
14964 entries with the same primary key as the current response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton6ca89162021-01-07 14:50:51 +010014965- If the process-vary option is enabled and the response has an unknown encoding (not
14966 mentioned in https://www.iana.org/assignments/http-parameters/http-parameters.xhtml)
14967 while varying on the accept-encoding client header
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020014968
14969- If the request is not a GET
14970- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
14971- If the request contains an Authorization header
14972
14973
149746.2. Setup
14975-----------
14976
14977To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
14978the corresponding http-request and response actions.
14979
14980
149816.2.1. Cache section
14982---------------------
14983
14984cache <name>
14985 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
14986 size of cache is mandatory.
14987
14988total-max-size <megabytes>
14989 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
14990 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
14991
14992max-object-size <bytes>
14993 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
14994 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
14995 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
14996
14997max-age <seconds>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010014998 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set as the lowest
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020014999 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
15000 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
15001 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
15002 default.
15003
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010015004process-vary <on/off>
15005 Enable or disable the processing of the Vary header. When disabled, a response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010015006 containing such a header will never be cached. When enabled, we need to calculate
15007 a preliminary hash for a subset of request headers on all the incoming requests
15008 (which might come with a cpu cost) which will be used to build a secondary key
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010015009 for a given request (see RFC 7234#4.1). The default value is off (disabled).
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010015010
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015011max-secondary-entries <number>
15012 Define the maximum number of simultaneous secondary entries with the same primary
15013 key in the cache. This needs the vary support to be enabled. Its default value is 10
15014 and should be passed a strictly positive integer.
15015
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015016
150176.2.2. Proxy section
15018---------------------
15019
15020http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
15021 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
15022 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
15023 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
15024 after this one.
15025
15026http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
15027 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
15028 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
15029 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
15030 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
15031
15032
15033Example:
15034
15035 backend bck1
15036 mode http
15037
15038 http-request cache-use foobar
15039 http-response cache-store foobar
15040 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
15041
15042 cache foobar
15043 total-max-size 4
15044 max-age 240
15045
15046
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200150477. Using ACLs and fetching samples
15048----------------------------------
15049
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015050HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015051client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
15052The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
15053these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
15054but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
15055data called patterns.
15056
15057
150587.1. ACL basics
15059---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015060
15061The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
15062content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
15063from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
15064simple :
15065
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015066 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015067 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015068 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
15069 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015070
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015071The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
15072adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015073
15074In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
15075
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015076 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015077
15078This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
15079Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
15080and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015081an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
15082conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
15083as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
15084are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015085
15086ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
15087'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
15088which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
15089
15090There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
15091performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
15092
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015093The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
15094specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
15095this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015096methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
15097ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015098
15099Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
15100 - boolean
15101 - integer (signed or unsigned)
15102 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
15103 - string
15104 - data block
15105
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015106Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
15107converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
15108would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
15109The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
15110which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
15111
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015112Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
15113keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
15114fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
15115which are summarized in the table below :
15116
15117 +---------------------+-----------------+
15118 | Sample or converter | Default |
15119 | output type | matching method |
15120 +---------------------+-----------------+
15121 | boolean | bool |
15122 +---------------------+-----------------+
15123 | integer | int |
15124 +---------------------+-----------------+
15125 | ip | ip |
15126 +---------------------+-----------------+
15127 | string | str |
15128 +---------------------+-----------------+
15129 | binary | none, use "-m" |
15130 +---------------------+-----------------+
15131
15132Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
15133matching method, see below.
15134
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015135The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
15136 - boolean
15137 - integer or integer range
15138 - IP address / network
15139 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
15140 - regular expression
15141 - hex block
15142
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015143The following ACL flags are currently supported :
15144
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015145 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
15146 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015147 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015148 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010015149 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010015150 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015151 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
15152
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015153The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
15154read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
15155if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
15156lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
15157will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
15158beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
15159a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
15160lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
15161exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
15162
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010015163The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
15164parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
15165ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
15166a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
15167check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
15168
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010015169The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
15170socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
15171file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
15172
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015173Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
15174loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
15175
15176 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
15177
15178In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
15179the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
15180case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
15181as well.
15182
15183The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
15184sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
15185do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
15186methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
15187is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015188obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015189followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
15190default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
15191that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
15192string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
15193
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015194The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
15195By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
15196string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
15197resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
15198server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015199waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015200flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
15201function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
15202
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015203There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
15204sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
15205be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015206
15207 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
15208 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015209 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
15210 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
15211 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
15212 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015213
15214 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
15215 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015216 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015217
15218 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015219 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015220
15221 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015222 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015223
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015224 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015225 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
15226
15227 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
15228 binary or string samples.
15229
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015230 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
15231 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015232
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015233 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
15234 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
15235 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015236
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015237 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
15238 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015239
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015240 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
15241 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015242
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015243 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
15244 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015245
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015246 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
15247 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015248 This may be used with binary or string samples.
15249
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015250 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
15251 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
15252 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015253
15254For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
15255request, it is possible to do :
15256
15257 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
15258
15259In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
15260buffer, one would use the following acl :
15261
15262 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
15263
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015264On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
15265possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
15266
15267 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
15268
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015269All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
15270criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
15271method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
15272to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
15273criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
15274the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015275
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015276If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015277the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
15278For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015279
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015280 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
15281 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
15282 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
15283 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015284
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015285
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015286The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
15287types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
15288combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
15289brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
15290default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015291
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015292 +-------------------------------------------------+
15293 | Input sample type |
15294 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015295 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015296 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
15297 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
15298 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015299 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015300 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015301 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015302 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015303 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015304 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015305 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015306 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015307 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015308 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015309 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015310 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015311 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015312 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015313 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015314 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015315 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015316 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015317 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015318 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015319 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015320 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
15321 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
15322 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015323
15324
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200153257.1.1. Matching booleans
15326------------------------
15327
15328In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
15329Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
15330When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
15331that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
15332
15333Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
15334return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
15335"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
15336
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015337
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200153387.1.2. Matching integers
15339------------------------
15340
15341Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
15342enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
15343to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
15344
15345Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
15346matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
15347lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015348
15349For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
15350unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
15351representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
15352
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015353As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
15354two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
15355instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
15356ranges and operators.
15357
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015358For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015359operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
15360Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
15361of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015362
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015363Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015364
15365 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
15366 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
15367 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
15368 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
15369 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
15370
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015371For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015372
15373 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
15374
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015375This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
15376
15377 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
15378
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015379
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200153807.1.3. Matching strings
15381-----------------------
15382
15383String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
15384different forms :
15385
15386 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015387 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015388
15389 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015390 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015391
15392 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
15393 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
15394
15395 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
15396 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
15397
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010015398 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015399 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
15400 matches.
15401
15402 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
15403 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
15404 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015405
15406String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
15407exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
15408characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
15409string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
15410to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015411before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015412
Mathias Weiersmuellercb250fc2019-12-02 09:43:40 +010015413Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
15414(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
15415Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
15416
15417Example:
15418 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
15419 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
15420
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015421
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200154227.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
15423---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015424
15425Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
15426they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
15427possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
15428passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
15429the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015430the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
15431match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015432
15433
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200154347.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
15435-------------------------------------
15436
15437It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
15438not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
15439a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
15440to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
15441digits may be used upper or lower case.
15442
15443Example :
15444 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
15445 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
15446
15447
154487.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
15449---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015450
15451IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
15452netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
15453within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010015454host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015455difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
15456at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
15457does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
15458parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015459
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020015460The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
15461abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
15462
15463 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15464 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
15465 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15466 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
15467 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
15468 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
15469 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
15470 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15471
15472Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
15473192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
15474
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020015475IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
15476Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
15477trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
15478IPv6 patterns.
15479
15480HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
15481following situations :
15482 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
15483 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
15484 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
15485 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
15486 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
15487 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
15488 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
15489 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
15490 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
15491 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
15492
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015493
154947.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
15495----------------------------------
15496
15497Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
15498combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
15499
15500 - AND (implicit)
15501 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
15502 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015503
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015504A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015505
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015506 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020015507
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015508Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
15509indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020015510
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015511For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
15512"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
15513requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
15514is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
15515
15516 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015517 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
15518 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
15519 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015520
15521To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
15522and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
15523
15524 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
15525 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
15526 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
15527 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
15528
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015529 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015530 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
15531 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
15532 use_backend www if host_www
15533
15534It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
15535expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
15536be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
15537the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
15538
15539 The following rule :
15540
15541 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015542 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015543
15544 Can also be written that way :
15545
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015546 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015547
15548It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
15549to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
15550simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
15551sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
15552good use is the following :
15553
15554 With named ACLs :
15555
15556 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
15557 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
15558 monitor fail if site_dead
15559
15560 With anonymous ACLs :
15561
15562 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
15563
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015564See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
15565keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015566
15567
155687.3. Fetching samples
15569---------------------
15570
15571Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
15572against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
15573sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
15574ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
15575of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
15576available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
15577
15578This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
15579Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
15580compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
15581deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
15582
15583The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
15584matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
15585method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
15586indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
15587
15588As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
15589when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
15590mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
15591the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
15592ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
15593
15594Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
15595multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
15596when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015597incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
15598are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015599is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
15600all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
15601
15602Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
15603 - name
15604 - name(arg1)
15605 - name(arg1,arg2)
15606
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015607
156087.3.1. Converters
15609-----------------
15610
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015611Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
15612of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
15613is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
15614was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015615has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015616unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
15617
15618These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
15619sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
15620the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015621support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015622
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015623A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
15624support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
15625supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
15626(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
15627bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
15628
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015629The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015630
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001563151d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
15632 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
15633 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
15634 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
15635 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
15636 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
15637
15638 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015639 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
15640 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000015641 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
15642 frontend http-in
15643 bind *:8081
15644 default_backend servers
15645 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
15646 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
15647
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015648add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015649 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015650 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015651 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
15652 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015653 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015654 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15655 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15656 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15657 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015658 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015659 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015660
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010015661aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
15662 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
15663 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
15664 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
15665 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
15666 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
15667 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
15668
15669 Example:
15670 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
15671 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
15672
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015673and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015674 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015675 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015676 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
15677 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015678 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015679 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15680 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15681 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15682 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015683 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015684 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015685
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020015686b64dec
15687 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
15688 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020015689 For base64url("URL and Filename Safe Alphabet" (RFC 4648)) variant
15690 see "ub64dec".
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020015691
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020015692base64
15693 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015694 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020015695 an SSL ID can be copied in a header). For base64url("URL and Filename
15696 Safe Alphabet" (RFC 4648)) variant see "ub64enc".
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020015697
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015698bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015699 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015700 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015701 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015702 presence of a flag).
15703
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010015704bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
15705 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
15706 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010015707 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010015708
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010015709concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
15710 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
15711 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
15712 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
15713 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
15714 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
15715 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
15716 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
15717 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
15718 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
15719 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015720 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. If commas or closing
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040015721 parenthesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015722 backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
15723 level parser. See examples below.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010015724
15725 Example:
15726 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
15727 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
15728 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010015729 tcp-request session set-var(txn.ipport) "str(),concat('addr=(',sess.ip),concat(',',sess.port,')')"
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010015730 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
15731
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015732cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015733 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
15734 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015735
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010015736crc32([<avalanche>])
15737 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
15738 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15739 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15740 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
15741 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
15742 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
15743 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
15744 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
15745 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
15746 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010015747 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
15748
15749crc32c([<avalanche>])
15750 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
15751 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15752 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15753 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
15754 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
15755 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
15756 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
15757 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010015758
Christopher Fauletea159d62020-04-01 16:21:44 +020015759cut_crlf
15760 Cuts the string representation of the input sample on the first carriage
15761 return ('\r') or newline ('\n') character found. Only the string length is
15762 updated.
15763
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010015764da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020015765 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
15766 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
15767 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
15768 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000015769 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020015770 configuration language.
15771
15772 Example:
15773 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020015774 bind *:8881
15775 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000015776 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020015777
Willy Tarreau0851fd52019-12-17 10:07:25 +010015778debug([<prefix][,<destination>])
15779 This converter is used as debug tool. It takes a capture of the input sample
15780 and sends it to event sink <destination>, which may designate a ring buffer
15781 such as "buf0", as well as "stdout", or "stderr". Available sinks may be
15782 checked at run time by issuing "show events" on the CLI. When not specified,
15783 the output will be "buf0", which may be consulted via the CLI's "show events"
15784 command. An optional prefix <prefix> may be passed to help distinguish
15785 outputs from multiple expressions. It will then appear before the colon in
15786 the output message. The input sample is passed as-is on the output, so that
15787 it is safe to insert the debug converter anywhere in a chain, even with non-
15788 printable sample types.
15789
15790 Example:
15791 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src,debug(track-sc)
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020015792
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020015793digest(<algorithm>)
15794 Converts a binary input sample to a message digest. The result is a binary
15795 sample. The <algorithm> must be an OpenSSL message digest name (e.g. sha256).
15796
15797 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
15798 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
15799
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015800div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015801 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
15802 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020015803 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015804 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
15805 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010015806 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010015807 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
15808 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
15809 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
15810 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015811 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010015812 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015813
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015814djb2([<avalanche>])
15815 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
15816 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
15817 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
15818 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
15819 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
15820 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
15821 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010015822 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
15823 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020015824
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015825even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020015826 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010015827 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
15828
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020015829field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
15830 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
15831 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
15832 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
15833 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
15834 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
15835 fields.
15836
15837 Example :
15838 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
15839 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
15840 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
15841 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
15842 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010015843
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020015844fix_is_valid
15845 Parses a binary payload and performs sanity checks regarding FIX (Financial
15846 Information eXchange):
15847
15848 - checks that all tag IDs and values are not empty and the tags IDs are well
15849 numeric
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050015850 - checks the BeginString tag is the first tag with a valid FIX version
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020015851 - checks the BodyLength tag is the second one with the right body length
Christopher Fauleted4bef72021-03-18 17:40:56 +010015852 - checks the MsgType tag is the third tag.
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020015853 - checks that last tag in the message is the CheckSum tag with a valid
15854 checksum
15855
15856 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
15857 the server can be parsed.
15858
15859 This converter returns a boolean, true if the payload contains a valid FIX
15860 message, false if not.
15861
15862 See also the fix_tag_value converter.
15863
15864 Example:
15865 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
15866 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
15867
15868fix_tag_value(<tag>)
15869 Parses a FIX (Financial Information eXchange) message and extracts the value
15870 from the tag <tag>. <tag> can be a string or an integer pointing to the
15871 desired tag. Any integer value is accepted, but only the following strings
15872 are translated into their integer equivalent: BeginString, BodyLength,
Daniel Corbettbefef702021-03-09 23:00:34 -050015873 MsgType, SenderCompID, TargetCompID, CheckSum. More tag names can be easily
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020015874 added.
15875
15876 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
15877 the server can be parsed. No message validation is performed by this
15878 converter. It is highly recommended to validate the message first using
15879 fix_is_valid converter.
15880
15881 See also the fix_is_valid converter.
15882
15883 Example:
15884 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
15885 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
15886 # MsgType tag ID is 35, so both lines below will return the same content
15887 tcp-request content set-var(txn.foo) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(35)
15888 tcp-request content set-var(txn.bar) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(MsgType)
15889
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015890hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015891 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015892 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015893 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015894 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010015895
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020015896hex2i
15897 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015898 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020015899
Christopher Faulet4ccc12f2020-04-01 09:08:32 +020015900htonl
15901 Converts the input integer value to its 32-bit binary representation in the
15902 network byte order. Because sample fetches own signed 64-bit integer, when
15903 this converter is used, the input integer value is first casted to an
15904 unsigned 32-bit integer.
15905
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010015906hmac(<algorithm>,<key>)
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020015907 Converts a binary input sample to a message authentication code with the given
15908 key. The result is a binary sample. The <algorithm> must be one of the
15909 registered OpenSSL message digest names (e.g. sha256). The <key> parameter must
15910 be base64 encoded and can either be a string or a variable.
15911
15912 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
15913 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
15914
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010015915http_date([<offset],[<unit>])
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020015916 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
15917 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000015918 an offset value is specified, then it is added to the date before the
15919 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit Date header fields,
15920 Expires values in responses when combined with a positive offset, or
15921 Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
15922 If a unit value is specified, then consider the timestamp as either
15923 "s" for seconds (default behavior), "ms" for milliseconds, or "us" for
15924 microseconds since epoch. Offset is assumed to have the same unit as
15925 input timestamp.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015926
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020015927iif(<true>,<false>)
15928 Returns the <true> string if the input value is true. Returns the <false>
15929 string otherwise.
15930
15931 Example:
Tim Duesterhus870713b2020-09-11 17:13:12 +020015932 http-request set-header x-forwarded-proto %[ssl_fc,iif(https,http)]
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020015933
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015934in_table(<table>)
15935 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
15936 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
15937 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015938 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020015939 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
15940
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010015941ipmask(<mask4>,[<mask6>])
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010015942 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020015943 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010015944 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
15945 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
15946 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
15947 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
15948 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020015949
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015950json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015951 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015952 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020015953 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015954 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
15955 of errors:
15956 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
15957 bytes, ...)
15958 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
15959 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
15960
15961 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
15962 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
15963 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
15964 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
15965 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
15966 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015967 - "ascii" : never fails;
15968 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
15969 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015970 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015971 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015972 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
15973 characters corresponding to the other errors.
15974
15975 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015976 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015977
15978 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015979 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020015980 capture request header user-agent len 150
15981 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020015982
15983 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
15984 GET / HTTP/1.0
15985 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
15986
15987 Output log:
15988 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
15989
Alex51c8ad42021-04-15 16:45:15 +020015990json_query(<json_path>,[<output_type>])
15991 The json_query converter supports the JSON types string, boolean and
15992 number. Floating point numbers will be returned as a string. By
15993 specifying the output_type 'int' the value will be converted to an
15994 Integer. If conversion is not possible the json_query converter fails.
15995
15996 <json_path> must be a valid JSON Path string as defined in
15997 https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/draft-ietf-jsonpath-base/
15998
15999 Example:
16000 # get a integer value from the request body
16001 # "{"integer":4}" => 5
16002 http-request set-var(txn.pay_int) req.body,json_query('$.integer','int'),add(1)
16003
16004 # get a key with '.' in the name
16005 # {"my.key":"myvalue"} => myvalue
16006 http-request set-var(txn.pay_mykey) req.body,json_query('$.my\\.key')
16007
16008 # {"boolean-false":false} => 0
16009 http-request set-var(txn.pay_boolean_false) req.body,json_query('$.boolean-false')
16010
16011 # get the value of the key 'iss' from a JWT Bearer token
16012 http-request set-var(txn.token_payload) req.hdr(Authorization),word(2,.),ub64dec,json_query('$.iss')
16013
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016014language(<value>[,<default>])
16015 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
16016 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
16017 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
16018 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
16019 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
16020 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
16021 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
16022 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
16023 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016024 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016025 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
16026 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016027
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016028 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016029
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016030 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
16031 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016032
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016033 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
16034 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
16035 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
16036 use_backend spanish if es
16037 use_backend french if fr
16038 use_backend english if en
16039 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016040
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010016041length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010016042 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
16043 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
16044 type. The result is of type integer.
16045
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016046lower
16047 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
16048 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
16049 type. The result is of type string.
16050
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016051ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
16052 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
16053 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
16054 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
16055 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
16056 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
16057 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
16058
16059 Example :
16060
16061 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016062 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016063 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
16064
Christopher Faulet51fc9d12020-04-01 17:24:41 +020016065ltrim(<chars>)
16066 Skips any characters from <chars> from the beginning of the string
16067 representation of the input sample.
16068
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016069map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16070map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16071map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16072 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
16073 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
16074 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
16075 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
16076 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
16077 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
16078 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
16079 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016080
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016081 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
16082 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
16083 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016084
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016085 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016086 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016087
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016088 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
16089 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16090 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
16091 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020016092 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
16093 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016094 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
16095 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16096 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
16097 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16098 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
16099 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16100 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
16101 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080016102 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
16103 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16104 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016105 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16106 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
16107 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16108 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
16109 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016110
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010016111 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
16112 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
16113 the corresponding match text.
16114
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016115 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
16116 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
16117 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
16118 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
16119 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016120
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016121 Example :
16122
16123 # this is a comment and is ignored
16124 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
16125 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
16126 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
16127 | | | `---------- value
16128 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
16129 | `---------------------------- key
16130 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
16131
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016132mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016133 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
16134 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016135 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016136 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016137 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016138 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16139 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16140 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16141 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016142 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016143 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016144
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010016145mqtt_field_value(<packettype>,<fieldname or property ID>)
16146 Returns value of <fieldname> found in input MQTT payload of type
16147 <packettype>.
16148 <packettype> can be either a string (case insensitive matching) or a numeric
16149 value corresponding to the type of packet we're supposed to extract data
16150 from.
16151 Supported string and integers can be found here:
16152 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v3.1.1/os/mqtt-v3.1.1-os.html#_Toc398718021
16153 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901022
16154
16155 <fieldname> depends on <packettype> and can be any of the following below.
16156 (note that <fieldname> matching is case insensitive).
16157 <property id> can only be found in MQTT v5.0 streams. check this table:
16158 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901029
16159
16160 - CONNECT (or 1): flags, protocol_name, protocol_version, client_identifier,
16161 will_topic, will_payload, username, password, keepalive
16162 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
16163 packets only):
16164 17: Session Expiry Interval
16165 33: Receive Maximum
16166 39: Maximum Packet Size
16167 34: Topic Alias Maximum
16168 25: Request Response Information
16169 23: Request Problem Information
16170 21: Authentication Method
16171 22: Authentication Data
16172 18: Will Delay Interval
16173 1: Payload Format Indicator
16174 2: Message Expiry Interval
16175 3: Content Type
16176 8: Response Topic
16177 9: Correlation Data
16178 Not supported yet:
16179 38: User Property
16180
16181 - CONNACK (or 2): flags, protocol_version, reason_code
16182 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
16183 packets only):
16184 17: Session Expiry Interval
16185 33: Receive Maximum
16186 36: Maximum QoS
16187 37: Retain Available
16188 39: Maximum Packet Size
16189 18: Assigned Client Identifier
16190 34: Topic Alias Maximum
16191 31: Reason String
16192 40; Wildcard Subscription Available
16193 41: Subscription Identifiers Available
16194 42: Shared Subscription Available
16195 19: Server Keep Alive
16196 26: Response Information
16197 28: Server Reference
16198 21: Authentication Method
16199 22: Authentication Data
16200 Not supported yet:
16201 38: User Property
16202
16203 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16204 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
16205 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
16206 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
16207
16208 Example:
16209
16210 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
16211 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
16212 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(connect,protocol_name) \
16213 if data_in_buffer
16214 # do the same as above
16215 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
16216 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(1,protocol_name) \
16217 if data_in_buffer
16218
16219mqtt_is_valid
16220 Checks that the binary input is a valid MQTT packet. It returns a boolean.
16221
16222 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16223 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
16224 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
16225 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
16226
16227 Example:
16228
16229 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
16230 tcp-request content reject unless req.payload(0,0),mqtt_is_valid
16231
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016232mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016233 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020016234 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
16235 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016236 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016237 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016238 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016239 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16240 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16241 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16242 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016243 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016244 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016245
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010016246nbsrv
16247 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
16248 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
16249 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
16250 map lookup.
16251
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016252neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016253 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
16254 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
16255 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
16256 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016257
16258not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016259 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016260 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016261 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016262 absence of a flag).
16263
16264odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016265 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016266 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
16267
16268or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016269 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016270 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016271 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
16272 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016273 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016274 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16275 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16276 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16277 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016278 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016279 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016280
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016281protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
16282 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
16283 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
16284 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
16285 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
16286 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
16287 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
16288 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
16289 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
16290 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
16291 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
16292 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
16293
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010016294regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016295 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
16296 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
16297 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
16298 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
16299 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
16300 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
16301 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
16302 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
16303 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016304 The first use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence
16305 of characters with other ones.
16306
16307 It is highly recommended to enclose the regex part using protected quotes to
16308 improve clarity and never have a closing parenthesis from the regex mixed up
16309 with the parenthesis from the function. Just like in Bourne shell, the first
16310 level of quotes is processed when delimiting word groups on the line, a
16311 second level is usable for argument. It is recommended to use single quotes
16312 outside since these ones do not try to resolve backslashes nor dollar signs.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016313
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010016314 Examples:
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016315
16316 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
16317 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
16318 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016319 http-request set-header x-path "%[hdr(x-path),regsub('/+','/','g')]"
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016320
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010016321 # copy query string to x-query and drop all leading '?', ';' and '&'
16322 http-request set-header x-query "%[query,regsub([?;&]*,'')]"
16323
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010016324 # capture groups and backreferences
16325 # both lines do the same.
Willy Tarreau465dc7d2020-10-08 18:05:56 +020016326 http-request redirect location %[url,'regsub("(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?","\2\1",i)']
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010016327 http-request redirect location %[url,regsub(\"(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?\",\"\2\1\",i)]
16328
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020016329capture-req(<id>)
16330 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
16331 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
16332
16333 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020016334 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
16335 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020016336
16337capture-res(<id>)
16338 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
16339 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
16340
16341 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020016342 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
16343 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020016344
Christopher Faulet568415a2020-04-01 17:24:47 +020016345rtrim(<chars>)
16346 Skips any characters from <chars> from the end of the string representation
16347 of the input sample.
16348
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016349sdbm([<avalanche>])
16350 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
16351 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16352 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16353 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16354 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16355 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
16356 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016357 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
16358 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016359
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020016360secure_memcmp(<var>)
16361 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value. Both values are treated
16362 as a binary string. Returns a boolean indicating whether both binary strings
16363 match.
16364
16365 If both binary strings have the same length then the comparison will be
16366 performed in constant time.
16367
16368 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
16369 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16370
16371 Example :
16372
16373 http-request set-var(txn.token) hdr(token)
16374 # Check whether the token sent by the client matches the secret token
16375 # value, without leaking the contents using a timing attack.
16376 acl token_given str(my_secret_token),secure_memcmp(txn.token)
16377
Tim Duesterhusef4e45c2021-01-21 17:40:50 +010016378set-var(<var>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016379 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
16380 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
16381 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016382 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016383 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16384 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016385 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016386 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16387 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016388 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016389 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016390
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020016391sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020016392 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020016393 sample with length of 20 bytes.
16394
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020016395sha2([<bits>])
16396 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
16397 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
16398
16399 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
16400 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
16401
16402 Please note that this converter is only available when haproxy has been
16403 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16404
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020016405srv_queue
16406 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
16407 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
16408 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
16409 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
16410 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
16411
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020016412strcmp(<var>)
16413 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
16414 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
16415 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
16416 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
16417 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
16418 shorter).
16419
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020016420 See also the secure_memcmp converter if you need to compare two binary
16421 strings in constant time.
16422
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020016423 Example :
16424
16425 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
16426 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
16427 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
16428
16429
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016430sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016431 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
16432 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016433 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016434 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
16435 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016436 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016437 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16438 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016439 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016440 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16441 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016442 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016443 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016444
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016445table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
16446 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16447 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16448 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
16449 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
16450 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
16451 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
16452
16453
16454table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
16455 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16456 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16457 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
16458 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
16459 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
16460 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
16461
16462table_conn_cnt(<table>)
16463 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16464 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016465 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016466 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
16467 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16468
16469table_conn_cur(<table>)
16470 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16471 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16472 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
16473 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
16474 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
16475
16476table_conn_rate(<table>)
16477 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16478 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16479 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
16480 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
16481 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
16482
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020016483table_gpt0(<table>)
16484 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16485 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
16486 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
16487 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
16488 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
16489
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016490table_gpc0(<table>)
16491 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16492 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16493 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
16494 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
16495 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
16496
16497table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
16498 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16499 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16500 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
16501 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
16502 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
16503 sample fetch keyword.
16504
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016505table_gpc1(<table>)
16506 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16507 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16508 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
16509 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
16510 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
16511
16512table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
16513 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16514 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16515 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
16516 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
16517 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
16518 sample fetch keyword.
16519
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016520table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
16521 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16522 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016523 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016524 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
16525 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16526
16527table_http_err_rate(<table>)
16528 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16529 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16530 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
16531 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
16532 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
16533 keyword.
16534
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010016535table_http_fail_cnt(<table>)
16536 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16537 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16538 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
16539 failures associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
16540 the sc_http_fail_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16541
16542table_http_fail_rate(<table>)
16543 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16544 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16545 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP failures associated with the
16546 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of failures over the
16547 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_fail_rate sample fetch
16548 keyword.
16549
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016550table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
16551 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16552 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016553 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016554 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
16555 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16556
16557table_http_req_rate(<table>)
16558 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16559 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16560 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
16561 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
16562 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
16563 keyword.
16564
16565table_kbytes_in(<table>)
16566 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16567 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016568 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016569 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
16570 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
16571 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
16572 keyword.
16573
16574table_kbytes_out(<table>)
16575 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16576 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016577 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016578 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
16579 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
16580 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
16581 keyword.
16582
16583table_server_id(<table>)
16584 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16585 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16586 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
16587 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
16588 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
16589 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
16590
16591table_sess_cnt(<table>)
16592 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16593 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016594 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016595 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
16596 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
16597 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
16598 keyword.
16599
16600table_sess_rate(<table>)
16601 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16602 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16603 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
16604 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
16605 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
16606 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
16607 keyword.
16608
16609table_trackers(<table>)
16610 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16611 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16612 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
16613 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
16614 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
16615 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
16616 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
16617 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
16618 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
16619 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
16620
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020016621ub64dec
16622 This converter is the base64url variant of b64dec converter. base64url
16623 encoding is the "URL and Filename Safe Alphabet" variant of base64 encoding.
16624 It is also the encoding used in JWT (JSON Web Token) standard.
16625
16626 Example:
16627 # Decoding a JWT payload:
16628 http-request set-var(txn.token_payload) req.hdr(Authorization),word(2,.),ub64dec
16629
16630ub64enc
16631 This converter is the base64url variant of base64 converter.
16632
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016633upper
16634 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
16635 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
16636 type. The result is of type string.
16637
Willy Tarreau62ba9ba2020-04-23 17:54:47 +020016638url_dec([<in_form>])
16639 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded version
16640 as output. The input and the output are of type string. If the <in_form>
16641 argument is set to a non-zero integer value, the input string is assumed to
16642 be part of a form or query string and the '+' character will be turned into a
16643 space (' '). Otherwise this will only happen after a question mark indicating
16644 a query string ('?').
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020016645
William Dauchy888b0ae2021-01-06 23:39:50 +010016646url_enc([<enc_type>])
16647 Takes a string provided as input and returns the encoded version as output.
16648 The input and the output are of type string. By default the type of encoding
16649 is meant for `query` type. There is no other type supported for now but the
16650 optional argument is here for future changes.
16651
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016652ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010016653 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016654 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
16655 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
16656 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016657 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
16658 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
16659 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
16660 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010016661 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016662 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
16663 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010016664
16665 Example:
16666 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
16667 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
16668
16669 message Point {
16670 int32 latitude = 1;
16671 int32 longitude = 2;
16672 }
16673
16674 message PPoint {
16675 Point point = 59;
16676 }
16677
16678 message Rectangle {
16679 // One corner of the rectangle.
16680 PPoint lo = 48;
16681 // The other corner of the rectangle.
16682 PPoint hi = 49;
16683 }
16684
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020016685 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
16686 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
16687 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010016688
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016689 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
16690 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016691 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016692 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
16693
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020016694 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016695
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010016696 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010016697
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020016698 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
16699 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
16700 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016701
16702 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
16703 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
16704 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
16705
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020016706 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
16707 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
16708 interpret the previous binary sample.
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016709
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010016710
Tim Duesterhusef4e45c2021-01-21 17:40:50 +010016711unset-var(<var>)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010016712 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
16713 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
16714 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
16715 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16716 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
16717 response),
16718 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16719 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
16720 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
16721 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
16722
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016723utime(<format>[,<offset>])
16724 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
16725 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
16726 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
16727 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
16728 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
16729 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
16730
16731 Example :
16732
16733 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016734 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016735 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
16736
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020016737word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
16738 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
16739 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
16740 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010016741 Delimiters at the beginning or end of the input string are ignored.
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020016742 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
16743 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
16744
16745 Example :
16746 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
16747 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
16748 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
16749 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
16750 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010016751 str(/f1/f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f1
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010016752
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016753wt6([<avalanche>])
16754 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
16755 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16756 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16757 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16758 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16759 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
16760 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016761 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
16762 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016763
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016764xor(<value>)
16765 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016766 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016767 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016768 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016769 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016770 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16771 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016772 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016773 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16774 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016775 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016776 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016777
Dragan Dosen04bf0cc2020-12-22 21:44:33 +010016778xxh3([<seed>])
16779 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the XXH3
16780 64-bit variant of the XXhash hash function. This hash supports a seed which
16781 defaults to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument.
16782 This hash is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash
16783 URLs and/or URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics
16784 with a low collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not
16785 considered as cryptographically secure.
16786
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010016787xxh32([<seed>])
16788 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
16789 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
16790 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
16791 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
16792 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
16793 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
16794 as cryptographically secure.
16795
16796xxh64([<seed>])
16797 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
16798 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
16799 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
16800 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
16801 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
16802 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
16803 as cryptographically secure.
16804
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016805
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200168067.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016807--------------------------------------------
16808
16809A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
16810not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
16811"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
16812The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
16813
16814always_false : boolean
16815 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
16816 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
16817
16818always_true : boolean
16819 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
16820 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
16821
16822avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016823 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016824 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
16825 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
16826 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
16827 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
16828 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
16829 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
16830 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
16831 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
16832 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
16833 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
16834 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
16835 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
16836 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010016837
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016838be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020016839 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
16840 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
16841 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
16842 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040016843 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
16844
16845be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
16846 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
16847 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
16848 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
16849 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
16850 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040016851 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
16852 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040016853
16854 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
16855 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
16856 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016857
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016858be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
16859 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
16860 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
16861 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016862 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016863 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
16864 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010016865
16866 Example :
16867 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
16868 backend dynamic
16869 mode http
16870 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
16871 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016872
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016873bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020016874 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
16875 of the string.
16876
16877bool(<bool>) : bool
16878 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
16879 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
16880
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016881connslots([<backend>]) : integer
16882 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016883 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016884 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
16885 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050016886
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080016887 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016888 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080016889 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
16890
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016891 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
16892 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080016893
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020016894 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016895 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016896 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016897 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016898 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016899 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020016900 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080016901
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016902 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
16903 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016904 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016905 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080016906
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010016907cpu_calls : integer
16908 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
16909 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
16910 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
16911 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
16912 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
16913 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
16914
16915cpu_ns_avg : integer
16916 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
16917 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
16918 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
16919 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
16920 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
16921 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
16922 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
16923 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
16924 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
16925 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
16926 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
16927
16928cpu_ns_tot : integer
16929 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
16930 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
16931 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
16932 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
16933 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
16934 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
16935 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
16936 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
16937 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
16938 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
16939 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
16940 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
16941 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
16942
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010016943date([<offset>],[<unit>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020016944 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000016945
16946 If an offset value is specified, then it is added to the current date before
16947 returning the value. This is particularly useful to compute relative dates,
16948 as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020016949 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
16950
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000016951 <unit> is facultative, and can be set to "s" for seconds (default behavior),
16952 "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds.
16953 If unit is set, return value is an integer reflecting either seconds,
16954 milliseconds or microseconds since epoch, plus offset.
16955 It is useful when a time resolution of less than a second is needed.
16956
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020016957 Example :
16958
16959 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
16960 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020016961
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000016962 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response, with
16963 # millisecond granularity
16964 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600000,ms),http_date(0,ms)]
16965
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010016966date_us : integer
16967 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
16968 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
16969 from the same timeval structure.
16970
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020016971distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
16972 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
16973 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
16974 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
16975 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
16976 haproxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
16977 list of supported tokens.
16978
16979distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
16980 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
16981 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
16982 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
16983 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
16984 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through haproxy.
16985 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
16986 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
16987 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
16988 supported tokens.
16989
16990 Example :
16991 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
16992 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
16993 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
16994 # send large files to the big farm
16995 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
16996
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020016997env(<name>) : string
16998 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
16999 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
17000 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
17001 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
17002 certain way.
17003
17004 Examples :
17005 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
17006 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
17007
17008 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
17009 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
17010
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017011fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
17012 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017013 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
17014 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017015 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
17016 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017017 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017018 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
17019 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017020
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020017021fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
17022 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
17023 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
17024 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
17025
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017026fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
17027 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17028 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
17029 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
17030 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
17031 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
17032 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
17033 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
17034 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010017035
17036 Example :
17037 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
17038 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
17039 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
17040 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
17041 frontend mail
17042 bind :25
17043 mode tcp
17044 maxconn 100
17045 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
17046 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
17047 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
17048 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017049
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010017050hostname : string
17051 Returns the system hostname.
17052
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017053int(<integer>) : signed integer
17054 Returns a signed integer.
17055
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017056ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
17057 Returns an ipv4.
17058
17059ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
17060 Returns an ipv6.
17061
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017062lat_ns_avg : integer
17063 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
17064 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
17065 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
17066 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
17067 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
17068 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
17069 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
17070 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
17071 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020017072 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
17073 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
17074 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
17075 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
17076 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: this value is
17077 exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017078
17079lat_ns_tot : integer
17080 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
17081 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
17082 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
17083 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
17084 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
17085 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
17086 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
17087 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
17088 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020017089 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
17090 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
17091 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
17092 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
17093 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017094 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
17095 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
17096 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
17097 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
17098 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
17099 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
17100
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017101meth(<method>) : method
17102 Returns a method.
17103
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017104nbproc : integer
17105 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
17106 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
17107 and debugging purposes.
17108
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017109nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
17110 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
17111 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
17112 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017113 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
17114 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
17115 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010017116
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040017117prio_class : integer
17118 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
17119 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
17120 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
17121
17122prio_offset : integer
17123 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
17124 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
17125 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
17126 set-priority-offset".
17127
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017128proc : integer
17129 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
17130 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
17131 debugging purposes.
17132
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017133queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017134 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
17135 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
17136 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017137 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
17138 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
17139 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
17140 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
17141 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
17142
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010017143rand([<range>]) : integer
17144 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
17145 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
17146 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
17147 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
17148 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
17149
Luca Schimweg8a694b82019-09-10 15:42:52 +020017150uuid([<version>]) : string
17151 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
17152 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
17153 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
17154
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017155srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17156 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
17157 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
17158 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
17159 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
17160 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040017161 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
17162 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
17163
17164srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17165 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
17166 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
17167 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
17168 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
17169 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
17170 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
17171 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
17172
17173 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
17174 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017175
17176srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
17177 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
17178 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
17179 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017180 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017181 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
17182 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
17183 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
17184
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020017185srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17186 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
17187 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
17188 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
17189 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
17190 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
17191 fetch methods.
17192
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017193srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17194 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17195 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017196 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017197 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
17198 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017199 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017200 overloading servers).
17201
17202 Example :
17203 # Redirect to a separate back
17204 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
17205 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
17206 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
17207
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020017208srv_iweight([<backend>/]<server>): integer
17209 Returns an integer corresponding to the server's initial weight. If <backend>
17210 is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. See also
17211 "srv_weight" and "srv_uweight".
17212
17213srv_uweight([<backend>/]<server>): integer
17214 Returns an integer corresponding to the user visible server's weight. If
17215 <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
17216 backend. See also "srv_weight" and "srv_iweight".
17217
17218srv_weight([<backend>/]<server>): integer
17219 Returns an integer corresponding to the current (or effective) server's
17220 weight. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
17221 backend. See also "srv_iweight" and "srv_uweight".
17222
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017223stopping : boolean
17224 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
17225 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
17226 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
17227
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017228str(<string>) : string
17229 Returns a string.
17230
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017231table_avl([<table>]) : integer
17232 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
17233 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
17234
17235table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17236 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
17237 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
17238 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
17239
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010017240thread : integer
17241 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
17242 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
17243 and debugging purposes.
17244
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017245var(<var-name>) : undefined
17246 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017247 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
17248 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017249 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017250 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17251 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017252 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017253 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17254 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017255 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017256 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017257
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200172587.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017259----------------------------------
17260
17261The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
17262closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
17263methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
17264sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
17265TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017266the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
17267counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020017268"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
17269used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
17270can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
17271Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
17272table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
17273tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
17274currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017275
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017276bc_dst : ip
17277 This is the destination ip address of the connection on the server side,
17278 which is the server address HAProxy connected to. It is of type IP and works
17279 on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its
17280 IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291.
17281
17282bc_dst_port : integer
17283 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
17284 connection on the server side, which is the port HAproxy connected to.
17285
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010017286bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010017287 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
17288 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
17289 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
17290
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017291bc_src : ip
17292 This is the source ip address of the connection on the server side, which is
17293 the server address haproxy connected from. It is of type IP and works on both
17294 IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are mapped to their IPv6
17295 equivalent, according to RFC 4291.
17296
17297bc_src_port : integer
17298 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
17299 connection on the server side, which is the port HAproxy connected from.
17300
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017301be_id : integer
17302 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020017303 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
17304 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017305
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010017306be_name : string
17307 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020017308 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
17309 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010017310
Amaury Denoyelled91d7792020-12-10 13:43:56 +010017311be_server_timeout : integer
17312 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the server timeout of the
17313 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
17314 also the "cur_server_timeout".
17315
17316be_tunnel_timeout : integer
17317 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the tunnel timeout of the
17318 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
17319 also the "cur_tunnel_timeout".
17320
Amaury Denoyellef7719a22020-12-10 13:43:58 +010017321cur_server_timeout : integer
17322 Returns the currently applied server timeout in millisecond for the stream.
17323 In the default case, this will be equal to be_server_timeout unless a
17324 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_server_timeout".
17325
17326cur_tunnel_timeout : integer
17327 Returns the currently applied tunnel timeout in millisecond for the stream.
17328 In the default case, this will be equal to be_tunnel_timeout unless a
17329 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_tunnel_timeout".
17330
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017331dst : ip
17332 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
17333 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
17334 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
17335 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010017336 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
17337 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
17338 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
17339 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
17340 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
17341 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017342
17343dst_conn : integer
17344 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
17345 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
17346 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
17347 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
17348 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
17349 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
17350 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
17351 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017352
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020017353dst_is_local : boolean
17354 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
17355 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
17356 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
17357 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017358 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020017359 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
17360 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
17361 it only once per connection.
17362
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017363dst_port : integer
17364 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
17365 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
17366 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
17367 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
17368 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
17369 an HTTP header.
17370
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020017371fc_http_major : integer
17372 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
17373 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
17374 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
17375
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020017376fc_pp_authority : string
17377 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
17378 if any.
17379
Tim Duesterhusd1b15b62020-03-13 12:34:23 +010017380fc_pp_unique_id : string
17381 Returns the unique ID TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
17382 if any.
17383
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010017384fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
17385 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
17386 header.
17387
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020017388fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
17389 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
17390 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
17391 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
17392 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
17393 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
17394 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17395
17396fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
17397 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
17398 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
17399 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
17400 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
17401 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
17402 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17403
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017404fc_unacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017405 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
17406 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
17407 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
17408 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17409
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017410fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017411 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
17412 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
17413 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
17414 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17415
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017416fc_retrans : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017417 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
17418 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17419 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17420 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17421
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017422fc_fackets : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017423 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
17424 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17425 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17426 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17427
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017428fc_lost : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017429 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
17430 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17431 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17432 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17433
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017434fc_reordering : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017435 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
17436 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17437 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17438 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17439
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020017440fe_defbe : string
17441 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
17442 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
17443
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017444fe_id : integer
17445 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010017446 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017447 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
17448
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010017449fe_name : string
17450 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
17451 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
17452 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
17453
Amaury Denoyelleda184d52020-12-10 13:43:55 +010017454fe_client_timeout : integer
17455 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the client timeout of the
17456 current frontend.
17457
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017458sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017459sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
17460sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
17461sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017462 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
17463 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
17464 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
17465
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017466sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017467sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
17468sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
17469sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017470 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
17471 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
17472 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
17473
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017474sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017475sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17476sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17477sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017478 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
17479 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010017480 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
17481 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
17482 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017483
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017484 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017485 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
17486 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017487 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
17488 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
17489 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017490 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
17491 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
17492
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017493sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17494sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17495sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17496sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17497 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
17498 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
17499 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
17500 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
17501 when a first ACL was verified.
17502
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017503sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017504sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17505sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17506sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017507 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017508 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
17509
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017510sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017511sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
17512sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
17513sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017514 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
17515 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
17516 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
17517
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017518sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017519sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
17520sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
17521sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017522 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
17523 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
17524 See also src_conn_rate.
17525
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017526sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017527sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17528sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17529sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017530 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017531 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017532
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017533sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17534sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17535sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17536sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17537 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
17538 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
17539
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020017540sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17541sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
17542sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
17543sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
17544 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
17545 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
17546
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017547sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017548sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
17549sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
17550sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017551 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
17552 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
17553 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017554 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
17555 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
17556 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017557
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017558sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17559sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
17560sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
17561sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
17562 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
17563 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
17564 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
17565 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
17566 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
17567 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
17568
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017569sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017570sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17571sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17572sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017573 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017574 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
17575 See also src_http_err_cnt.
17576
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017577sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017578sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
17579sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
17580sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017581 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
17582 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
17583 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
17584 src_http_err_rate.
17585
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010017586sc_http_fail_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17587sc0_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17588sc1_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17589sc2_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17590 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures from the currently
17591 tracked counters. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes
17592 other than 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_cnt.
17593
17594sc_http_fail_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17595sc0_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
17596sc1_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
17597sc2_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
17598 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures from the currently tracked
17599 counters, measured in amount of failures over the period configured in the
17600 table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes other than
17601 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_rate.
17602
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017603sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017604sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17605sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17606sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017607 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017608 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
17609 src_http_req_cnt.
17610
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017611sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017612sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
17613sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
17614sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017615 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
17616 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
17617 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
17618 src_http_req_rate.
17619
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017620sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017621sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17622sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17623sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017624 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010017625 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
17626 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
17627 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
17628 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017629
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017630 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017631 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
17632 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017633 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
17634
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017635sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17636sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17637sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17638sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17639 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
17640 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
17641 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
17642 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
17643 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
17644
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017645sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017646sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
17647sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
17648sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020017649 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
17650 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
17651 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017652
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017653sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017654sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
17655sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
17656sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020017657 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
17658 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
17659 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017660
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017661sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017662sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17663sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17664sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017665 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017666 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
17667 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
17668 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017669 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017670 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
17671
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017672sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017673sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
17674sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
17675sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017676 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
17677 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
17678 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
17679 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
17680 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017681 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017682
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017683sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017684sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
17685sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
17686sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020017687 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
17688 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
17689 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
17690
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017691sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017692sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
17693sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
17694sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010017695 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
17696 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017697 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010017698 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
17699 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017700 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
17701 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
17702 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010017703
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017704so_id : integer
17705 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
17706 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
17707 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017708
Jerome Magnineb421b22020-03-27 22:08:40 +010017709so_name : string
17710 Returns a string containing the current listening socket's name, as defined
17711 with name on a "bind" line. It can serve the same purposes as so_id but with
17712 strings instead of integers.
17713
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017714src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017715 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017716 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
17717 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
17718 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010017719 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
17720 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
17721 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010017722 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
17723 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
17724 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
17725 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
17726 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
17727 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
17728 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017729
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010017730 Example:
17731 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
17732 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
17733
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017734src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
17735 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
17736 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
17737 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017738 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017739
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017740src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
17741 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
17742 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017743 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017744 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017745
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017746src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17747 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
17748 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
17749 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
17750 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
17751 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
17752 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017753
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017754 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017755 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
17756 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
17757 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
17758 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010017759 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017760 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
17761 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
17762
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017763src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17764 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
17765 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
17766 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
17767 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
17768 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
17769 was verified.
17770
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017771src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017772 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017773 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017774 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017775 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017776
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017777src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017778 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017779 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
17780 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017781 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017782
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017783src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
17784 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
17785 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
17786 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017787 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017788
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017789src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017790 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017791 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017792 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017793 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017794
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017795src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17796 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
17797 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
17798 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
17799 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
17800
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020017801src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
17802 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
17803 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
17804 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
17805 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
17806
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017807src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017808 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017809 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017810 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
17811 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017812 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
17813 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
17814 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017815
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017816src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
17817 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
17818 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
17819 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
17820 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
17821 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
17822 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
17823 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
17824
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017825src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017826 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017827 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017828 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017829 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017830 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017831
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017832src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
17833 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
17834 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
17835 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
17836 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017837 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017838
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010017839src_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17840 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures triggered by the
17841 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Ilya Shipitsin0de36ad2021-02-20 00:23:36 +050017842 the designated stick-table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010017843 status codes other than 501 and 505. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_cnt.
17844 If the address is not found, zero is returned.
17845
17846src_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
17847 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures triggered by the incoming
17848 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
17849 designated stick-table, measured in amount of failures over the period
17850 configured in the table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
17851 status codes other than 501 and 505. If the address is not found, zero is
17852 returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_rate.
17853
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017854src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017855 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017856 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
17857 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017858 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017859
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017860src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
17861 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
17862 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
17863 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017864 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017865 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017866
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017867src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17868 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
17869 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
17870 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017871 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017872 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
17873 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017874
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017875 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017876 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010017877 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017878 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017879
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017880src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17881 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
17882 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
17883 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
17884 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
17885 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
17886 connection when a first ACL was verified.
17887
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020017888src_is_local : boolean
17889 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
17890 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
17891 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
17892 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017893 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020017894 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
17895 once per connection.
17896
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017897src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020017898 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
17899 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
17900 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
17901 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
17902 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017903
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017904src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020017905 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
17906 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
17907 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
17908 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
17909 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020017910
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017911src_port : integer
17912 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
17913 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
17914 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
17915 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010017916
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017917src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017918 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017919 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
17920 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
17921 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017922 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017923
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017924src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
17925 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
17926 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
17927 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
17928 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017929 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017930
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017931src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17932 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
17933 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
17934 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
17935 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
17936 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
17937 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
17938 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
17939 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020017940
17941 Example :
17942 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
17943 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
17944 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
17945 listen ssh
17946 bind :22
17947 mode tcp
17948 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020017949 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017950 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020017951 server local 127.0.0.1:22
17952
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017953srv_id : integer
17954 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
17955 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020017956 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020017957
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080017958srv_name : string
17959 Returns a string containing the server's name when processing the response.
17960 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020017961 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080017962
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200179637.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017964----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020017965
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017966The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
17967closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
17968when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
17969usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017970future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020017971
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001797251d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
17973 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
17974 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
17975 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
17976 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
17977 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
17978
17979 Example :
17980 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
17981 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
17982 # the request.
17983 frontend http-in
17984 bind *:8081
17985 default_backend servers
17986 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
17987 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
17988
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017989ssl_bc : boolean
17990 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
17991 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017992 other a server with the "ssl" option. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
17993 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017994
17995ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
17996 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020017997 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
17998 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020017999
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018000ssl_bc_alpn : string
18001 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
18002 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020018003 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018004 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
18005 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
18006 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
18007 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
18008 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018009 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn". It can be used in a
18010 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018011
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018012ssl_bc_cipher : string
18013 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018014 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
18015 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018016
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018017ssl_bc_client_random : binary
18018 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
18019 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18020 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018021 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018022
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010018023ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
18024 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18025 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018026 session or a TLS ticket. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
18027 ruleset.
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010018028
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018029ssl_bc_npn : string
18030 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
18031 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020018032 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018033 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
18034 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
18035 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
18036 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018037 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN. It can be used in a tcp-check
18038 or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018039
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018040ssl_bc_protocol : string
18041 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018042 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
18043 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018044
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018045ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018046 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018047 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018048 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64". It
18049 can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018050
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018051ssl_bc_server_random : binary
18052 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
18053 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18054 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018055 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018056
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018057ssl_bc_session_id : binary
18058 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
18059 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018060 if session was reused or not. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
18061 ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018062
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040018063ssl_bc_session_key : binary
18064 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
18065 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
18066 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018067 BoringSSL. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040018068
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018069ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
18070 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018071 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
18072 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018073
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018074ssl_c_ca_err : integer
18075 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18076 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
18077 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
18078 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
18079 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020018080
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018081ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
18082 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18083 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
18084 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
18085 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018086
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010018087ssl_c_chain_der : binary
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018088 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the client when the
18089 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18090 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050018091 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018092 does not support resumed sessions.
18093
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010018094ssl_c_der : binary
18095 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
18096 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18097 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18098
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018099ssl_c_err : integer
18100 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18101 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
18102 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
18103 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
18104 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018105
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018106ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018107 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18108 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
18109 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18110 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18111 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18112 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18113 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18114 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018115 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18116 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18117 LDAP v3.
18118 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18119 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018120
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018121ssl_c_key_alg : string
18122 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
18123 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18124 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018125
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018126ssl_c_notafter : string
18127 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
18128 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18129 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020018130
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018131ssl_c_notbefore : string
18132 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
18133 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18134 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010018135
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018136ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018137 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18138 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
18139 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18140 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18141 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18142 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18143 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18144 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018145 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18146 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18147 LDAP v3.
18148 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18149 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010018150
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018151ssl_c_serial : binary
18152 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
18153 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18154 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018155
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018156ssl_c_sha1 : binary
18157 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
18158 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
18159 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020018160 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
18161 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
18162
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018163 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020018164 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018165
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018166ssl_c_sig_alg : string
18167 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
18168 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18169 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018170
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018171ssl_c_used : boolean
18172 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
18173 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020018174
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018175ssl_c_verify : integer
18176 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
18177 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
18178 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
18179 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020018180
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018181ssl_c_version : integer
18182 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
18183 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020018184
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010018185ssl_f_der : binary
18186 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
18187 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18188 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18189
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018190ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018191 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18192 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
18193 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18194 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018195 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018196 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18197 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18198 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018199 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18200 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18201 LDAP v3.
18202 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18203 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018204
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018205ssl_f_key_alg : string
18206 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
18207 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
18208 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020018209
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018210ssl_f_notafter : string
18211 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
18212 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18213 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018214
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018215ssl_f_notbefore : string
18216 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
18217 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18218 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018219
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018220ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018221 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18222 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
18223 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18224 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18225 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18226 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18227 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18228 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018229 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18230 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18231 LDAP v3.
18232 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18233 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020018234
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018235ssl_f_serial : binary
18236 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
18237 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18238 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018239
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020018240ssl_f_sha1 : binary
18241 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
18242 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
18243 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
18244
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018245ssl_f_sig_alg : string
18246 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
18247 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18248 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020018249
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018250ssl_f_version : integer
18251 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
18252 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
18253
18254ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018255 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
18256 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
18257 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
18258
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018259 Example :
18260 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
18261 listen http-https
18262 bind :80
18263 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
18264 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
18265
18266ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
18267 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
18268 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
18269
18270ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018271 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018272 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
18273 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
18274 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
18275 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
18276 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
18277 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
18278 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
18279 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
18280
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018281ssl_fc_cipher : string
18282 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
18283 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020018284
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018285ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
18286 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
18287 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010018288 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018289
18290ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
18291 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
18292 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010018293 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018294
18295ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
18296 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
18297 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
18298 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018299 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020018300 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018301
18302ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
18303 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
18304 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010018305 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018306
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018307ssl_fc_client_random : binary
18308 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
18309 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18310 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
18311
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020018312ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret : string
18313 Return the CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18314 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18315 transport layer.
18316 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18317 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18318 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18319 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18320
18321ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret : string
18322 Return the CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18323 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18324 transport layer.
18325 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18326 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18327 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18328 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18329
18330ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0 : string
18331 Return the CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
18332 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18333 transport layer.
18334 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18335 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18336 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18337 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18338
18339ssl_fc_exporter_secret : string
18340 Return the EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18341 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18342 transport layer.
18343 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18344 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18345 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18346 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18347
18348ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret : string
18349 Return the EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18350 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
18351 transport layer.
18352 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18353 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18354 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18355 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18356
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018357ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018358 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
18359 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010018360 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
18361 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
18362 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
18363 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018364
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020018365ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
18366 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
18367 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
18368 wait until the handshake happened.
18369
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018370ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
18371 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020018372 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
18373 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018374 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020018375 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020018376
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020018377ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020018378 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010018379 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
18380 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020018381
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018382ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018383 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018384 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
18385 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
18386 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
18387 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
18388 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
18389 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
18390 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020018391
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018392ssl_fc_protocol : string
18393 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
18394 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020018395
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018396ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040018397 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018398 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
18399 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040018400
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020018401ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret : string
18402 Return the SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18403 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18404 transport layer.
18405 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18406 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18407 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18408 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18409
18410ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0 : string
18411 Return the SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
18412 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
18413 transport layer.
18414 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18415 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18416 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18417 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18418
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018419ssl_fc_server_random : binary
18420 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
18421 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18422 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
18423
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018424ssl_fc_session_id : binary
18425 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
18426 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
18427 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
18428 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020018429
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040018430ssl_fc_session_key : binary
18431 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
18432 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
18433 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
18434 BoringSSL.
18435
18436
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018437ssl_fc_sni : string
18438 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
18439 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
18440 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
18441 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
18442 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
18443
18444 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
18445 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
18446 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018447 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020018448 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018449
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018450 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018451 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
18452 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020018453
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018454ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
18455 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
18456 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020018457
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018458ssl_s_der : binary
18459 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the server when the
18460 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18461 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18462
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018463ssl_s_chain_der : binary
18464 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the server when the
18465 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18466 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050018467 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018468 does not support resumed sessions.
18469
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018470ssl_s_key_alg : string
18471 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
18472 presented by the server when the outgoing connection was made over an
18473 SSL/TLS transport layer.
18474
18475ssl_s_notafter : string
18476 Returns the end date presented by the server as a formatted string
18477 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18478 transport layer.
18479
18480ssl_s_notbefore : string
18481 Returns the start date presented by the server as a formatted string
18482 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18483 transport layer.
18484
18485ssl_s_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
18486 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18487 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
18488 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18489 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18490 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18491 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020018492 For instance, "ssl_s_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18493 "ssl_s_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018494 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18495 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18496 LDAP v3.
18497 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18498 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
18499
18500ssl_s_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
18501 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18502 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
18503 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18504 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18505 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18506 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020018507 For instance, "ssl_s_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18508 "ssl_s_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018509 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18510 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18511 LDAP v3.
18512 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18513 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
18514
18515ssl_s_serial : binary
18516 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the server when the
18517 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18518 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18519
18520ssl_s_sha1 : binary
18521 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the server
18522 when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
18523 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
18524
18525ssl_s_sig_alg : string
18526 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
18527 the server when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18528 layer.
18529
18530ssl_s_version : integer
18531 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the server when the
18532 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020018533
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200185347.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018535------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020018536
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018537Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
18538sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
18539only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
18540For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
18541be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
18542can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
18543sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
18544for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
18545content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018546
Christopher Fauleta434a002021-03-25 11:58:51 +010018547Warning : Following sample fetches are ignored if used from HTTP proxies. They
18548 only deal with raw contents found in the buffers. On their side,
18549 HTTTP proxies use structured content. Thus raw representation of
18550 these data are meaningless. A warning is emitted if an ACL relies on
18551 one of the following sample fetches. But it is not possible to detect
18552 all invalid usage (for instance inside a log-format string or a
18553 sample expression). So be careful.
18554
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018555payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018556 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018557 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
18558 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018559
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018560payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
18561 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018562 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018563 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018564
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018565req.len : integer
18566req_len : integer (deprecated)
18567 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
18568 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
18569 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
18570 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
18571 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
18572 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
18573 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
18574 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018575
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018576req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
18577 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020018578 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
18579 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
18580 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
18581 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018582
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018583 ACL alternatives :
18584 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018585
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018586req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
18587 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
18588 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
18589 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
18590 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018591
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018592 ACL alternatives :
18593 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018594
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018595 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018596
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018597req.proto_http : boolean
18598req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
18599 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
18600 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
18601 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
18602 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
18603 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
18604 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
18605 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018606
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018607 Example:
18608 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
18609 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
18610 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018611 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018612
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018613req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
18614rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
18615 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
18616 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
18617 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
18618 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
18619 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
18620 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
18621 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018622
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018623 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
18624 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
18625 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
18626 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
18627 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
18628 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018629
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018630 ACL derivatives :
18631 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018632
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018633 Example :
18634 listen tse-farm
18635 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
18636 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
18637 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
18638 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
18639 # apply RDP cookie persistence
18640 persist rdp-cookie
18641 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
18642 # This is only useful makes sense if
18643 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
18644 stick-table type string size 204800
18645 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
18646 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
18647 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018648
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018649 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
18650 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018651
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018652req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
18653rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
18654 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
18655 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
18656 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
18657 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018658
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018659 ACL derivatives :
18660 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018661
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110018662req.ssl_alpn : string
18663 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
18664 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
18665 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
18666 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
18667 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
18668 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020018669 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110018670
18671 Examples :
18672 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
18673 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
18674 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020018675 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110018676 default_backend bk_default
18677
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020018678req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
18679 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
18680 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020018681 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
18682 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
18683 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
18684 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
18685 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020018686
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018687req.ssl_hello_type : integer
18688req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
18689 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
18690 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
18691 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
18692 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
18693 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
18694 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
18695 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018696
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018697req.ssl_sni : string
18698req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
18699 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
18700 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
18701 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
18702 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
18703 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020018704 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This will only work for actual
18705 implicit TLS based protocols like HTTPS (443), IMAPS (993), SMTPS (465),
18706 however it will not work for explicit TLS based protocols, like SMTP (25/587)
18707 or IMAP (143). SNI normally contains the name of the host the client tries to
18708 connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is useful for allowing or denying access
18709 to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used by the client. This test was designed to
18710 be used with TCP request content inspection. If content switching is needed,
18711 it is recommended to first wait for a complete client hello (type 1), like in
18712 the example below. See also "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018713
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018714 ACL derivatives :
18715 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018716
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018717 Examples :
18718 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
18719 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
18720 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
18721 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
18722 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020018723
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053018724req.ssl_st_ext : integer
18725 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
18726 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
18727 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
18728 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
18729 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
18730 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
18731 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
18732 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
18733 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
18734
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018735req.ssl_ver : integer
18736req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
18737 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
18738 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
18739 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
18740 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
18741 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
18742 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
18743 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018744 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018745 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018746
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018747 ACL derivatives :
18748 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018749
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020018750res.len : integer
18751 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
18752 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
18753 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
18754 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
18755 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
18756 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
18757 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018758 content inspection. But it may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020018759
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018760res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
18761 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020018762 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018763 the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020018764 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018765 any location. It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018766
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018767res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
18768 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
18769 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
18770 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020018771 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign. It may also be used in tcp-check based
18772 expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018773
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018774 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018775
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020018776res.ssl_hello_type : integer
18777rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
18778 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
18779 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
18780 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
18781 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
18782 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
18783 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
18784 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
18785
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018786wait_end : boolean
18787 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
18788 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018789 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018790 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
18791 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018792 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018793 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
18794 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018795
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018796 Examples :
18797 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
18798 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
18799 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018800
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018801 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
18802 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
18803 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
18804 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
18805 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
18806 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
18807 tcp-request content reject
18808
18809
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200188107.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018811--------------------------------------
18812
18813It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
18814This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
18815data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
18816its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
18817HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
18818content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
18819to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
18820more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
18821response are indexed.
18822
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +010018823Note : Regarding HTTP processing from the tcp-request content rules, everything
18824 will work as expected from an HTTP proxy. However, from a TCP proxy,
18825 without an HTTP upgrade, it will only work for HTTP/1 content. For
18826 HTTP/2 content, only the preface is visible. Thus, it is only possible
18827 to rely to "req.proto_http", "req.ver" and eventually "method" sample
18828 fetches. All other L7 sample fetches will fail. After an HTTP upgrade,
18829 they will work in the same manner than from an HTTP proxy.
18830
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018831base : string
18832 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
18833 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
18834 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
18835 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
18836 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
18837 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
18838 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
18839 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
18840
18841 ACL derivatives :
18842 base : exact string match
18843 base_beg : prefix match
18844 base_dir : subdir match
18845 base_dom : domain match
18846 base_end : suffix match
18847 base_len : length match
18848 base_reg : regex match
18849 base_sub : substring match
18850
18851base32 : integer
18852 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
18853 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
18854 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020018855 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
18856 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
18857 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018858
18859base32+src : binary
18860 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
18861 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
18862 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
18863 per-URL counters.
18864
Yves Lafonb4d37082021-02-11 11:01:28 +010018865baseq : string
18866 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
18867 the request with the query-string, which starts at the first slash. Using this
18868 instead of "base" allows one to properly identify the target resource, for
18869 statistics or caching use cases. See also "path", "pathq" and "base".
18870
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010018871capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
18872 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
18873 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
18874 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
18875
18876capture.req.method : string
18877 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
18878 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
18879 because it's allocated.
18880
18881capture.req.uri : string
18882 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
18883 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
18884 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
18885 allocated.
18886
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020018887capture.req.ver : string
18888 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
18889 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
18890 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
18891
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010018892capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
18893 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
18894 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
18895 The first entry is an index of 0.
18896 See also: "capture response header"
18897
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020018898capture.res.ver : string
18899 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
18900 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
18901 persistent flag.
18902
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020018903req.body : binary
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020018904 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It is
18905 recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as much
18906 as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020018907
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020018908req.body_param([<name>) : string
18909 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
18910 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
18911 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
18912 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
18913 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
18914 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
18915 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
18916 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
18917 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
18918 given.
18919
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020018920req.body_len : integer
18921 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
18922 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020018923 is recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as
18924 much as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020018925
18926req.body_size : integer
18927 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020018928 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
18929 available data in case of chunked encoding.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020018930
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018931req.cook([<name>]) : string
18932cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
18933 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
18934 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
18935 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
18936 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
18937 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
18938 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
18939 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
18940 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
18941
18942 ACL derivatives :
18943 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
18944 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
18945 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
18946 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
18947 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
18948 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
18949 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
18950 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018951
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018952req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
18953cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
18954 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
18955 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018956
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018957req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
18958cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
18959 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
18960 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
18961 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
18962 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020018963
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018964cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
18965 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
18966 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
18967 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
18968 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020018969 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018970 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
18971 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
18972 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
18973 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018974
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018975hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
18976 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
18977 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
18978 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
18979 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018980 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018981
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018982req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018983 This returns the full value of the last occurrence of header <name> in an
18984 HTTP request. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas present in the
18985 value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is sometimes useful
18986 with headers such as User-Agent.
18987
18988 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
18989 found.
18990
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018991 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
18992 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
18993 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018994 with -1 being the last one.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018995
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018996req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
18997 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
18998 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010018999 not specified. Like req.fhdr() it differs from res.hdr_cnt() by not splitting
19000 headers at commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019001
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019002req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019003 This returns the last comma-separated value of the header <name> in an HTTP
19004 request. The fetch considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values.
19005 This is useful if you need to process headers that are defined to be a list
19006 of values, such as Accept, or X-Forwarded-For. If full-line headers are
19007 desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC 7231 to know how
19008 certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
19009 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
19010
19011 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
19012 found.
19013
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019014 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
19015 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
19016 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019017 with -1 being the last one.
19018
19019 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header once converted to IP,
19020 associated with an IP stick-table.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019021
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019022 ACL derivatives :
19023 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
19024 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
19025 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
19026 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
19027 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
19028 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
19029 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
19030 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
19031
19032req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19033hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
19034 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
19035 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019036 <name> is not specified. Like req.hdr() it counts each comma separated
19037 part of the header's value. If counting of full-line headers is desired,
19038 then req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead.
19039
19040 With ACLs, it can be used to detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific
19041 header, as well as to block request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests
19042 which contain more than one of certain headers.
19043
19044 Refer to req.hdr() for more information on header matching.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019045
19046req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
19047hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
19048 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
19049 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
19050 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
Willy Tarreau7b0e00d2021-03-25 14:12:29 +010019051 of every header is checked. The parser strictly adheres to the format
19052 described in RFC7239, with the extension that IPv4 addresses may optionally
19053 be followed by a colon (':') and a valid decimal port number (0 to 65535),
19054 which will be silently dropped. All other forms will not match and will
19055 cause the address to be ignored.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019056
19057 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
19058
19059 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019060
19061req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
19062hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
19063 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
19064 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
19065 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019066
19067 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
19068
19069 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019070
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010019071req.hdrs : string
19072 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
19073 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
19074 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
19075 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
19076
19077req.hdrs_bin : binary
19078 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
19079 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
19080 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
19081 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
19082 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
19083 names and values (length of 0 for both).
19084
19085 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010019086
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010019087 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
19088 str: <int:length><bytes>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010019089
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019090http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
19091 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
19092 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
19093 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
19094 basic auth is supported.
19095
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010019096http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
19097 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
19098 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
19099 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
19100 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019101 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
19102 basic auth is supported.
19103
19104 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010019105 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
19106 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
19107 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
19108 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019109
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019110http_auth_pass : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010019111 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
19112 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
19113 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019114
19115http_auth_type : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010019116 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
19117 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
19118 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019119
19120http_auth_user : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010019121 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
19122 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
19123 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019124
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019125http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020019126 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
19127 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019128 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
19129 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020019130
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019131method : integer + string
19132 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
19133 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
19134 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
19135 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
19136 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
19137 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
19138 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019139
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019140 ACL derivatives :
19141 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019142
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019143 Example :
19144 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
19145 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
19146 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019147
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019148path : string
19149 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
19150 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
19151 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
19152 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
19153 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019154 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019155 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019156
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019157 ACL derivatives :
19158 path : exact string match
19159 path_beg : prefix match
19160 path_dir : subdir match
19161 path_dom : domain match
19162 path_end : suffix match
19163 path_len : length match
19164 path_reg : regex match
19165 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019166
Christopher Faulete720c322020-09-02 17:25:18 +020019167pathq : string
19168 This extracts the request's URL path with the query-string, which starts at
19169 the first slash. This sample fetch is pretty handy to always retrieve a
19170 relative URI, excluding the scheme and the authority part, if any. Indeed,
19171 while it is the common representation for an HTTP/1.1 request target, in
19172 HTTP/2, an absolute URI is often used. This sample fetch will return the same
19173 result in both cases.
19174
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010019175query : string
19176 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
19177 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
19178 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
19179 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010019180 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010019181 which stops before the question mark.
19182
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010019183req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
19184 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
19185 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
19186 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
19187 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
19188
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019189req.ver : string
19190req_ver : string (deprecated)
19191 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
19192 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
19193 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019194
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019195 ACL derivatives :
19196 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020019197
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019198res.body : binary
19199 This returns the HTTP response's available body as a block of data. Unlike
19200 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019201 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
19202
19203 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019204
19205res.body_len : integer
19206 This returns the length of the HTTP response available body in bytes. Unlike
19207 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019208 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
19209
19210 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019211
19212res.body_size : integer
19213 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP response body in bytes. It
19214 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
19215 available data in case of chunked encoding. Unlike the request side, there is
19216 no directive to wait for the response body. This sample fetch is really
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019217 useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
19218
19219 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019220
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonbf971212020-10-27 11:55:57 +010019221res.cache_hit : boolean
19222 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been built out of an
19223 HTTP cache entry, otherwise returns boolean "false".
19224
19225res.cache_name : string
19226 Returns a string containing the name of the HTTP cache that was used to
19227 build the HTTP response if res.cache_hit is true, otherwise returns an
19228 empty string.
19229
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019230res.comp : boolean
19231 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
19232 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
19233 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019234
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019235res.comp_algo : string
19236 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
19237 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
19238 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019239
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019240res.cook([<name>]) : string
19241scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19242 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
19243 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019244 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
19245
19246 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020019247
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019248 ACL derivatives :
19249 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020019250
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019251res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19252scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19253 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
19254 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019255 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
19256
19257 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019258
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019259res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
19260scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19261 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
19262 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019263 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
19264
19265 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019266
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019267res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019268 This fetch works like the req.fhdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
19269 on the headers within an HTTP response.
19270
19271 Like req.fhdr() the res.fhdr() fetch returns full values. If the header is
19272 defined to be a list you should use res.hdr().
19273
19274 This fetch is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or Expires.
19275
19276 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019277
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019278res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019279 This fetch works like the req.fhdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
19280 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19281
19282 Like req.fhdr_cnt() the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch acts on full values. If the
19283 header is defined to be a list you should use res.hdr_cnt().
19284
19285 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019286
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019287res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
19288shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019289 This fetch works like the req.hdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
19290 on the headers within an HTTP response.
19291
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050019292 Like req.hdr() the res.hdr() fetch considers the comma to be a delimiter. If
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019293 this is not desired res.fhdr() should be used.
19294
19295 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019296
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019297 ACL derivatives :
19298 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
19299 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
19300 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
19301 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
19302 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
19303 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
19304 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
19305 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
19306
19307res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19308shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019309 This fetch works like the req.hdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
19310 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19311
19312 Like req.hdr_cnt() the res.hdr_cnt() fetch considers the comma to be a
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050019313 delimiter. If this is not desired res.fhdr_cnt() should be used.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019314
19315 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019316
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019317res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
19318shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019319 This fetch works like the req.hdr_ip() fetch with the difference that it
19320 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19321
19322 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
19323
19324 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019325
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010019326res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
19327 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
19328 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
19329 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019330 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
19331
19332 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010019333
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019334res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
19335shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019336 This fetch works like the req.hdr_val() fetch with the difference that it
19337 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19338
19339 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
19340
19341 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019342
19343res.hdrs : string
19344 Returns the current response headers as string including the last empty line
19345 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
19346 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019347 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
19348
19349 It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019350
19351res.hdrs_bin : binary
19352 Returns the current response headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
19353 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. It may be used in
19354 tcp-check based expect rules. Each string is described by a length followed
19355 by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The length is represented
19356 using the variable integer encoding detailed in the SPOE documentation. The
19357 end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header names and values
19358 (length of 0 for both).
19359
19360 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
19361
19362 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
19363 str: <int:length><bytes>
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010019364
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019365res.ver : string
19366resp_ver : string (deprecated)
19367 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019368 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
19369
19370 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020019371
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019372 ACL derivatives :
19373 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010019374
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019375set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19376 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
19377 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020019378 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019379 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010019380
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019381 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
19382 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010019383
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019384status : integer
19385 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
19386 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019387 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
19388
19389 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019390
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020019391unique-id : string
19392 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
19393 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
19394 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
19395 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
19396 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
19397 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
19398
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019399url : string
19400 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
19401 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
19402 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
19403 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
19404 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
19405 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
19406 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019407
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019408 ACL derivatives :
19409 url : exact string match
19410 url_beg : prefix match
19411 url_dir : subdir match
19412 url_dom : domain match
19413 url_end : suffix match
19414 url_len : length match
19415 url_reg : regex match
19416 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019417
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019418url_ip : ip
19419 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
19420 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
19421 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
19422 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
19423 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
19424 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
19425 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019426
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019427url_port : integer
19428 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
19429 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
19430 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
19431 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019432
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020019433urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
19434url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019435 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
19436 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020019437 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
19438 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
19439 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
19440 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019441 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
19442 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020019443 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
19444 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019445
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019446 ACL derivatives :
19447 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
19448 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
19449 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
19450 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
19451 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
19452 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
19453 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
19454 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019455
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019456
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019457 Example :
19458 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
19459 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
19460 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
19461 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019462
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030019463urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019464 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
19465 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
19466 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020019467
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020019468url32 : integer
19469 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
19470 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
19471 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
19472 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
19473 is an unsigned integer.
19474
19475url32+src : binary
19476 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
19477 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
19478 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
19479
Christopher Faulet16032ab2020-04-30 11:30:00 +020019480
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200194817.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019482---------------------------------------
19483
19484This set of sample fetch methods is reserved to developers and must never be
19485used on a production environment, except on developer demand, for debugging
19486purposes. Moreover, no special care will be taken on backwards compatibility.
19487There is no warranty the following sample fetches will never change, be renamed
19488or simply removed. So be really careful if you should use one of them. To avoid
19489any ambiguity, these sample fetches are placed in the dedicated scope "internal",
19490for instance "internal.strm.is_htx".
19491
19492internal.htx.data : integer
19493 Returns the size in bytes used by data in the HTX message associated to a
19494 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19495
19496internal.htx.free : integer
19497 Returns the free space (size - used) in bytes in the HTX message associated
19498 to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19499
19500internal.htx.free_data : integer
19501 Returns the free space for the data in bytes in the HTX message associated to
19502 a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19503
19504internal.htx.has_eom : boolean
Christopher Fauletd1ac2b92020-12-02 19:12:22 +010019505 Returns true if the HTX message associated to a channel contains the
19506 end-of-message flag (EOM). Otherwise, it returns false. The channel is chosen
19507 depending on the sample direction.
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019508
19509internal.htx.nbblks : integer
19510 Returns the number of blocks present in the HTX message associated to a
19511 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19512
19513internal.htx.size : integer
19514 Returns the total size in bytes of the HTX message associated to a
19515 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19516
19517internal.htx.used : integer
19518 Returns the total size used in bytes (data + metadata) in the HTX message
19519 associated to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
19520 direction.
19521
19522internal.htx_blk.size(<idx>) : integer
19523 Returns the size of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
19524 associated to a channel or 0 if it does not exist. The channel is chosen
19525 depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one
19526 of the special value :
19527 * head : The oldest inserted block
19528 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019529 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019530
19531internal.htx_blk.type(<idx>) : string
19532 Returns the type of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
19533 associated to a channel or "HTX_BLK_UNUSED" if it does not exist. The channel
19534 is chosen depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive
19535 integer or one of the special value :
19536 * head : The oldest inserted block
19537 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019538 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019539
19540internal.htx_blk.data(<idx>) : binary
19541 Returns the value of the DATA block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
19542 associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if it is
19543 not a DATA block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19544 <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
19545
19546 * head : The oldest inserted block
19547 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019548 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019549
19550internal.htx_blk.hdrname(<idx>) : string
19551 Returns the header name of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
19552 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
19553 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
19554 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
19555
19556 * head : The oldest inserted block
19557 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019558 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019559
19560internal.htx_blk.hdrval(<idx>) : string
19561 Returns the header value of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
19562 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
19563 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
19564 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
19565
19566 * head : The oldest inserted block
19567 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019568 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019569
19570internal.htx_blk.start_line(<idx>) : string
19571 Returns the value of the REQ_SL or RES_SL block at the position <idx> in the
19572 HTX message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist
19573 or if it is not a SL block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
19574 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
19575
19576 * head : The oldest inserted block
19577 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019578 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019579
19580internal.strm.is_htx : boolean
19581 Returns true if the current stream is an HTX stream. It means the data in the
19582 channels buffers are stored using the internal HTX representation. Otherwise,
19583 it returns false.
19584
19585
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200195867.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019587---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010019588
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019589Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
19590every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020019591order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010019592
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019593ACL name Equivalent to Usage
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020019594---------------+----------------------------------+------------------------------------------------------
19595FALSE always_false never match
19596HTTP req.proto_http match if request protocol is valid HTTP
19597HTTP_1.0 req.ver 1.0 match if HTTP request version is 1.0
19598HTTP_1.1 req.ver 1.1 match if HTTP request version is 1.1
Christopher Faulet8043e832021-03-26 16:00:54 +010019599HTTP_2.0 req.ver 2.0 match if HTTP request version is 2.0
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020019600HTTP_CONTENT req.hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length in the HTTP request
19601HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
19602HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
19603HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
19604LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
19605METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
19606METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
19607METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
19608METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
19609METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
19610METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
19611METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
19612METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
19613RDP_COOKIE req.rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie in the request buffer
19614REQ_CONTENT req.len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
19615TRUE always_true always match
19616WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
19617---------------+----------------------------------+------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010019618
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010019619
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200196208. Logging
19621----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010019622
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019623One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
19624provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
19625very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
19626provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
19627state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010019628to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019629headers.
19630
19631In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
19632about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
19633send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
19634
19635 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
19636 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
19637 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
19638 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
19639 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019640 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060019641 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019642
19643The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
19644allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
19645as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
19646while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
19647real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
19648delay.
19649
19650
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200196518.1. Log levels
19652---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019653
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090019654TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019655source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090019656HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
19657in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
19658track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
19659syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
19660about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019661
19662
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200196638.2. Log formats
19664----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019665
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019666HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090019667and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
19668slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
19669options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019670
19671 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
19672 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
19673 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
19674 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
19675 extents.
19676
19677 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
19678 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
19679 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
19680 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
19681 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
19682
19683 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
19684 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
19685 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
19686 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
19687 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
19688
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020019689 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
19690 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
19691 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
19692 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
19693
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010019694 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
19695
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019696Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
19697specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
19698field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
19699servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
19700always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
19701identifier.
19702
19703Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
19704 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
19705 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
19706 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
19707 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
19708
19709
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200197108.2.1. Default log format
19711-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019712
19713This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
19714as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
19715format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
19716
19717 Example :
19718 listen www
19719 mode http
19720 log global
19721 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
19722
19723 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
19724 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
19725 (www/HTTP)
19726
19727 Field Format Extract from the example above
19728 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
19729 2 'Connect from' Connect from
19730 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
19731 4 'to' to
19732 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
19733 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
19734
19735Detailed fields description :
19736 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
19737 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
19738 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
19739 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
19740 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
19741 and processed the connection.
19742 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
19743
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010019744In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
19745"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
19746connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
19747
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019748It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
19749will eventually disappear.
19750
19751
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200197528.2.2. TCP log format
19753---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019754
19755The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
19756is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
19757information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
19758counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
19759emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
19760environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
19761the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
19762sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020019763specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
19764not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
19765fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
19766marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019767
19768 Example :
19769 frontend fnt
19770 mode tcp
19771 option tcplog
19772 log global
19773 default_backend bck
19774
19775 backend bck
19776 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
19777
19778 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
19779 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
19780 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
19781
19782 Field Format Extract from the example above
19783 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
19784 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
19785 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
19786 4 frontend_name fnt
19787 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
19788 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
19789 7 bytes_read* 212
19790 8 termination_state --
19791 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
19792 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
19793
19794Detailed fields description :
19795 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010019796 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
19797 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
19798 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010019799 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019800 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010019801 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019802
19803 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010019804 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
19805 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
19806 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019807
19808 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
19809 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
19810 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020019811 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
19812 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
19813 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
19814 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019815
19816 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
19817 and processed the connection.
19818
19819 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
19820 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
19821 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
19822 applications.
19823
19824 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
19825 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
19826 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
19827 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
19828 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
19829
19830 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
19831 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
19832 See "Timers" below for more details.
19833
19834 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
19835 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
19836 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
19837 "Timers" below for more details.
19838
19839 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019840 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019841 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
19842 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
19843 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
19844 details.
19845
19846 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
19847 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
19848 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
19849 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
19850 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
19851
19852 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
19853 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
19854 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
19855 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
19856 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
19857 for more details.
19858
19859 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040019860 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019861 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
19862 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
19863 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020019864 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019865
19866 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
19867 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
19868 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
19869 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
19870 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
19871 caused by a denial of service attack.
19872
19873 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
19874 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
19875 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
19876 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
19877 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
19878 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
19879 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
19880 denial of service attack.
19881
19882 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
19883 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
19884 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
19885 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
19886 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
19887 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
19888 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
19889 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
19890 be processed than on other servers.
19891
19892 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
19893 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
19894 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
19895 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
19896 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
19897 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
19898 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
19899 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
19900 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
19901 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
19902 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
19903 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
19904 should not be attributed to the logged server.
19905
19906 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
19907 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
19908 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
19909 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
19910 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
19911 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019912 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019913 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
19914
19915 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
19916 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
19917 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
19918 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
19919 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
19920 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019921 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019922 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
19923 occurs.
19924
19925
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200199268.2.3. HTTP log format
19927----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019928
19929The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
19930is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
19931the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
19932are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
19933emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
19934generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
19935"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
19936which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020019937frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
19938is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019939
19940Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
19941slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
19942with a star ('*') after the field name below.
19943
19944 Example :
19945 frontend http-in
19946 mode http
19947 option httplog
19948 log global
19949 default_backend bck
19950
19951 backend static
19952 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
19953
19954 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
19955 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
19956 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019957 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019958
19959 Field Format Extract from the example above
19960 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
19961 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019962 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019963 4 frontend_name http-in
19964 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019965 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019966 7 status_code 200
19967 8 bytes_read* 2750
19968 9 captured_request_cookie -
19969 10 captured_response_cookie -
19970 11 termination_state ----
19971 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
19972 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
19973 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
19974 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
19975 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010019976
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019977Detailed fields description :
19978 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010019979 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
19980 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
19981 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010019982 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019983 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010019984 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019985
19986 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010019987 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
19988 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
19989 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019990
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020019991 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
19992 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010019993
19994 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
19995 and processed the connection.
19996
19997 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
19998 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
19999 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
20000
20001 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
20002 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
20003 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
20004 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
20005 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
20006 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
20007
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020008 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
20009 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
20010 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050020011 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020012 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
20013 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020014 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
20015 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020016
20017 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
20018 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020019 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020020
20021 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
20022 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020023 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
20024 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020025
20026 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
20027 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
20028 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
20029 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
20030 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020031 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
20032 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020033
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020034 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
20035 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
20036 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
20037 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
20038 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
20039 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
20040 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020041 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020042
20043 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
20044 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
20045 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
20046
20047 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
20048 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050020049 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020050 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
20051 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
20052 overflowing.
20053
20054 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
20055 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
20056 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
20057 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
20058 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
20059 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
20060 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
20061 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
20062
20063 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
20064 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
20065 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
20066 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
20067 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
20068 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
20069 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
20070 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
20071
20072 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
20073 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
20074 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
20075 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
20076 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
20077 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
20078 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
20079
20080 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020081 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020082 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
20083 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
20084 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020085 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020086 system.
20087
20088 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
20089 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
20090 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
20091 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
20092 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
20093 caused by a denial of service attack.
20094
20095 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
20096 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
20097 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
20098 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
20099 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
20100 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
20101 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
20102 denial of service attack.
20103
20104 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
20105 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
20106 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
20107 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
20108 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
20109 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
20110 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
20111 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
20112 processed than on other servers.
20113
20114 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
20115 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
20116 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
20117 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
20118 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
20119 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
20120 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
20121 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
20122 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
20123 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
20124 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
20125 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
20126 should not be attributed to the logged server.
20127
20128 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20129 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
20130 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
20131 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
20132 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
20133 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020134 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020135 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
20136
20137 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20138 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
20139 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
20140 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
20141 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
20142 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020143 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020144 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
20145 occurs.
20146
20147 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
20148 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
20149 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
20150 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
20151 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
20152 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
20153 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
20154 cookies" below for more details.
20155
20156 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
20157 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
20158 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
20159 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
20160 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
20161 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
20162 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
20163 and cookies" below for more details.
20164
20165 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
20166 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
20167 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
20168 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
20169 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
20170 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
20171 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
20172 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
20173
20174
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200201758.2.4. Custom log format
20176------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020177
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020178The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020179mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020180
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020181HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020182Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
20183separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
20184prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
20185
20186Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
20187variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020188("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020189
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010020190If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020020191as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010020192less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
20193the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
20194
Dragan Dosen1e3b16f2020-06-23 18:16:44 +020020195Note: spaces must be escaped. In configuration directives "log-format",
20196"log-format-sd" and "unique-id-format", spaces are considered as
20197delimiters and are merged. In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be
20198preceded by another '%' resulting in '%%'.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020199
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020200Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
20201'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
20202https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
20203such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
20204
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020205Flags are :
20206 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020207 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020208 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
20209 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020210
20211 Example:
20212
20213 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
20214 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
20215
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020216 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
20217
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020218At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
20219
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020220 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
20221 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020222
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020223the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020224
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020225 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
20226 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
20227 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020228
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020229and the default TCP format is defined this way :
20230
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020231 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
20232 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020233
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020234Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
20235
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020236 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020237 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020238 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
20239 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
20240 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020241 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
20242 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
20243 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020244 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000020245 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
Maciej Zdeb21acc332020-11-26 10:45:52 +000020246 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string | string |
Maciej Zdebfcdfd852020-11-30 18:27:47 +000020247 | H | %HPO | HTTP path only (without host nor query string)| string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000020248 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000020249 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
20250 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010020251 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020020252 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020253 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020254 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020255 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020020256 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080020257 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020258 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
20259 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
20260 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
20261 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
20262 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020263 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020264 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000020265 | | %Tu | Tu | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020266 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020267 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020268 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
20269 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020270 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
20271 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
20272 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020273 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020274 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
20275 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020276 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020277 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
20278 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
20279 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020020280 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020020281 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020020282 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
20283 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
20284 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
20285 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020020286 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020287 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020288 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020289 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010020290 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020291 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020292 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
20293 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
20294 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020295 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020296 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
20297 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020298 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020299 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
20300 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020020301 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020302 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020303 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020304 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020305
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020306 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020307
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010020308
203098.2.5. Error log format
20310-----------------------
20311
20312When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
20313protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
20314By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
20315"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020316will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010020317logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
20318
20319The format looks like this :
20320
20321 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
20322 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
20323 Connection error during SSL handshake
20324
20325 Field Format Extract from the example above
20326 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
20327 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
20328 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
20329 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
20330 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
20331
20332These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
20333failures.
20334
20335
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200203368.3. Advanced logging options
20337-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020338
20339Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
20340just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
20341options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
20342for more information about their usage.
20343
20344
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200203458.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
20346------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020347
20348It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
20349haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
20350commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
20351monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
20352ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
20353
20354 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
20355 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
20356 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
20357 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
20358
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +020020359 - it is possible to use the "http-request set-log-level silent" action using
20360 a variety of conditions (source networks, paths, user-agents, etc).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020361
20362 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
20363 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
20364 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
20365
20366
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200203678.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
20368----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020369
20370The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
20371what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
20372or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020373"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020374just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
20375log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
20376after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
20377is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
20378with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
20379with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
20380
20381
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200203828.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
20383------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020384
20385Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
20386for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
20387"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
20388retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
20389raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
20390a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
20391file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
20392you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
20393"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
20394
20395
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200203968.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
20397--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020398
20399Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
20400multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
20401them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
20402"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
20403logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
20404error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
20405and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
20406too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
20407useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
20408alternative.
20409
20410
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200204118.4. Timing events
20412------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020413
20414Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
20415reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
20416the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
20417frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020418mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
20419addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
20420
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010020421Timings events in HTTP mode:
20422
20423 first request 2nd request
20424 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
20425 t tr t tr ...
20426 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
20427 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
20428 :<---- Tq ---->: :
20429 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000020430 :<-- -----Tu--------------->:
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010020431 :<--------- Ta --------->:
20432
20433Timings events in TCP mode:
20434
20435 TCP session
20436 |<----------------->|
20437 t t
20438 ---|----|----|----|----|---
20439 | Th Tw Tc Td |
20440 |<------ Tt ------->|
20441
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020442 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020443 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020444 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
20445 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
20446 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020447 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020448 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
20449 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
20450 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
20451 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020452
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020453 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
20454 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
20455 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020456 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
20457 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
20458 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
20459 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
20460 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
20461 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020462
20463 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
20464 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
20465 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
20466 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
20467 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
20468 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
20469 request typed by hand during a test.
20470
20471 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
20472 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020473 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020474 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
20475 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
20476 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
20477 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020478
20479 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
20480 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
20481 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
20482 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
20483 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
20484
20485 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
20486 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
20487 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
20488 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
20489 connection never established.
20490
20491 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
20492 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
20493 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
20494 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
20495 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
20496 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
20497 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
20498 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
20499 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
20500 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
20501 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
20502
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020503 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
20504 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
20505 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
20506 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
20507 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
20508 by subtracting other timers when valid :
20509
20510 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
20511
20512 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
20513 "Ta" can never be negative.
20514
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020515 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
20516 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020517 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
20518 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020519 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020520
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020521 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020522
20523 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020524 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
20525 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020526
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000020527 - Tu: total estimated time as seen from client, between the moment the proxy
20528 accepted it and the moment both ends were closed, without idle time.
20529 This is useful to roughly measure end-to-end time as a user would see it,
20530 without idle time pollution from keep-alive time between requests. This
20531 timer in only an estimation of time seen by user as it assumes network
20532 latency is the same in both directions. The exception is when the "logasap"
20533 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
20534 prefixed with a '+' sign.
20535
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020536These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
20537protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
20538that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020539due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
20540"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
20541that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020542
20543Most common cases :
20544
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020545 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
20546 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
20547 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
20548 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
20549 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
20550 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
20551 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
20552 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
20553 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
20554 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
20555 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020020556 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020557
20558 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
20559 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
20560 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
20561 of ms on remote networks.
20562
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020020563 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
20564 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
20565 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020566
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020567 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
20568 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
20569 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
20570 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
20571 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
20572 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
20573 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
20574 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
20575 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020576
20577Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
20578
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020579 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020580 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020581 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020582
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020583 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020584 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
20585 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
20586
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020587 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020588 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
20589 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
20590 flags.
20591
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020592 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
20593 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020594 Check the session termination flags, then check the
20595 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
20596 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
20597 the client connection was maintained open.
20598
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020599 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020600 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020601 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020602 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
20603
20604
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200206058.5. Session state at disconnection
20606-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020607
20608TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
20609"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
206102-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
20611each of which has a special meaning :
20612
20613 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
20614 session to terminate :
20615
20616 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
20617
20618 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
20619 server explicitly refused it.
20620
20621 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
20622 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
20623 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
20624 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020625 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020020626
20627 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
20628 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020629
20630 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
20631 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
20632 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
20633 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
20634 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
20635
20636 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
20637 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
20638 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
20639 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
20640 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
20641
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090020642 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
20643 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
20644
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070020645 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
20646 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
20647 backup connections when going up.
20648
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020020649 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
20650
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020651 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
20652 send or receive data.
20653
20654 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
20655 send or receive data.
20656
20657 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
20658 with nothing left in the buffers.
20659
20660 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
20661
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010020662 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020663 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
20664
20665 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
20666 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
20667 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
20668 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
20669 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
20670
20671 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
20672 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
20673
20674 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
20675 server (HTTP only).
20676
20677 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
20678
20679 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
20680 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
20681 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
20682
20683 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
20684 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
20685 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
20686
20687 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
20688
20689 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
20690 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
20691
20692 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
20693 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
20694 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
20695
20696 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
20697 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020020698 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
20699 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020700
20701 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
20702 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
20703 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
20704 another server.
20705
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020706 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020707 server.
20708
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020709 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
20710 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
20711 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
20712 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
20713
20714 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
20715 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
20716 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
20717 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
20718
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020020719 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
20720 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
20721 "use-server" rule).
20722
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020723 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
20724
20725 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
20726 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
20727
20728 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
20729
20730 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
20731 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
20732 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
20733
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020734 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
20735 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020736 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020737 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
20738 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
20739
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020740 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
20741
20742 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
20743 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
20744
20745 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
20746
20747 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
20748
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020749The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
20750was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020751helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
20752starvation, attacks, etc...
20753
20754The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
20755alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
20756easier finding and understanding.
20757
20758 Flags Reason
20759
20760 -- Normal termination.
20761
20762 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
20763 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
20764 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
20765 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
20766
20767 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
20768 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
20769 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
20770 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
20771 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
20772 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020773
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020774 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
20775 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020020776 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020777
20778 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
20779 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
20780 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
20781
20782 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
20783 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
20784 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
20785 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
20786 the server takes too long to respond.
20787
20788 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
20789 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
20790 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
20791 long a time to respond.
20792
20793 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
20794 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
20795 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
20796 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020020797 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
20798 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020799
20800 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
20801 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
20802 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
20803 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
20804 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020020805 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020020806 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
20807 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
20808 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
20809 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
20810 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
20811 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
20812 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
20813 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020814 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020020815 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
20816 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
20817 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020818
20819 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
20820 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020020821 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
20822 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
20823 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
20824 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020825
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020020826 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
20827 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
20828
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010020829 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020830 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
20831 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020832 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020833 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
20834 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
20835
20836 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
20837 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
20838 503 or 504 here.
20839
20840 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
20841 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
20842 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
20843 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
20844 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
20845
20846 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
20847 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020848 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020849 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
20850 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
20851
20852 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
20853 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
20854 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
20855 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
20856 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
20857 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
20858 between haproxy and the server.
20859
20860 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
20861 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
20862 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
20863 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
20864 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
20865 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
20866 solution is to fix the application.
20867
20868 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
20869 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
20870 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
20871 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
20872 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
20873 external attacks.
20874
20875 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070020876 process's socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020020877 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020878 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
20879 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
20880
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010020881 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
20882 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
20883 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020884 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020020885 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010020886
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020887 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
20888 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
20889 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
20890 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010020891 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
20892 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
20893 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
20894 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
20895 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020896
20897 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
20898 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
20899 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
20900 returned an HTTP 403 error.
20901
20902 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
20903 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
20904 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
20905 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
20906
20907 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
20908 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
20909 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
20910 only be solved by proper system tuning.
20911
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020912The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
20913persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
20914important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
20915re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
20916
20917 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
20918
20919 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
20920 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
20921 set on a GET request.
20922
20923 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
20924 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020925 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020020926 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
20927
20928 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
20929 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
20930 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
20931
20932 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
20933 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
20934 already got a cookie.
20935
20936 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
20937 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
20938 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
20939 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
20940 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
20941
20942 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
20943 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
20944 new cookie was inserted in the response.
20945
20946 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
20947 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
20948 new cookie was inserted in the response.
20949
20950 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
20951 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
20952
20953 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
20954 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
20955 then advertised in the response.
20956
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020957
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200209588.6. Non-printable characters
20959-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020960
20961In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
20962consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
20963converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
20964prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
20965being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
20966escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
20967is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
20968'}' when logging headers.
20969
20970Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
20971issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
20972containing spaces is "User-Agent".
20973
20974Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
20975the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
20976performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
20977
20978
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200209798.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
20980---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020981
20982Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
20983achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020984section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020985cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
20986the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
20987the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020988locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020989not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
20990user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
20991a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
20992wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
20993
20994 Examples :
20995 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
20996 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
20997
20998 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
20999 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
21000
21001
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200210028.8. Capturing HTTP headers
21003---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021004
21005Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
21006proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
21007the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
21008server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
21009
21010Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
21011response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021012section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021013
21014It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010021015time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
21016appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021017are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
21018and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
21019follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
21020request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
21021in the logs.
21022
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020021023As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
21024frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
21025an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
21026
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021027 Example :
21028 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
21029 listen proxy-out
21030 mode http
21031 option httplog
21032 option logasap
21033 log global
21034 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
21035
21036 # log the name of the virtual server
21037 capture request header Host len 20
21038
21039 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
21040 capture request header Content-Length len 10
21041
21042 # log the beginning of the referrer
21043 capture request header Referer len 20
21044
21045 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
21046 capture response header Server len 20
21047
21048 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
21049 capture response header Content-Length len 10
21050
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021051 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021052 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
21053
21054 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
21055 capture response header Via len 20
21056
21057 # log the URL location during a redirection
21058 capture response header Location len 20
21059
21060 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
21061 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
21062 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
21063 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
21064 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
21065
21066 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
21067 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
21068 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
21069 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021070 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021071
21072 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
21073 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
21074 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
21075 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
21076 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021077 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021078
21079
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200210808.9. Examples of logs
21081---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021082
21083These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
21084them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
21085reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
21086
21087 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
21088 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
21089 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
21090
21091 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
21092 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
21093
21094 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
21095 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
21096 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
21097
21098 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
21099 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
21100
21101 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
21102 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
21103 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
21104
21105 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010021106 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021107 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
21108 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
21109
21110 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
21111 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
21112 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
21113
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020021114 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
21115 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
21116 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
21117 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
21118 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided to
21119 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021120
21121 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021122 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021123
21124 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
21125 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
21126 Nothing was sent to any server.
21127
21128 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
21129 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
21130
21131 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
21132 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021133 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021134 send a 408 return code to the client.
21135
21136 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
21137 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
21138
21139 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
21140 5 seconds ("c----").
21141
21142 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
21143 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021144 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021145
21146 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021147 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021148 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
21149 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
21150 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
21151 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
21152 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010021153
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020021154
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200211559. Supported filters
21156--------------------
21157
21158Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
21159accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
21160unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
21161
21162See also : "filter"
21163
211649.1. Trace
21165----------
21166
Christopher Fauletc41d8bd2020-11-17 10:43:26 +010021167filter trace [name <name>] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021168
21169 Arguments:
21170 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
21171 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
21172
Christopher Faulet96a577a2020-11-17 10:45:05 +010021173 <quiet> inhibits trace messages.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021174
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021175 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021176 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
21177 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
21178 amount of the parsed data.
21179
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021180 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010021181
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021182This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
21183callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
21184information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
21185filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
21186
21187Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
21188tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
21189a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
21190
21191
211929.2. HTTP compression
21193---------------------
21194
21195filter compression
21196
21197The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
21198keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021199when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
21200fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
21201done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
21202explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
21203filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
21204listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
21205order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021206
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021207See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
21208 about the fcgi-app filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021209
21210
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200212119.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
21212--------------------------------------------
21213
21214filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
21215
21216 Arguments :
21217
21218 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
21219 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
21220 parsed.
21221
21222 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
21223 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
21224 part must be placed in its own scope.
21225
21226The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
21227external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021228streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020021229exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
21230also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
21231
21232SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
21233the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
21234
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010021235For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020021236"doc/SPOE.txt".
21237
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100212389.4. Cache
21239----------
21240
21241filter cache <name>
21242
21243 Arguments :
21244
21245 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
21246
21247The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
21248"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050021249cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021250other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
21251case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
21252is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
21253filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010021254listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
21255order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010021256
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021257See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
21258 fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
21259
21260
212619.5. Fcgi-app
21262-------------
21263
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040021264filter fcgi-app <name>
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021265
21266 Arguments :
21267
21268 <name> is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
21269
21270The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
21271request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
21272reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
21273used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
21274implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
21275used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
21276fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
21277used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
21278order.
21279
21280See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
21281 about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
21282
21283
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +0100212849.6. OpenTracing
21285----------------
21286
21287The OpenTracing filter adds native support for using distributed tracing in
21288HAProxy. This is enabled by sending an OpenTracing compliant request to one
21289of the supported tracers such as Datadog, Jaeger, Lightstep and Zipkin tracers.
21290Please note: tracers are not listed by any preference, but alphabetically.
21291
21292This feature is only enabled when haproxy was built with USE_OT=1.
21293
21294The OpenTracing filter activation is done explicitly by specifying it in the
21295HAProxy configuration. If this is not done, the OpenTracing filter in no way
21296participates in the work of HAProxy.
21297
21298filter opentracing [id <id>] config <file>
21299
21300 Arguments :
21301
21302 <id> is the OpenTracing filter id that will be used to find the
21303 right scope in the configuration file. If no filter id is
21304 specified, 'ot-filter' is used as default. If scope is not
21305 specified in the configuration file, it applies to all defined
21306 OpenTracing filters.
21307
21308 <file> is the path of the OpenTracing configuration file. The same
21309 file can contain configurations for multiple OpenTracing
21310 filters simultaneously. In that case we do not need to define
21311 scope so the same configuration applies to all filters or each
21312 filter must have its own scope defined.
21313
21314More detailed documentation related to the operation, configuration and use
Willy Tarreaua63d1a02021-04-02 17:16:46 +020021315of the filter can be found in the addons/ot directory.
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +010021316
21317
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02002131810. FastCGI applications
21319-------------------------
21320
21321HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
21322feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
21323the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
21324FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
21325servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
21326FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
21327backend.
21328
21329HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
21330application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
21331connection.
21332
2133310.1. Setup
21334-----------
21335
2133610.1.1. Fcgi-app section
21337--------------------------
21338
21339fcgi-app <name>
21340 Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
21341 document root must be defined.
21342
21343acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
21344 Declare or complete an access list.
21345
21346 See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
21347 details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
21348 used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
21349 in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
21350 Pre-defined ACLs are available.
21351
21352docroot <path>
21353 Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
21354 the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
21355 PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
21356
21357index <script-name>
21358 Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
21359 slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
21360 is an optional setting.
21361
21362 Example :
21363 index index.php
21364
21365log-stderr global
21366log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +010021367 [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021368 Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
21369
21370 See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
21371 default STDERR messages are ignored.
21372
21373pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
21374 Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
21375 application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
21376 which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
21377
21378 Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
21379 prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
21380 that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
21381 "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
21382
21383 Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
21384 the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
21385
21386path-info <regex>
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010021387 Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info from
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010021388 the URL-decoded path. Thus, <regex> may have two captures: the first one to
21389 capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. The
21390 first one is mandatory, the second one is optional. This way, it is possible
21391 to extract the script-name from the path ignoring the path-info. It is an
21392 optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
21393 path. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not
21394 filled.
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010021395
21396 For security reason, when this regular expression is defined, the newline and
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050021397 the null characters are forbidden from the path, once URL-decoded. The reason
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010021398 to such limitation is because otherwise the matching always fails (due to a
21399 limitation one the way regular expression are executed in HAProxy). So if one
21400 of these two characters is found in the URL-decoded path, an error is
21401 returned to the client. The principle of least astonishment is applied here.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021402
21403 Example :
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010021404 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$ # both script-name and path-info may be set
21405 path-info ^(/.+\.php) # the path-info is ignored
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021406
21407option get-values
21408no option get-values
21409 Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
21410
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040021411 HAProxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021412 establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
21413
21414 * FCGI_MAX_REQS The maximum number of concurrent requests this
21415 application will accept.
21416
William Lallemand93e548e2019-09-30 13:54:02 +020021417 * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
21418 "1" otherwise.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021419
21420 Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050021421 the connection immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021422 option is disabled.
21423
21424 Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
21425 application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
21426 per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
21427 server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
21428 an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
21429 of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
21430
21431option keep-conn
21432no option keep-conn
21433 Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
21434 sending a response.
21435
21436 If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
21437 to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
21438
21439option max-reqs <reqs>
21440 Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
21441 accept.
21442
21443 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
21444 during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
21445 support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
21446 to 1.
21447
21448option mpxs-conns
21449no option mpxs-conns
21450 Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
21451
21452 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
21453 during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
21454
21455set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
21456 Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
21457 value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.4
21458 "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
21459 condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
21460
21461 With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
21462 parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
21463 ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
21464
21465 Example :
21466 # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
21467 set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
21468
21469 set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
21470
21471
2147210.1.2. Proxy section
21473---------------------
21474
21475use-fcgi-app <name>
21476 Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
21477
21478 Arguments :
21479 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
21480
21481 This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
21482 and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
21483 with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
21484 recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
21485 application may be defined at a time per backend.
21486
21487 Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
21488 on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
21489 sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
21490 application are evaluated.
21491
21492
2149310.1.3. Example
21494---------------
21495
21496 frontend front-http
21497 mode http
21498 bind *:80
21499 bind *:
21500
21501 use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
21502 default_backend back-static
21503
21504 backend back-static
21505 mode http
21506 server www A.B.C.D:80
21507
21508 backend back-dynamic
21509 mode http
21510 use-fcgi-app php-fpm
21511 server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
21512
21513 fcgi-app php-fpm
21514 log-stderr global
21515 option keep-conn
21516
21517 docroot /var/www/my-app
21518 index index.php
21519 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
21520
21521
2152210.2. Default parameters
21523------------------------
21524
21525A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
21526the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050021527script. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021528applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
21529
21530 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21531 | AUTH_TYPE | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy |
21532 | | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the |
21533 | | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported. |
21534 | | |
21535 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21536 | CONTENT_LENGTH | Contains the size of the message-body attached to |
21537 | | the request. It means only requests with a known |
21538 | | size are considered as valid and sent to the |
21539 | | application. |
21540 | | |
21541 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21542 | CONTENT_TYPE | Contains the type of the message-body attached to |
21543 | | the request. It may not be set. |
21544 | | |
21545 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21546 | DOCUMENT_ROOT | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
21547 | | which the script should be executed, as defined in |
21548 | | the application's configuration. |
21549 | | |
21550 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21551 | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy |
21552 | | to communicate with the FastCGI application. |
21553 | | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1". |
21554 | | |
21555 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21556 | PATH_INFO | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy |
21557 | | following the part that identifies the script |
21558 | | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must |
21559 | | be defined. |
21560 | | |
21561 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21562 | PATH_TRANSLATED | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version. |
21563 | | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and |
21564 | | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
21565 | | is not set too. |
21566 | | |
21567 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21568 | QUERY_STRING | Contains the request's query string. It may not be |
21569 | | set. |
21570 | | |
21571 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21572 | REMOTE_ADDR | Contains the network address of the client sending |
21573 | | the request. |
21574 | | |
21575 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21576 | REMOTE_USER | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
21577 | | client as part of user authentication. |
21578 | | |
21579 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21580 | REQUEST_METHOD | Contains the method which should be used by the |
21581 | | script to process the request. |
21582 | | |
21583 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21584 | REQUEST_URI | Contains the request's URI. |
21585 | | |
21586 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21587 | SCRIPT_FILENAME | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
21588 | | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
21589 | | |
21590 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21591 | SCRIPT_NAME | Contains the name of the script. If the directive |
21592 | | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
21593 | | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name. |
21594 | | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path. |
21595 | | |
21596 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21597 | SERVER_NAME | Contains the name of the server host to which the |
21598 | | client request is directed. It is the value of the |
21599 | | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the |
21600 | | destination address of the connection on the client |
21601 | | side. |
21602 | | |
21603 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21604 | SERVER_PORT | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
21605 | | on the client side, which is the port the client |
21606 | | connected to. |
21607 | | |
21608 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21609 | SERVER_PROTOCOL | Contains the request's protocol. |
21610 | | |
21611 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21612 | HTTPS | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was |
21613 | | queried through the HTTPS protocol. |
21614 | | |
21615 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21616
21617
2161810.3. Limitations
21619------------------
21620
21621The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
21622way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
21623during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
21624establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
21625application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
21626or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
21627message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
21628these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
21629and HTTP servers under the same backend.
21630
21631Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
21632request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
21633requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
21634
21635About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
21636into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
21637fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
21638"http-request" ones.
21639
21640Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
21641FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
21642processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
21643must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
21644here.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010021645
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020021646
2164711. Address formats
21648-------------------
21649
21650Several statements as "bind, "server", "nameserver" and "log" requires an
21651address.
21652
21653This address can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6 address, or '*'.
21654The '*' is equal to the special address "0.0.0.0" and can be used, in the case
21655of "bind" or "dgram-bind" to listen on all IPv4 of the system.The IPv6
21656equivalent is '::'.
21657
21658Depending of the statement, a port or port range follows the IP address. This
21659is mandatory on 'bind' statement, optional on 'server'.
21660
21661This address can also begin with a slash '/'. It is considered as the "unix"
21662family, and '/' and following characters must be present the path.
21663
21664Default socket type or transport method "datagram" or "stream" depends on the
21665configuration statement showing the address. Indeed, 'bind' and 'server' will
21666use a "stream" socket type by default whereas 'log', 'nameserver' or
21667'dgram-bind' will use a "datagram".
21668
21669Optionally, a prefix could be used to force the address family and/or the
21670socket type and the transport method.
21671
21672
2167311.1 Address family prefixes
21674----------------------------
21675
21676'abns@<name>' following <name> is an abstract namespace (Linux only).
21677
21678'fd@<n>' following address is a file descriptor <n> inherited from the
21679 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already be
21680 listening.
21681
21682'ip@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4 or
21683 IPv6 address depending on the syntax. Depending
21684 on the statement using this address, a port or
21685 a port range may or must be specified.
21686
21687'ipv4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
21688 an IPv4 address. Depending on the statement
21689 using this address, a port or a port range
21690 may or must be specified.
21691
21692'ipv6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
21693 an IPv6 address. Depending on the statement
21694 using this address, a port or a port range
21695 may or must be specified.
21696
21697'sockpair@<n>' following address is the file descriptor of a connected unix
21698 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the initiator
21699 creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes one of them
21700 over the FD to the other end. The listener waits to receive
21701 the FD from the unix socket and uses it as if it were the FD
21702 of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
21703
21704'unix@<path>' following string is considered as a UNIX socket <path>. this
21705 prefix is useful to declare an UNIX socket path which don't
21706 start by slash '/'.
21707
21708
2170911.2 Socket type prefixes
21710-------------------------
21711
21712Previous "Address family prefixes" can also be prefixed to force the socket
21713type and the transport method. The default depends of the statement using
21714this address but in some cases the user may force it to a different one.
21715This is the case for "log" statement where the default is syslog over UDP
21716but we could force to use syslog over TCP.
21717
21718Those prefixes were designed for internal purpose and users should
21719instead use aliases of the next section "11.5.3 Protocol prefixes".
21720
21721If users need one those prefixes to perform what they expect because
21722they can not configure the same using the protocol prefixes, they should
21723report this to the maintainers.
21724
21725'stream+<family>@<address>' forces socket type and transport method
21726 to "stream"
21727
21728'dgram+<family>@<address>' forces socket type and transport method
21729 to "datagram".
21730
21731
2173211.3 Protocol prefixes
21733----------------------
21734
21735'tcp@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4
21736 or IPv6 address depending of the syntax but
21737 socket type and transport method is forced to
21738 "stream". Depending on the statement using
21739 this address, a port or a port range can or
21740 must be specified. It is considered as an alias
21741 of 'stream+ip@'.
21742
21743'tcp4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
21744 an IPv4 address but socket type and transport
21745 method is forced to "stream". Depending on the
21746 statement using this address, a port or port
21747 range can or must be specified.
21748 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
21749
21750'tcp6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
21751 an IPv6 address but socket type and transport
21752 method is forced to "stream". Depending on the
21753 statement using this address, a port or port
21754 range can or must be specified.
21755 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
21756
21757'udp@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4
21758 or IPv6 address depending of the syntax but
21759 socket type and transport method is forced to
21760 "datagram". Depending on the statement using
21761 this address, a port or a port range can or
21762 must be specified. It is considered as an alias
21763 of 'dgram+ip@'.
21764
21765'udp4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
21766 an IPv4 address but socket type and transport
21767 method is forced to "datagram". Depending on
21768 the statement using this address, a port or
21769 port range can or must be specified.
21770 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
21771
21772'udp6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
21773 an IPv6 address but socket type and transport
21774 method is forced to "datagram". Depending on
21775 the statement using this address, a port or
21776 port range can or must be specified.
21777 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
21778
21779'uxdg@<path>' following string is considered as a unix socket <path> but
21780 transport method is forced to "datagram". It is considered as
21781 an alias of 'dgram+unix@'.
21782
21783'uxst@<path>' following string is considered as a unix socket <path> but
21784 transport method is forced to "stream". It is considered as
21785 an alias of 'stream+unix@'.
21786
21787In future versions, other prefixes could be used to specify protocols like
21788QUIC which proposes stream transport based on socket of type "datagram".
21789
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010021790/*
21791 * Local variables:
21792 * fill-column: 79
21793 * End:
21794 */